hooks.c (hook_int_rtx_mode_as_bool_0): New function.
[gcc.git] / gcc / doc / tm.texi
1 @c Copyright (C) 1988,1989,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1997,1998,1999,2000,2001,
2 @c 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010, 2011, 2012
3 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 @c This is part of the GCC manual.
5 @c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
6
7 @node Target Macros
8 @chapter Target Description Macros and Functions
9 @cindex machine description macros
10 @cindex target description macros
11 @cindex macros, target description
12 @cindex @file{tm.h} macros
13
14 In addition to the file @file{@var{machine}.md}, a machine description
15 includes a C header file conventionally given the name
16 @file{@var{machine}.h} and a C source file named @file{@var{machine}.c}.
17 The header file defines numerous macros that convey the information
18 about the target machine that does not fit into the scheme of the
19 @file{.md} file. The file @file{tm.h} should be a link to
20 @file{@var{machine}.h}. The header file @file{config.h} includes
21 @file{tm.h} and most compiler source files include @file{config.h}. The
22 source file defines a variable @code{targetm}, which is a structure
23 containing pointers to functions and data relating to the target
24 machine. @file{@var{machine}.c} should also contain their definitions,
25 if they are not defined elsewhere in GCC, and other functions called
26 through the macros defined in the @file{.h} file.
27
28 @menu
29 * Target Structure:: The @code{targetm} variable.
30 * Driver:: Controlling how the driver runs the compilation passes.
31 * Run-time Target:: Defining @samp{-m} options like @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}.
32 * Per-Function Data:: Defining data structures for per-function information.
33 * Storage Layout:: Defining sizes and alignments of data.
34 * Type Layout:: Defining sizes and properties of basic user data types.
35 * Registers:: Naming and describing the hardware registers.
36 * Register Classes:: Defining the classes of hardware registers.
37 * Old Constraints:: The old way to define machine-specific constraints.
38 * Stack and Calling:: Defining which way the stack grows and by how much.
39 * Varargs:: Defining the varargs macros.
40 * Trampolines:: Code set up at run time to enter a nested function.
41 * Library Calls:: Controlling how library routines are implicitly called.
42 * Addressing Modes:: Defining addressing modes valid for memory operands.
43 * Anchored Addresses:: Defining how @option{-fsection-anchors} should work.
44 * Condition Code:: Defining how insns update the condition code.
45 * Costs:: Defining relative costs of different operations.
46 * Scheduling:: Adjusting the behavior of the instruction scheduler.
47 * Sections:: Dividing storage into text, data, and other sections.
48 * PIC:: Macros for position independent code.
49 * Assembler Format:: Defining how to write insns and pseudo-ops to output.
50 * Debugging Info:: Defining the format of debugging output.
51 * Floating Point:: Handling floating point for cross-compilers.
52 * Mode Switching:: Insertion of mode-switching instructions.
53 * Target Attributes:: Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}.
54 * Emulated TLS:: Emulated TLS support.
55 * MIPS Coprocessors:: MIPS coprocessor support and how to customize it.
56 * PCH Target:: Validity checking for precompiled headers.
57 * C++ ABI:: Controlling C++ ABI changes.
58 * Named Address Spaces:: Adding support for named address spaces
59 * Misc:: Everything else.
60 @end menu
61
62 @node Target Structure
63 @section The Global @code{targetm} Variable
64 @cindex target hooks
65 @cindex target functions
66
67 @deftypevar {struct gcc_target} targetm
68 The target @file{.c} file must define the global @code{targetm} variable
69 which contains pointers to functions and data relating to the target
70 machine. The variable is declared in @file{target.h};
71 @file{target-def.h} defines the macro @code{TARGET_INITIALIZER} which is
72 used to initialize the variable, and macros for the default initializers
73 for elements of the structure. The @file{.c} file should override those
74 macros for which the default definition is inappropriate. For example:
75 @smallexample
76 #include "target.h"
77 #include "target-def.h"
78
79 /* @r{Initialize the GCC target structure.} */
80
81 #undef TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
82 #define TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES @var{machine}_comp_type_attributes
83
84 struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
85 @end smallexample
86 @end deftypevar
87
88 Where a macro should be defined in the @file{.c} file in this manner to
89 form part of the @code{targetm} structure, it is documented below as a
90 ``Target Hook'' with a prototype. Many macros will change in future
91 from being defined in the @file{.h} file to being part of the
92 @code{targetm} structure.
93
94 Similarly, there is a @code{targetcm} variable for hooks that are
95 specific to front ends for C-family languages, documented as ``C
96 Target Hook''. This is declared in @file{c-family/c-target.h}, the
97 initializer @code{TARGETCM_INITIALIZER} in
98 @file{c-family/c-target-def.h}. If targets initialize @code{targetcm}
99 themselves, they should set @code{target_has_targetcm=yes} in
100 @file{config.gcc}; otherwise a default definition is used.
101
102 Similarly, there is a @code{targetm_common} variable for hooks that
103 are shared between the compiler driver and the compilers proper,
104 documented as ``Common Target Hook''. This is declared in
105 @file{common/common-target.h}, the initializer
106 @code{TARGETM_COMMON_INITIALIZER} in
107 @file{common/common-target-def.h}. If targets initialize
108 @code{targetm_common} themselves, they should set
109 @code{target_has_targetm_common=yes} in @file{config.gcc}; otherwise a
110 default definition is used.
111
112 @node Driver
113 @section Controlling the Compilation Driver, @file{gcc}
114 @cindex driver
115 @cindex controlling the compilation driver
116
117 @c prevent bad page break with this line
118 You can control the compilation driver.
119
120 @defmac DRIVER_SELF_SPECS
121 A list of specs for the driver itself. It should be a suitable
122 initializer for an array of strings, with no surrounding braces.
123
124 The driver applies these specs to its own command line between loading
125 default @file{specs} files (but not command-line specified ones) and
126 choosing the multilib directory or running any subcommands. It
127 applies them in the order given, so each spec can depend on the
128 options added by earlier ones. It is also possible to remove options
129 using @samp{%<@var{option}} in the usual way.
130
131 This macro can be useful when a port has several interdependent target
132 options. It provides a way of standardizing the command line so
133 that the other specs are easier to write.
134
135 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
136 @end defmac
137
138 @defmac OPTION_DEFAULT_SPECS
139 A list of specs used to support configure-time default options (i.e.@:
140 @option{--with} options) in the driver. It should be a suitable initializer
141 for an array of structures, each containing two strings, without the
142 outermost pair of surrounding braces.
143
144 The first item in the pair is the name of the default. This must match
145 the code in @file{config.gcc} for the target. The second item is a spec
146 to apply if a default with this name was specified. The string
147 @samp{%(VALUE)} in the spec will be replaced by the value of the default
148 everywhere it occurs.
149
150 The driver will apply these specs to its own command line between loading
151 default @file{specs} files and processing @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}, using
152 the same mechanism as @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}.
153
154 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
155 @end defmac
156
157 @defmac CPP_SPEC
158 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
159 pass to CPP@. It can also specify how to translate options you
160 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the CPP@.
161
162 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
163 @end defmac
164
165 @defmac CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
166 This macro is just like @code{CPP_SPEC}, but is used for C++, rather
167 than C@. If you do not define this macro, then the value of
168 @code{CPP_SPEC} (if any) will be used instead.
169 @end defmac
170
171 @defmac CC1_SPEC
172 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
173 pass to @code{cc1}, @code{cc1plus}, @code{f771}, and the other language
174 front ends.
175 It can also specify how to translate options you give to GCC into options
176 for GCC to pass to front ends.
177
178 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
179 @end defmac
180
181 @defmac CC1PLUS_SPEC
182 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
183 pass to @code{cc1plus}. It can also specify how to translate options you
184 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the @code{cc1plus}.
185
186 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
187 Note that everything defined in CC1_SPEC is already passed to
188 @code{cc1plus} so there is no need to duplicate the contents of
189 CC1_SPEC in CC1PLUS_SPEC@.
190 @end defmac
191
192 @defmac ASM_SPEC
193 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
194 pass to the assembler. It can also specify how to translate options
195 you give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the assembler.
196 See the file @file{sun3.h} for an example of this.
197
198 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
199 @end defmac
200
201 @defmac ASM_FINAL_SPEC
202 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program how to
203 run any programs which cleanup after the normal assembler.
204 Normally, this is not needed. See the file @file{mips.h} for
205 an example of this.
206
207 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
208 @end defmac
209
210 @defmac AS_NEEDS_DASH_FOR_PIPED_INPUT
211 Define this macro, with no value, if the driver should give the assembler
212 an argument consisting of a single dash, @option{-}, to instruct it to
213 read from its standard input (which will be a pipe connected to the
214 output of the compiler proper). This argument is given after any
215 @option{-o} option specifying the name of the output file.
216
217 If you do not define this macro, the assembler is assumed to read its
218 standard input if given no non-option arguments. If your assembler
219 cannot read standard input at all, use a @samp{%@{pipe:%e@}} construct;
220 see @file{mips.h} for instance.
221 @end defmac
222
223 @defmac LINK_SPEC
224 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
225 pass to the linker. It can also specify how to translate options you
226 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the linker.
227
228 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
229 @end defmac
230
231 @defmac LIB_SPEC
232 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The difference
233 between the two is that @code{LIB_SPEC} is used at the end of the
234 command given to the linker.
235
236 If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that
237 loads the standard C library from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
238 @end defmac
239
240 @defmac LIBGCC_SPEC
241 Another C string constant that tells the GCC driver program
242 how and when to place a reference to @file{libgcc.a} into the
243 linker command line. This constant is placed both before and after
244 the value of @code{LIB_SPEC}.
245
246 If this macro is not defined, the GCC driver provides a default that
247 passes the string @option{-lgcc} to the linker.
248 @end defmac
249
250 @defmac REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC
251 By default, if @code{ENABLE_SHARED_LIBGCC} is defined, the
252 @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} is not directly used by the driver program but is
253 instead modified to refer to different versions of @file{libgcc.a}
254 depending on the values of the command line flags @option{-static},
255 @option{-shared}, @option{-static-libgcc}, and @option{-shared-libgcc}. On
256 targets where these modifications are inappropriate, define
257 @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} instead. @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} tells the
258 driver how to place a reference to @file{libgcc} on the link command
259 line, but, unlike @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}, it is used unmodified.
260 @end defmac
261
262 @defmac USE_LD_AS_NEEDED
263 A macro that controls the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}
264 mentioned in @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}. If nonzero, a spec will be
265 generated that uses --as-needed and the shared libgcc in place of the
266 static exception handler library, when linking without any of
267 @code{-static}, @code{-static-libgcc}, or @code{-shared-libgcc}.
268 @end defmac
269
270 @defmac LINK_EH_SPEC
271 If defined, this C string constant is added to @code{LINK_SPEC}.
272 When @code{USE_LD_AS_NEEDED} is zero or undefined, it also affects
273 the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} mentioned in
274 @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}.
275 @end defmac
276
277 @defmac STARTFILE_SPEC
278 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
279 difference between the two is that @code{STARTFILE_SPEC} is used at
280 the very beginning of the command given to the linker.
281
282 If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that loads the
283 standard C startup file from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
284 @end defmac
285
286 @defmac ENDFILE_SPEC
287 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
288 difference between the two is that @code{ENDFILE_SPEC} is used at
289 the very end of the command given to the linker.
290
291 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
292 @end defmac
293
294 @defmac THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
295 GCC @code{-v} will print the thread model GCC was configured to use.
296 However, this doesn't work on platforms that are multilibbed on thread
297 models, such as AIX 4.3. On such platforms, define
298 @code{THREAD_MODEL_SPEC} such that it evaluates to a string without
299 blanks that names one of the recognized thread models. @code{%*}, the
300 default value of this macro, will expand to the value of
301 @code{thread_file} set in @file{config.gcc}.
302 @end defmac
303
304 @defmac SYSROOT_SUFFIX_SPEC
305 Define this macro to add a suffix to the target sysroot when GCC is
306 configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to search for usr/lib,
307 et al, within sysroot+suffix.
308 @end defmac
309
310 @defmac SYSROOT_HEADERS_SUFFIX_SPEC
311 Define this macro to add a headers_suffix to the target sysroot when
312 GCC is configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to pass the
313 updated sysroot+headers_suffix to CPP, causing it to search for
314 usr/include, et al, within sysroot+headers_suffix.
315 @end defmac
316
317 @defmac EXTRA_SPECS
318 Define this macro to provide additional specifications to put in the
319 @file{specs} file that can be used in various specifications like
320 @code{CC1_SPEC}.
321
322 The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures,
323 containing a string constant, that defines the specification name, and a
324 string constant that provides the specification.
325
326 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
327
328 @code{EXTRA_SPECS} is useful when an architecture contains several
329 related targets, which have various @code{@dots{}_SPECS} which are similar
330 to each other, and the maintainer would like one central place to keep
331 these definitions.
332
333 For example, the PowerPC System V.4 targets use @code{EXTRA_SPECS} to
334 define either @code{_CALL_SYSV} when the System V calling sequence is
335 used or @code{_CALL_AIX} when the older AIX-based calling sequence is
336 used.
337
338 The @file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h} target file defines:
339
340 @smallexample
341 #define EXTRA_SPECS \
342 @{ "cpp_sysv_default", CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT @},
343
344 #define CPP_SYS_DEFAULT ""
345 @end smallexample
346
347 The @file{config/rs6000/sysv.h} target file defines:
348 @smallexample
349 #undef CPP_SPEC
350 #define CPP_SPEC \
351 "%@{posix: -D_POSIX_SOURCE @} \
352 %@{mcall-sysv: -D_CALL_SYSV @} \
353 %@{!mcall-sysv: %(cpp_sysv_default) @} \
354 %@{msoft-float: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@} %@{mcpu=403: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@}"
355
356 #undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
357 #define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_SYSV"
358 @end smallexample
359
360 while the @file{config/rs6000/eabiaix.h} target file defines
361 @code{CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT} as:
362
363 @smallexample
364 #undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
365 #define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_AIX"
366 @end smallexample
367 @end defmac
368
369 @defmac LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
370 Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
371 @file{libgcc.a}. If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
372 the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search.
373 @end defmac
374
375 @defmac LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
376 The sequence in which libgcc and libc are specified to the linker.
377 By default this is @code{%G %L %G}.
378 @end defmac
379
380 @defmac LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
381 A C string constant giving the complete command line need to execute the
382 linker. When you do this, you will need to update your port each time a
383 change is made to the link command line within @file{gcc.c}. Therefore,
384 define this macro only if you need to completely redefine the command
385 line for invoking the linker and there is no other way to accomplish
386 the effect you need. Overriding this macro may be avoidable by overriding
387 @code{LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC} instead.
388 @end defmac
389
390 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALWAYS_STRIP_DOTDOT
391 True if @file{..} components should always be removed from directory names computed relative to GCC's internal directories, false (default) if such components should be preserved and directory names containing them passed to other tools such as the linker.
392 @end deftypevr
393
394 @defmac MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
395 Define this macro as a C expression for the initializer of an array of
396 string to tell the driver program which options are defaults for this
397 target and thus do not need to be handled specially when using
398 @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS}.
399
400 Do not define this macro if @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} is not defined in
401 the target makefile fragment or if none of the options listed in
402 @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} are set by default.
403 @xref{Target Fragment}.
404 @end defmac
405
406 @defmac RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
407 Define this macro to tell @command{gcc} that it should only translate
408 a @option{-B} prefix into a @option{-L} linker option if the prefix
409 indicates an absolute file name.
410 @end defmac
411
412 @defmac MD_EXEC_PREFIX
413 If defined, this macro is an additional prefix to try after
414 @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched
415 when the compiler is built as a cross
416 compiler. If you define @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, then be sure to add it
417 to the list of directories used to find the assembler in @file{configure.in}.
418 @end defmac
419
420 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
421 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
422 standard choice of @code{libdir} as the default prefix to
423 try when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
424 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX} is not searched when the compiler
425 is built as a cross compiler.
426 @end defmac
427
428 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
429 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
430 standard choice of @code{/lib} as a prefix to try after the default prefix
431 when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
432 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1} is not searched when the compiler
433 is built as a cross compiler.
434 @end defmac
435
436 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2
437 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
438 standard choice of @code{/lib} as yet another prefix to try after the
439 default prefix when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
440 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2} is not searched when the compiler
441 is built as a cross compiler.
442 @end defmac
443
444 @defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
445 If defined, this macro supplies an additional prefix to try after the
446 standard prefixes. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched when the
447 compiler is built as a cross compiler.
448 @end defmac
449
450 @defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
451 If defined, this macro supplies yet another prefix to try after the
452 standard prefixes. It is not searched when the compiler is built as a
453 cross compiler.
454 @end defmac
455
456 @defmac INIT_ENVIRONMENT
457 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to set environment
458 variables for programs called by the driver, such as the assembler and
459 loader. The driver passes the value of this macro to @code{putenv} to
460 initialize the necessary environment variables.
461 @end defmac
462
463 @defmac LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
464 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
465 standard choice of @file{/usr/local/include} as the default prefix to
466 try when searching for local header files. @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR}
467 comes before @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR} (set in
468 @file{config.gcc}, normally @file{/usr/include}) in the search order.
469
470 Cross compilers do not search either @file{/usr/local/include} or its
471 replacement.
472 @end defmac
473
474 @defmac NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_COMPONENT
475 The ``component'' corresponding to @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}.
476 See @code{INCLUDE_DEFAULTS}, below, for the description of components.
477 If you do not define this macro, no component is used.
478 @end defmac
479
480 @defmac INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
481 Define this macro if you wish to override the entire default search path
482 for include files. For a native compiler, the default search path
483 usually consists of @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR},
484 @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}, and
485 @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}. In addition, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}
486 and @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR} are defined automatically by @file{Makefile},
487 and specify private search areas for GCC@. The directory
488 @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} is used only for C++ programs.
489
490 The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures.
491 Each array element should have four elements: the directory name (a
492 string constant), the component name (also a string constant), a flag
493 for C++-only directories,
494 and a flag showing that the includes in the directory don't need to be
495 wrapped in @code{extern @samp{C}} when compiling C++. Mark the end of
496 the array with a null element.
497
498 The component name denotes what GNU package the include file is part of,
499 if any, in all uppercase letters. For example, it might be @samp{GCC}
500 or @samp{BINUTILS}. If the package is part of a vendor-supplied
501 operating system, code the component name as @samp{0}.
502
503 For example, here is the definition used for VAX/VMS:
504
505 @smallexample
506 #define INCLUDE_DEFAULTS \
507 @{ \
508 @{ "GNU_GXX_INCLUDE:", "G++", 1, 1@}, \
509 @{ "GNU_CC_INCLUDE:", "GCC", 0, 0@}, \
510 @{ "SYS$SYSROOT:[SYSLIB.]", 0, 0, 0@}, \
511 @{ ".", 0, 0, 0@}, \
512 @{ 0, 0, 0, 0@} \
513 @}
514 @end smallexample
515 @end defmac
516
517 Here is the order of prefixes tried for exec files:
518
519 @enumerate
520 @item
521 Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
522
523 @item
524 The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or, if @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}
525 is not set and the compiler has not been installed in the configure-time
526 @var{prefix}, the location in which the compiler has actually been installed.
527
528 @item
529 The directories specified by the environment variable @code{COMPILER_PATH}.
530
531 @item
532 The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if the compiler has been installed
533 in the configured-time @var{prefix}.
534
535 @item
536 The location @file{/usr/libexec/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
537
538 @item
539 The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
540
541 @item
542 The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
543 compiler.
544 @end enumerate
545
546 Here is the order of prefixes tried for startfiles:
547
548 @enumerate
549 @item
550 Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
551
552 @item
553 The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or its automatically determined
554 value based on the installed toolchain location.
555
556 @item
557 The directories specified by the environment variable @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
558 (or port-specific name; native only, cross compilers do not use this).
559
560 @item
561 The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, but only if the toolchain is installed
562 in the configured @var{prefix} or this is a native compiler.
563
564 @item
565 The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
566
567 @item
568 The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
569 compiler.
570
571 @item
572 The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a
573 native compiler, or we have a target system root.
574
575 @item
576 The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, if defined, but only if this is a
577 native compiler, or we have a target system root.
578
579 @item
580 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, with any sysroot modifications.
581 If this path is relative it will be prefixed by @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} and
582 the machine suffix or @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX} and the machine suffix.
583
584 @item
585 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, but only if this is a native
586 compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
587 @file{/lib/}.
588
589 @item
590 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2}, but only if this is a native
591 compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
592 @file{/usr/lib/}.
593 @end enumerate
594
595 @node Run-time Target
596 @section Run-time Target Specification
597 @cindex run-time target specification
598 @cindex predefined macros
599 @cindex target specifications
600
601 @c prevent bad page break with this line
602 Here are run-time target specifications.
603
604 @defmac TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS ()
605 This function-like macro expands to a block of code that defines
606 built-in preprocessor macros and assertions for the target CPU, using
607 the functions @code{builtin_define}, @code{builtin_define_std} and
608 @code{builtin_assert}. When the front end
609 calls this macro it provides a trailing semicolon, and since it has
610 finished command line option processing your code can use those
611 results freely.
612
613 @code{builtin_assert} takes a string in the form you pass to the
614 command-line option @option{-A}, such as @code{cpu=mips}, and creates
615 the assertion. @code{builtin_define} takes a string in the form
616 accepted by option @option{-D} and unconditionally defines the macro.
617
618 @code{builtin_define_std} takes a string representing the name of an
619 object-like macro. If it doesn't lie in the user's namespace,
620 @code{builtin_define_std} defines it unconditionally. Otherwise, it
621 defines a version with two leading underscores, and another version
622 with two leading and trailing underscores, and defines the original
623 only if an ISO standard was not requested on the command line. For
624 example, passing @code{unix} defines @code{__unix}, @code{__unix__}
625 and possibly @code{unix}; passing @code{_mips} defines @code{__mips},
626 @code{__mips__} and possibly @code{_mips}, and passing @code{_ABI64}
627 defines only @code{_ABI64}.
628
629 You can also test for the C dialect being compiled. The variable
630 @code{c_language} is set to one of @code{clk_c}, @code{clk_cplusplus}
631 or @code{clk_objective_c}. Note that if we are preprocessing
632 assembler, this variable will be @code{clk_c} but the function-like
633 macro @code{preprocessing_asm_p()} will return true, so you might want
634 to check for that first. If you need to check for strict ANSI, the
635 variable @code{flag_iso} can be used. The function-like macro
636 @code{preprocessing_trad_p()} can be used to check for traditional
637 preprocessing.
638 @end defmac
639
640 @defmac TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS ()
641 Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
642 and is used for the target operating system instead.
643 @end defmac
644
645 @defmac TARGET_OBJFMT_CPP_BUILTINS ()
646 Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
647 and is used for the target object format. @file{elfos.h} uses this
648 macro to define @code{__ELF__}, so you probably do not need to define
649 it yourself.
650 @end defmac
651
652 @deftypevar {extern int} target_flags
653 This variable is declared in @file{options.h}, which is included before
654 any target-specific headers.
655 @end deftypevar
656
657 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} int TARGET_DEFAULT_TARGET_FLAGS
658 This variable specifies the initial value of @code{target_flags}.
659 Its default setting is 0.
660 @end deftypevr
661
662 @cindex optional hardware or system features
663 @cindex features, optional, in system conventions
664
665 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION (struct gcc_options *@var{opts}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts_set}, const struct cl_decoded_option *@var{decoded}, location_t @var{loc})
666 This hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
667 target-specific options described by the @file{.opt} definition files
668 (@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some option-specific
669 processing and should return true if the option is valid. The default
670 definition does nothing but return true.
671
672 @var{decoded} specifies the option and its arguments. @var{opts} and
673 @var{opts_set} are the @code{gcc_options} structures to be used for
674 storing option state, and @var{loc} is the location at which the
675 option was passed (@code{UNKNOWN_LOCATION} except for options passed
676 via attributes).
677 @end deftypefn
678
679 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION (size_t @var{code}, const char *@var{arg}, int @var{value})
680 This target hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
681 target-specific C language family options described by the @file{.opt}
682 definition files(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some
683 option-specific processing and should return true if the option is
684 valid. The arguments are like for @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION}. The
685 default definition does nothing but return false.
686
687 In general, you should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION} to handle
688 options. However, if processing an option requires routines that are
689 only available in the C (and related language) front ends, then you
690 should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION} instead.
691 @end deftypefn
692
693 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} tree TARGET_OBJC_CONSTRUCT_STRING_OBJECT (tree @var{string})
694 Targets may provide a string object type that can be used within and between C, C++ and their respective Objective-C dialects. A string object might, for example, embed encoding and length information. These objects are considered opaque to the compiler and handled as references. An ideal implementation makes the composition of the string object match that of the Objective-C @code{NSString} (@code{NXString} for GNUStep), allowing efficient interworking between C-only and Objective-C code. If a target implements string objects then this hook should return a reference to such an object constructed from the normal `C' string representation provided in @var{string}. At present, the hook is used by Objective-C only, to obtain a common-format string object when the target provides one.
695 @end deftypefn
696
697 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_OBJC_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_CLASS_REFERENCE (const char *@var{classname})
698 Declare that Objective C class @var{classname} is referenced by the current TU.
699 @end deftypefn
700
701 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_OBJC_DECLARE_CLASS_DEFINITION (const char *@var{classname})
702 Declare that Objective C class @var{classname} is defined by the current TU.
703 @end deftypefn
704
705 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_STRING_OBJECT_REF_TYPE_P (const_tree @var{stringref})
706 If a target implements string objects then this hook should return @code{true} if @var{stringref} is a valid reference to such an object.
707 @end deftypefn
708
709 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_CHECK_STRING_OBJECT_FORMAT_ARG (tree @var{format_arg}, tree @var{args_list})
710 If a target implements string objects then this hook should should provide a facility to check the function arguments in @var{args_list} against the format specifiers in @var{format_arg} where the type of @var{format_arg} is one recognized as a valid string reference type.
711 @end deftypefn
712
713 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE (void)
714 This target function is similar to the hook @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}
715 but is called when the optimize level is changed via an attribute or
716 pragma or when it is reset at the end of the code affected by the
717 attribute or pragma. It is not called at the beginning of compilation
718 when @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} is called so if you want to perform these
719 actions then, you should have @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} call
720 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}.
721 @end deftypefn
722
723 @defmac C_COMMON_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
724 This is similar to the @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} hook
725 but is only used in the C
726 language frontends (C, Objective-C, C++, Objective-C++) and so can be
727 used to alter option flag variables which only exist in those
728 frontends.
729 @end defmac
730
731 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} {const struct default_options *} TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION_TABLE
732 Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for
733 various optimization levels. This variable, if defined, describes
734 options to enable at particular sets of optimization levels. These
735 options are processed once
736 just after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder
737 of the command options have been parsed, so may be overridden by other
738 options passed explicitly.
739
740 This processing is run once at program startup and when the optimization
741 options are changed via @code{#pragma GCC optimize} or by using the
742 @code{optimize} attribute.
743 @end deftypevr
744
745 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_INIT_STRUCT (struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
746 Set target-dependent initial values of fields in @var{opts}.
747 @end deftypefn
748
749 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_DEFAULT_PARAMS (void)
750 Set target-dependent default values for @option{--param} settings, using calls to @code{set_default_param_value}.
751 @end deftypefn
752
753 @defmac SWITCHABLE_TARGET
754 Some targets need to switch between substantially different subtargets
755 during compilation. For example, the MIPS target has one subtarget for
756 the traditional MIPS architecture and another for MIPS16. Source code
757 can switch between these two subarchitectures using the @code{mips16}
758 and @code{nomips16} attributes.
759
760 Such subtargets can differ in things like the set of available
761 registers, the set of available instructions, the costs of various
762 operations, and so on. GCC caches a lot of this type of information
763 in global variables, and recomputing them for each subtarget takes a
764 significant amount of time. The compiler therefore provides a facility
765 for maintaining several versions of the global variables and quickly
766 switching between them; see @file{target-globals.h} for details.
767
768 Define this macro to 1 if your target needs this facility. The default
769 is 0.
770 @end defmac
771
772 @node Per-Function Data
773 @section Defining data structures for per-function information.
774 @cindex per-function data
775 @cindex data structures
776
777 If the target needs to store information on a per-function basis, GCC
778 provides a macro and a couple of variables to allow this. Note, just
779 using statics to store the information is a bad idea, since GCC supports
780 nested functions, so you can be halfway through encoding one function
781 when another one comes along.
782
783 GCC defines a data structure called @code{struct function} which
784 contains all of the data specific to an individual function. This
785 structure contains a field called @code{machine} whose type is
786 @code{struct machine_function *}, which can be used by targets to point
787 to their own specific data.
788
789 If a target needs per-function specific data it should define the type
790 @code{struct machine_function} and also the macro @code{INIT_EXPANDERS}.
791 This macro should be used to initialize the function pointer
792 @code{init_machine_status}. This pointer is explained below.
793
794 One typical use of per-function, target specific data is to create an
795 RTX to hold the register containing the function's return address. This
796 RTX can then be used to implement the @code{__builtin_return_address}
797 function, for level 0.
798
799 Note---earlier implementations of GCC used a single data area to hold
800 all of the per-function information. Thus when processing of a nested
801 function began the old per-function data had to be pushed onto a
802 stack, and when the processing was finished, it had to be popped off the
803 stack. GCC used to provide function pointers called
804 @code{save_machine_status} and @code{restore_machine_status} to handle
805 the saving and restoring of the target specific information. Since the
806 single data area approach is no longer used, these pointers are no
807 longer supported.
808
809 @defmac INIT_EXPANDERS
810 Macro called to initialize any target specific information. This macro
811 is called once per function, before generation of any RTL has begun.
812 The intention of this macro is to allow the initialization of the
813 function pointer @code{init_machine_status}.
814 @end defmac
815
816 @deftypevar {void (*)(struct function *)} init_machine_status
817 If this function pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per
818 function, before function compilation starts, in order to allow the
819 target to perform any target specific initialization of the
820 @code{struct function} structure. It is intended that this would be
821 used to initialize the @code{machine} of that structure.
822
823 @code{struct machine_function} structures are expected to be freed by GC@.
824 Generally, any memory that they reference must be allocated by using
825 GC allocation, including the structure itself.
826 @end deftypevar
827
828 @node Storage Layout
829 @section Storage Layout
830 @cindex storage layout
831
832 Note that the definitions of the macros in this table which are sizes or
833 alignments measured in bits do not need to be constant. They can be C
834 expressions that refer to static variables, such as the @code{target_flags}.
835 @xref{Run-time Target}.
836
837 @defmac BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
838 Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant bit in a
839 byte has the lowest number; otherwise define it to have the value zero.
840 This means that bit-field instructions count from the most significant
841 bit. If the machine has no bit-field instructions, then this must still
842 be defined, but it doesn't matter which value it is defined to. This
843 macro need not be a constant.
844
845 This macro does not affect the way structure fields are packed into
846 bytes or words; that is controlled by @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN}.
847 @end defmac
848
849 @defmac BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
850 Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant byte in a
851 word has the lowest number. This macro need not be a constant.
852 @end defmac
853
854 @defmac WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
855 Define this macro to have the value 1 if, in a multiword object, the
856 most significant word has the lowest number. This applies to both
857 memory locations and registers; see @code{REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} if the
858 order of words in memory is not the same as the order in registers. This
859 macro need not be a constant.
860 @end defmac
861
862 @defmac REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
863 On some machines, the order of words in a multiword object differs between
864 registers in memory. In such a situation, define this macro to describe
865 the order of words in a register. The macro @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} controls
866 the order of words in memory.
867 @end defmac
868
869 @defmac FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
870 Define this macro to have the value 1 if @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} or
871 @code{TFmode} floating point numbers are stored in memory with the word
872 containing the sign bit at the lowest address; otherwise define it to
873 have the value 0. This macro need not be a constant.
874
875 You need not define this macro if the ordering is the same as for
876 multi-word integers.
877 @end defmac
878
879 @defmac BITS_PER_UNIT
880 Define this macro to be the number of bits in an addressable storage
881 unit (byte). If you do not define this macro the default is 8.
882 @end defmac
883
884 @defmac BITS_PER_WORD
885 Number of bits in a word. If you do not define this macro, the default
886 is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * UNITS_PER_WORD}.
887 @end defmac
888
889 @defmac MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
890 Maximum number of bits in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
891 @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
892 largest value that @code{BITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
893 @end defmac
894
895 @defmac UNITS_PER_WORD
896 Number of storage units in a word; normally the size of a general-purpose
897 register, a power of two from 1 or 8.
898 @end defmac
899
900 @defmac MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
901 Minimum number of units in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
902 @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
903 smallest value that @code{UNITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
904 @end defmac
905
906 @defmac POINTER_SIZE
907 Width of a pointer, in bits. You must specify a value no wider than the
908 width of @code{Pmode}. If it is not equal to the width of @code{Pmode},
909 you must define @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED}. If you do not specify
910 a value the default is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
911 @end defmac
912
913 @defmac POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
914 A C expression that determines how pointers should be extended from
915 @code{ptr_mode} to either @code{Pmode} or @code{word_mode}. It is
916 greater than zero if pointers should be zero-extended, zero if they
917 should be sign-extended, and negative if some other sort of conversion
918 is needed. In the last case, the extension is done by the target's
919 @code{ptr_extend} instruction.
920
921 You need not define this macro if the @code{ptr_mode}, @code{Pmode}
922 and @code{word_mode} are all the same width.
923 @end defmac
924
925 @defmac PROMOTE_MODE (@var{m}, @var{unsignedp}, @var{type})
926 A macro to update @var{m} and @var{unsignedp} when an object whose type
927 is @var{type} and which has the specified mode and signedness is to be
928 stored in a register. This macro is only called when @var{type} is a
929 scalar type.
930
931 On most RISC machines, which only have operations that operate on a full
932 register, define this macro to set @var{m} to @code{word_mode} if
933 @var{m} is an integer mode narrower than @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. In most
934 cases, only integer modes should be widened because wider-precision
935 floating-point operations are usually more expensive than their narrower
936 counterparts.
937
938 For most machines, the macro definition does not change @var{unsignedp}.
939 However, some machines, have instructions that preferentially handle
940 either signed or unsigned quantities of certain modes. For example, on
941 the DEC Alpha, 32-bit loads from memory and 32-bit add instructions
942 sign-extend the result to 64 bits. On such machines, set
943 @var{unsignedp} according to which kind of extension is more efficient.
944
945 Do not define this macro if it would never modify @var{m}.
946 @end defmac
947
948 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE (const_tree @var{type}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, int *@var{punsignedp}, const_tree @var{funtype}, int @var{for_return})
949 Like @code{PROMOTE_MODE}, but it is applied to outgoing function arguments or
950 function return values. The target hook should return the new mode
951 and possibly change @code{*@var{punsignedp}} if the promotion should
952 change signedness. This function is called only for scalar @emph{or
953 pointer} types.
954
955 @var{for_return} allows to distinguish the promotion of arguments and
956 return values. If it is @code{1}, a return value is being promoted and
957 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must perform the same promotions done here.
958 If it is @code{2}, the returned mode should be that of the register in
959 which an incoming parameter is copied, or the outgoing result is computed;
960 then the hook should return the same mode as @code{promote_mode}, though
961 the signedness may be different.
962
963 @var{type} can be NULL when promoting function arguments of libcalls.
964
965 The default is to not promote arguments and return values. You can
966 also define the hook to @code{default_promote_function_mode_always_promote}
967 if you would like to apply the same rules given by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}.
968 @end deftypefn
969
970 @defmac PARM_BOUNDARY
971 Normal alignment required for function parameters on the stack, in
972 bits. All stack parameters receive at least this much alignment
973 regardless of data type. On most machines, this is the same as the
974 size of an integer.
975 @end defmac
976
977 @defmac STACK_BOUNDARY
978 Define this macro to the minimum alignment enforced by hardware for the
979 stack pointer on this machine. The definition is a C expression for the
980 desired alignment (measured in bits). This value is used as a default
981 if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is not defined. On most machines,
982 this should be the same as @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.
983 @end defmac
984
985 @defmac PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
986 Define this macro if you wish to preserve a certain alignment for the
987 stack pointer, greater than what the hardware enforces. The definition
988 is a C expression for the desired alignment (measured in bits). This
989 macro must evaluate to a value equal to or larger than
990 @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
991 @end defmac
992
993 @defmac INCOMING_STACK_BOUNDARY
994 Define this macro if the incoming stack boundary may be different
995 from @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}. This macro must evaluate
996 to a value equal to or larger than @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
997 @end defmac
998
999 @defmac FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
1000 Alignment required for a function entry point, in bits.
1001 @end defmac
1002
1003 @defmac BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1004 Biggest alignment that any data type can require on this machine, in
1005 bits. Note that this is not the biggest alignment that is supported,
1006 just the biggest alignment that, when violated, may cause a fault.
1007 @end defmac
1008
1009 @defmac MALLOC_ABI_ALIGNMENT
1010 Alignment, in bits, a C conformant malloc implementation has to
1011 provide. If not defined, the default value is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
1012 @end defmac
1013
1014 @defmac ATTRIBUTE_ALIGNED_VALUE
1015 Alignment used by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned))} construct. If
1016 not defined, the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1017 @end defmac
1018
1019 @defmac MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
1020 If defined, the smallest alignment, in bits, that can be given to an
1021 object that can be referenced in one operation, without disturbing any
1022 nearby object. Normally, this is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}, but may be larger
1023 on machines that don't have byte or half-word store operations.
1024 @end defmac
1025
1026 @defmac BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
1027 Biggest alignment that any structure or union field can require on this
1028 machine, in bits. If defined, this overrides @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} for
1029 structure and union fields only, unless the field alignment has been set
1030 by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1031 @end defmac
1032
1033 @defmac ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN (@var{field}, @var{computed})
1034 An expression for the alignment of a structure field @var{field} if the
1035 alignment computed in the usual way (including applying of
1036 @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} and @code{BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT} to the
1037 alignment) is @var{computed}. It overrides alignment only if the
1038 field alignment has not been set by the
1039 @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1040 @end defmac
1041
1042 @defmac MAX_STACK_ALIGNMENT
1043 Biggest stack alignment guaranteed by the backend. Use this macro
1044 to specify the maximum alignment of a variable on stack.
1045
1046 If not defined, the default value is @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1047
1048 @c FIXME: The default should be @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1049 @c But the fix for PR 32893 indicates that we can only guarantee
1050 @c maximum stack alignment on stack up to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, not
1051 @c @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}, if stack alignment isn't supported.
1052 @end defmac
1053
1054 @defmac MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
1055 Biggest alignment supported by the object file format of this machine.
1056 Use this macro to limit the alignment which can be specified using the
1057 @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct. If not defined,
1058 the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1059
1060 On systems that use ELF, the default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is
1061 the largest supported 32-bit ELF section alignment representable on
1062 a 32-bit host e.g. @samp{(((unsigned HOST_WIDEST_INT) 1 << 28) * 8)}.
1063 On 32-bit ELF the largest supported section alignment in bits is
1064 @samp{(0x80000000 * 8)}, but this is not representable on 32-bit hosts.
1065 @end defmac
1066
1067 @defmac DATA_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1068 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1069 the static store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1070 the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1071 macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1072
1073 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1074
1075 @findex strcpy
1076 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1077 make it all fit in fewer cache lines. Another is to cause character
1078 arrays to be word-aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1079 constants to character arrays can be done inline.
1080 @end defmac
1081
1082 @defmac CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT (@var{constant}, @var{basic-align})
1083 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment given to a constant
1084 that is being placed in memory. @var{constant} is the constant and
1085 @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the object would ordinarily
1086 have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1087 align the object.
1088
1089 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1090
1091 The typical use of this macro is to increase alignment for string
1092 constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1093 constants can be done inline.
1094 @end defmac
1095
1096 @defmac LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1097 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1098 the local store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1099 the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1100 macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1101
1102 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1103
1104 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1105 make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1106
1107 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1108 @end defmac
1109
1110 @deftypefn {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT (const_tree @var{type})
1111 This hook can be used to define the alignment for a vector of type
1112 @var{type}, in order to comply with a platform ABI. The default is to
1113 require natural alignment for vector types. The alignment returned by
1114 this hook must be a power-of-two multiple of the default alignment of
1115 the vector element type.
1116 @end deftypefn
1117
1118 @defmac STACK_SLOT_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{mode}, @var{basic-align})
1119 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for stack slot.
1120 @var{type} is the data type, @var{mode} is the widest mode available,
1121 and @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the slot would ordinarily
1122 have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1123 align the slot.
1124
1125 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used when
1126 @var{type} is @code{NULL}. Otherwise, @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT} will
1127 be used.
1128
1129 This macro is to set alignment of stack slot to the maximum alignment
1130 of all possible modes which the slot may have.
1131
1132 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1133 @end defmac
1134
1135 @defmac LOCAL_DECL_ALIGNMENT (@var{decl})
1136 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a local
1137 variable @var{decl}.
1138
1139 If this macro is not defined, then
1140 @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (TREE_TYPE (@var{decl}), DECL_ALIGN (@var{decl}))}
1141 is used.
1142
1143 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1144 make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1145
1146 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1147 @end defmac
1148
1149 @defmac MINIMUM_ALIGNMENT (@var{exp}, @var{mode}, @var{align})
1150 If defined, a C expression to compute the minimum required alignment
1151 for dynamic stack realignment purposes for @var{exp} (a type or decl),
1152 @var{mode}, assuming normal alignment @var{align}.
1153
1154 If this macro is not defined, then @var{align} will be used.
1155 @end defmac
1156
1157 @defmac EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
1158 Alignment in bits to be given to a structure bit-field that follows an
1159 empty field such as @code{int : 0;}.
1160
1161 If @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true, it overrides this macro.
1162 @end defmac
1163
1164 @defmac STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
1165 Number of bits which any structure or union's size must be a multiple of.
1166 Each structure or union's size is rounded up to a multiple of this.
1167
1168 If you do not define this macro, the default is the same as
1169 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1170 @end defmac
1171
1172 @defmac STRICT_ALIGNMENT
1173 Define this macro to be the value 1 if instructions will fail to work
1174 if given data not on the nominal alignment. If instructions will merely
1175 go slower in that case, define this macro as 0.
1176 @end defmac
1177
1178 @defmac PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
1179 Define this if you wish to imitate the way many other C compilers handle
1180 alignment of bit-fields and the structures that contain them.
1181
1182 The behavior is that the type written for a named bit-field (@code{int},
1183 @code{short}, or other integer type) imposes an alignment for the entire
1184 structure, as if the structure really did contain an ordinary field of
1185 that type. In addition, the bit-field is placed within the structure so
1186 that it would fit within such a field, not crossing a boundary for it.
1187
1188 Thus, on most machines, a named bit-field whose type is written as
1189 @code{int} would not cross a four-byte boundary, and would force
1190 four-byte alignment for the whole structure. (The alignment used may
1191 not be four bytes; it is controlled by the other alignment parameters.)
1192
1193 An unnamed bit-field will not affect the alignment of the containing
1194 structure.
1195
1196 If the macro is defined, its definition should be a C expression;
1197 a nonzero value for the expression enables this behavior.
1198
1199 Note that if this macro is not defined, or its value is zero, some
1200 bit-fields may cross more than one alignment boundary. The compiler can
1201 support such references if there are @samp{insv}, @samp{extv}, and
1202 @samp{extzv} insns that can directly reference memory.
1203
1204 The other known way of making bit-fields work is to define
1205 @code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} as large as @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1206 Then every structure can be accessed with fullwords.
1207
1208 Unless the machine has bit-field instructions or you define
1209 @code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} that way, you must define
1210 @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} to have a nonzero value.
1211
1212 If your aim is to make GCC use the same conventions for laying out
1213 bit-fields as are used by another compiler, here is how to investigate
1214 what the other compiler does. Compile and run this program:
1215
1216 @smallexample
1217 struct foo1
1218 @{
1219 char x;
1220 char :0;
1221 char y;
1222 @};
1223
1224 struct foo2
1225 @{
1226 char x;
1227 int :0;
1228 char y;
1229 @};
1230
1231 main ()
1232 @{
1233 printf ("Size of foo1 is %d\n",
1234 sizeof (struct foo1));
1235 printf ("Size of foo2 is %d\n",
1236 sizeof (struct foo2));
1237 exit (0);
1238 @}
1239 @end smallexample
1240
1241 If this prints 2 and 5, then the compiler's behavior is what you would
1242 get from @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS}.
1243 @end defmac
1244
1245 @defmac BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
1246 Like @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} except that its effect is limited
1247 to aligning a bit-field within the structure.
1248 @end defmac
1249
1250 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALIGN_ANON_BITFIELD (void)
1251 When @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true this hook will determine
1252 whether unnamed bitfields affect the alignment of the containing
1253 structure. The hook should return true if the structure should inherit
1254 the alignment requirements of an unnamed bitfield's type.
1255 @end deftypefn
1256
1257 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NARROW_VOLATILE_BITFIELD (void)
1258 This target hook should return @code{true} if accesses to volatile bitfields
1259 should use the narrowest mode possible. It should return @code{false} if
1260 these accesses should use the bitfield container type.
1261
1262 The default is @code{!TARGET_STRICT_ALIGN}.
1263 @end deftypefn
1264
1265 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK (const_tree @var{field}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
1266 Return true if a structure, union or array containing @var{field} should
1267 be accessed using @code{BLKMODE}.
1268
1269 If @var{field} is the only field in the structure, @var{mode} is its
1270 mode, otherwise @var{mode} is VOIDmode. @var{mode} is provided in the
1271 case where structures of one field would require the structure's mode to
1272 retain the field's mode.
1273
1274 Normally, this is not needed.
1275 @end deftypefn
1276
1277 @defmac ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1278 Define this macro as an expression for the alignment of a type (given
1279 by @var{type} as a tree node) if the alignment computed in the usual
1280 way is @var{computed} and the alignment explicitly specified was
1281 @var{specified}.
1282
1283 The default is to use @var{specified} if it is larger; otherwise, use
1284 the smaller of @var{computed} and @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
1285 @end defmac
1286
1287 @defmac MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
1288 An integer expression for the size in bits of the largest integer
1289 machine mode that should actually be used. All integer machine modes of
1290 this size or smaller can be used for structures and unions with the
1291 appropriate sizes. If this macro is undefined, @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE
1292 (DImode)} is assumed.
1293 @end defmac
1294
1295 @defmac STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE (@var{save_level})
1296 If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1297 specifies the mode of the save area operand of a
1298 @code{save_stack_@var{level}} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1299 @var{save_level} is one of @code{SAVE_BLOCK}, @code{SAVE_FUNCTION}, or
1300 @code{SAVE_NONLOCAL} and selects which of the three named patterns is
1301 having its mode specified.
1302
1303 You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{Pmode}. You
1304 would most commonly define this macro if the
1305 @code{save_stack_@var{level}} patterns need to support both a 32- and a
1306 64-bit mode.
1307 @end defmac
1308
1309 @defmac STACK_SIZE_MODE
1310 If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1311 specifies the mode of the size increment operand of an
1312 @code{allocate_stack} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1313
1314 You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{word_mode}.
1315 You would most commonly define this macro if the @code{allocate_stack}
1316 pattern needs to support both a 32- and a 64-bit mode.
1317 @end defmac
1318
1319 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_LIBGCC_CMP_RETURN_MODE (void)
1320 This target hook should return the mode to be used for the return value
1321 of compare instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1322 @code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1323 targets.
1324 @end deftypefn
1325
1326 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_LIBGCC_SHIFT_COUNT_MODE (void)
1327 This target hook should return the mode to be used for the shift count operand
1328 of shift instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1329 @code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1330 targets.
1331 @end deftypefn
1332
1333 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_UNWIND_WORD_MODE (void)
1334 Return machine mode to be used for @code{_Unwind_Word} type.
1335 The default is to use @code{word_mode}.
1336 @end deftypefn
1337
1338 @defmac ROUND_TOWARDS_ZERO
1339 If defined, this macro should be true if the prevailing rounding
1340 mode is towards zero.
1341
1342 Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1343 floating-point arithmetic.
1344
1345 Not defining this macro is equivalent to returning zero.
1346 @end defmac
1347
1348 @defmac LARGEST_EXPONENT_IS_NORMAL (@var{size})
1349 This macro should return true if floats with @var{size}
1350 bits do not have a NaN or infinity representation, but use the largest
1351 exponent for normal numbers instead.
1352
1353 Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1354 floating-point arithmetic.
1355
1356 The default definition of this macro returns false for all sizes.
1357 @end defmac
1358
1359 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MS_BITFIELD_LAYOUT_P (const_tree @var{record_type})
1360 This target hook returns @code{true} if bit-fields in the given
1361 @var{record_type} are to be laid out following the rules of Microsoft
1362 Visual C/C++, namely: (i) a bit-field won't share the same storage
1363 unit with the previous bit-field if their underlying types have
1364 different sizes, and the bit-field will be aligned to the highest
1365 alignment of the underlying types of itself and of the previous
1366 bit-field; (ii) a zero-sized bit-field will affect the alignment of
1367 the whole enclosing structure, even if it is unnamed; except that
1368 (iii) a zero-sized bit-field will be disregarded unless it follows
1369 another bit-field of nonzero size. If this hook returns @code{true},
1370 other macros that control bit-field layout are ignored.
1371
1372 When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
1373 of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
1374 bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
1375 and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
1376 chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that
1377 size is allocated). In an unpacked record, this is the same as using
1378 alignment, but not equivalent when packing.
1379
1380 If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
1381 the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
1382 used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
1383 precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
1384 may affect its placement.
1385 @end deftypefn
1386
1387 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DECIMAL_FLOAT_SUPPORTED_P (void)
1388 Returns true if the target supports decimal floating point.
1389 @end deftypefn
1390
1391 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FIXED_POINT_SUPPORTED_P (void)
1392 Returns true if the target supports fixed-point arithmetic.
1393 @end deftypefn
1394
1395 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXPAND_TO_RTL_HOOK (void)
1396 This hook is called just before expansion into rtl, allowing the target
1397 to perform additional initializations or analysis before the expansion.
1398 For example, the rs6000 port uses it to allocate a scratch stack slot
1399 for use in copying SDmode values between memory and floating point
1400 registers whenever the function being expanded has any SDmode
1401 usage.
1402 @end deftypefn
1403
1404 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSTANTIATE_DECLS (void)
1405 This hook allows the backend to perform additional instantiations on rtl
1406 that are not actually in any insns yet, but will be later.
1407 @end deftypefn
1408
1409 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_MANGLE_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
1410 If your target defines any fundamental types, or any types your target
1411 uses should be mangled differently from the default, define this hook
1412 to return the appropriate encoding for these types as part of a C++
1413 mangled name. The @var{type} argument is the tree structure representing
1414 the type to be mangled. The hook may be applied to trees which are
1415 not target-specific fundamental types; it should return @code{NULL}
1416 for all such types, as well as arguments it does not recognize. If the
1417 return value is not @code{NULL}, it must point to a statically-allocated
1418 string constant.
1419
1420 Target-specific fundamental types might be new fundamental types or
1421 qualified versions of ordinary fundamental types. Encode new
1422 fundamental types as @samp{@w{u @var{n} @var{name}}}, where @var{name}
1423 is the name used for the type in source code, and @var{n} is the
1424 length of @var{name} in decimal. Encode qualified versions of
1425 ordinary types as @samp{@w{U @var{n} @var{name} @var{code}}}, where
1426 @var{name} is the name used for the type qualifier in source code,
1427 @var{n} is the length of @var{name} as above, and @var{code} is the
1428 code used to represent the unqualified version of this type. (See
1429 @code{write_builtin_type} in @file{cp/mangle.c} for the list of
1430 codes.) In both cases the spaces are for clarity; do not include any
1431 spaces in your string.
1432
1433 This hook is applied to types prior to typedef resolution. If the mangled
1434 name for a particular type depends only on that type's main variant, you
1435 can perform typedef resolution yourself using @code{TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT}
1436 before mangling.
1437
1438 The default version of this hook always returns @code{NULL}, which is
1439 appropriate for a target that does not define any new fundamental
1440 types.
1441 @end deftypefn
1442
1443 @node Type Layout
1444 @section Layout of Source Language Data Types
1445
1446 These macros define the sizes and other characteristics of the standard
1447 basic data types used in programs being compiled. Unlike the macros in
1448 the previous section, these apply to specific features of C and related
1449 languages, rather than to fundamental aspects of storage layout.
1450
1451 @defmac INT_TYPE_SIZE
1452 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the
1453 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1454 @end defmac
1455
1456 @defmac SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
1457 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short} on the
1458 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is half a word.
1459 (If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up to one
1460 unit.)
1461 @end defmac
1462
1463 @defmac LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1464 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1465 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1466 @end defmac
1467
1468 @defmac ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1469 On some machines, the size used for the Ada equivalent of the type
1470 @code{long} by a native Ada compiler differs from that used by C@. In
1471 that situation, define this macro to be a C expression to be used for
1472 the size of that type. If you don't define this, the default is the
1473 value of @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}.
1474 @end defmac
1475
1476 @defmac LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1477 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long} on the
1478 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1479 words. If you want to support GNU Ada on your machine, the value of this
1480 macro must be at least 64.
1481 @end defmac
1482
1483 @defmac CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1484 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
1485 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1486 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1487 @end defmac
1488
1489 @defmac BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
1490 A C expression for the size in bits of the C++ type @code{bool} and
1491 C99 type @code{_Bool} on the target machine. If you don't define
1492 this, and you probably shouldn't, the default is @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.
1493 @end defmac
1494
1495 @defmac FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
1496 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{float} on the
1497 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1498 @end defmac
1499
1500 @defmac DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1501 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{double} on the
1502 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1503 words.
1504 @end defmac
1505
1506 @defmac LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1507 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on
1508 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1509 words.
1510 @end defmac
1511
1512 @defmac SHORT_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1513 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Fract} on
1514 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1515 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1516 @end defmac
1517
1518 @defmac FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1519 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Fract} on
1520 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1521 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1522 @end defmac
1523
1524 @defmac LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1525 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Fract} on
1526 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1527 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1528 @end defmac
1529
1530 @defmac LONG_LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1531 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Fract} on
1532 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1533 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1534 @end defmac
1535
1536 @defmac SHORT_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1537 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Accum} on
1538 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1539 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1540 @end defmac
1541
1542 @defmac ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1543 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Accum} on
1544 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1545 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1546 @end defmac
1547
1548 @defmac LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1549 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Accum} on
1550 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1551 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1552 @end defmac
1553
1554 @defmac LONG_LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1555 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Accum} on
1556 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1557 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 16}.
1558 @end defmac
1559
1560 @defmac LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1561 Define this macro if @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not constant or
1562 if you want routines in @file{libgcc2.a} for a size other than
1563 @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}. If you don't define this, the
1564 default is @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1565 @end defmac
1566
1567 @defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_DF_MODE
1568 Define this macro if neither @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} nor
1569 @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is
1570 @code{DFmode} but you want @code{DFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1571 anyway. If you don't define this and either @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1572 or @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64 then the default is 1,
1573 otherwise it is 0.
1574 @end defmac
1575
1576 @defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_XF_MODE
1577 Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1578 @code{XFmode} but you want @code{XFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1579 anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1580 is 80 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1581 @end defmac
1582
1583 @defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_TF_MODE
1584 Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1585 @code{TFmode} but you want @code{TFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1586 anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1587 is 128 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1588 @end defmac
1589
1590 @defmac LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX
1591 This macro corresponds to the @code{TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX} target
1592 hook and should be defined if that hook is overriden to be true. It
1593 causes function names in libgcc to be changed to use a @code{__gnu_}
1594 prefix for their name rather than the default @code{__}. A port which
1595 uses this macro should also arrange to use @file{t-gnu-prefix} in
1596 the libgcc @file{config.host}.
1597 @end defmac
1598
1599 @defmac SF_SIZE
1600 @defmacx DF_SIZE
1601 @defmacx XF_SIZE
1602 @defmacx TF_SIZE
1603 Define these macros to be the size in bits of the mantissa of
1604 @code{SFmode}, @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode} values,
1605 if the defaults in @file{libgcc2.h} are inappropriate. By default,
1606 @code{FLT_MANT_DIG} is used for @code{SF_SIZE}, @code{LDBL_MANT_DIG}
1607 for @code{XF_SIZE} and @code{TF_SIZE}, and @code{DBL_MANT_DIG} or
1608 @code{LDBL_MANT_DIG} for @code{DF_SIZE} according to whether
1609 @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} or
1610 @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64.
1611 @end defmac
1612
1613 @defmac TARGET_FLT_EVAL_METHOD
1614 A C expression for the value for @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} in @file{float.h},
1615 assuming, if applicable, that the floating-point control word is in its
1616 default state. If you do not define this macro the value of
1617 @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} will be zero.
1618 @end defmac
1619
1620 @defmac WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
1621 A C expression for the size in bits of the widest floating-point format
1622 supported by the hardware. If you define this macro, you must specify a
1623 value less than or equal to the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1624 If you do not define this macro, the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1625 is the default.
1626 @end defmac
1627
1628 @defmac DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
1629 An expression whose value is 1 or 0, according to whether the type
1630 @code{char} should be signed or unsigned by default. The user can
1631 always override this default with the options @option{-fsigned-char}
1632 and @option{-funsigned-char}.
1633 @end defmac
1634
1635 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS (void)
1636 This target hook should return true if the compiler should give an
1637 @code{enum} type only as many bytes as it takes to represent the range
1638 of possible values of that type. It should return false if all
1639 @code{enum} types should be allocated like @code{int}.
1640
1641 The default is to return false.
1642 @end deftypefn
1643
1644 @defmac SIZE_TYPE
1645 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1646 for size values. The typedef name @code{size_t} is defined using the
1647 contents of the string.
1648
1649 The string can contain more than one keyword. If so, separate them with
1650 spaces, and write first any length keyword, then @code{unsigned} if
1651 appropriate, and finally @code{int}. The string must exactly match one
1652 of the data type names defined in the function
1653 @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins} in the file @file{c-family/c-common.c}.
1654 You may not omit @code{int} or change the order---that would cause the
1655 compiler to crash on startup.
1656
1657 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long unsigned
1658 int"}.
1659 @end defmac
1660
1661 @defmac SIZETYPE
1662 GCC defines internal types (@code{sizetype}, @code{ssizetype},
1663 @code{bitsizetype} and @code{sbitsizetype}) for expressions
1664 dealing with size. This macro is a C expression for a string describing
1665 the name of the data type from which the precision of @code{sizetype}
1666 is extracted.
1667
1668 The string has the same restrictions as @code{SIZE_TYPE} string.
1669
1670 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{SIZE_TYPE}.
1671 @end defmac
1672
1673 @defmac PTRDIFF_TYPE
1674 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1675 for the result of subtracting two pointers. The typedef name
1676 @code{ptrdiff_t} is defined using the contents of the string. See
1677 @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1678
1679 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long int"}.
1680 @end defmac
1681
1682 @defmac WCHAR_TYPE
1683 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1684 for wide characters. The typedef name @code{wchar_t} is defined using
1685 the contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1686 information.
1687
1688 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"int"}.
1689 @end defmac
1690
1691 @defmac WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1692 A C expression for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1693 characters. This is used in @code{cpp}, which cannot make use of
1694 @code{WCHAR_TYPE}.
1695 @end defmac
1696
1697 @defmac WINT_TYPE
1698 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to
1699 use for wide characters passed to @code{printf} and returned from
1700 @code{getwc}. The typedef name @code{wint_t} is defined using the
1701 contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1702 information.
1703
1704 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"unsigned int"}.
1705 @end defmac
1706
1707 @defmac INTMAX_TYPE
1708 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1709 can represent any value of any standard or extended signed integer type.
1710 The typedef name @code{intmax_t} is defined using the contents of the
1711 string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1712
1713 If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1714 @code{"int"}, @code{"long int"}, or @code{"long long int"} that has as
1715 much precision as @code{long long int}.
1716 @end defmac
1717
1718 @defmac UINTMAX_TYPE
1719 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1720 can represent any value of any standard or extended unsigned integer
1721 type. The typedef name @code{uintmax_t} is defined using the contents
1722 of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1723
1724 If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1725 @code{"unsigned int"}, @code{"long unsigned int"}, or @code{"long long
1726 unsigned int"} that has as much precision as @code{long long unsigned
1727 int}.
1728 @end defmac
1729
1730 @defmac SIG_ATOMIC_TYPE
1731 @defmacx INT8_TYPE
1732 @defmacx INT16_TYPE
1733 @defmacx INT32_TYPE
1734 @defmacx INT64_TYPE
1735 @defmacx UINT8_TYPE
1736 @defmacx UINT16_TYPE
1737 @defmacx UINT32_TYPE
1738 @defmacx UINT64_TYPE
1739 @defmacx INT_LEAST8_TYPE
1740 @defmacx INT_LEAST16_TYPE
1741 @defmacx INT_LEAST32_TYPE
1742 @defmacx INT_LEAST64_TYPE
1743 @defmacx UINT_LEAST8_TYPE
1744 @defmacx UINT_LEAST16_TYPE
1745 @defmacx UINT_LEAST32_TYPE
1746 @defmacx UINT_LEAST64_TYPE
1747 @defmacx INT_FAST8_TYPE
1748 @defmacx INT_FAST16_TYPE
1749 @defmacx INT_FAST32_TYPE
1750 @defmacx INT_FAST64_TYPE
1751 @defmacx UINT_FAST8_TYPE
1752 @defmacx UINT_FAST16_TYPE
1753 @defmacx UINT_FAST32_TYPE
1754 @defmacx UINT_FAST64_TYPE
1755 @defmacx INTPTR_TYPE
1756 @defmacx UINTPTR_TYPE
1757 C expressions for the standard types @code{sig_atomic_t},
1758 @code{int8_t}, @code{int16_t}, @code{int32_t}, @code{int64_t},
1759 @code{uint8_t}, @code{uint16_t}, @code{uint32_t}, @code{uint64_t},
1760 @code{int_least8_t}, @code{int_least16_t}, @code{int_least32_t},
1761 @code{int_least64_t}, @code{uint_least8_t}, @code{uint_least16_t},
1762 @code{uint_least32_t}, @code{uint_least64_t}, @code{int_fast8_t},
1763 @code{int_fast16_t}, @code{int_fast32_t}, @code{int_fast64_t},
1764 @code{uint_fast8_t}, @code{uint_fast16_t}, @code{uint_fast32_t},
1765 @code{uint_fast64_t}, @code{intptr_t}, and @code{uintptr_t}. See
1766 @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1767
1768 If any of these macros evaluates to a null pointer, the corresponding
1769 type is not supported; if GCC is configured to provide
1770 @code{<stdint.h>} in such a case, the header provided may not conform
1771 to C99, depending on the type in question. The defaults for all of
1772 these macros are null pointers.
1773 @end defmac
1774
1775 @defmac TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
1776 The C++ compiler represents a pointer-to-member-function with a struct
1777 that looks like:
1778
1779 @smallexample
1780 struct @{
1781 union @{
1782 void (*fn)();
1783 ptrdiff_t vtable_index;
1784 @};
1785 ptrdiff_t delta;
1786 @};
1787 @end smallexample
1788
1789 @noindent
1790 The C++ compiler must use one bit to indicate whether the function that
1791 will be called through a pointer-to-member-function is virtual.
1792 Normally, we assume that the low-order bit of a function pointer must
1793 always be zero. Then, by ensuring that the vtable_index is odd, we can
1794 distinguish which variant of the union is in use. But, on some
1795 platforms function pointers can be odd, and so this doesn't work. In
1796 that case, we use the low-order bit of the @code{delta} field, and shift
1797 the remainder of the @code{delta} field to the left.
1798
1799 GCC will automatically make the right selection about where to store
1800 this bit using the @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY} setting for your platform.
1801 However, some platforms such as ARM/Thumb have @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}
1802 set such that functions always start at even addresses, but the lowest
1803 bit of pointers to functions indicate whether the function at that
1804 address is in ARM or Thumb mode. If this is the case of your
1805 architecture, you should define this macro to
1806 @code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_delta}.
1807
1808 In general, you should not have to define this macro. On architectures
1809 in which function addresses are always even, according to
1810 @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}, GCC will automatically define this macro to
1811 @code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_pfn}.
1812 @end defmac
1813
1814 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
1815 Normally, the C++ compiler uses function pointers in vtables. This
1816 macro allows the target to change to use ``function descriptors''
1817 instead. Function descriptors are found on targets for whom a
1818 function pointer is actually a small data structure. Normally the
1819 data structure consists of the actual code address plus a data
1820 pointer to which the function's data is relative.
1821
1822 If vtables are used, the value of this macro should be the number
1823 of words that the function descriptor occupies.
1824 @end defmac
1825
1826 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN
1827 By default, the vtable entries are void pointers, the so the alignment
1828 is the same as pointer alignment. The value of this macro specifies
1829 the alignment of the vtable entry in bits. It should be defined only
1830 when special alignment is necessary. */
1831 @end defmac
1832
1833 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_DATA_ENTRY_DISTANCE
1834 There are a few non-descriptor entries in the vtable at offsets below
1835 zero. If these entries must be padded (say, to preserve the alignment
1836 specified by @code{TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN}), set this to the number
1837 of words in each data entry.
1838 @end defmac
1839
1840 @node Registers
1841 @section Register Usage
1842 @cindex register usage
1843
1844 This section explains how to describe what registers the target machine
1845 has, and how (in general) they can be used.
1846
1847 The description of which registers a specific instruction can use is
1848 done with register classes; see @ref{Register Classes}. For information
1849 on using registers to access a stack frame, see @ref{Frame Registers}.
1850 For passing values in registers, see @ref{Register Arguments}.
1851 For returning values in registers, see @ref{Scalar Return}.
1852
1853 @menu
1854 * Register Basics:: Number and kinds of registers.
1855 * Allocation Order:: Order in which registers are allocated.
1856 * Values in Registers:: What kinds of values each reg can hold.
1857 * Leaf Functions:: Renumbering registers for leaf functions.
1858 * Stack Registers:: Handling a register stack such as 80387.
1859 @end menu
1860
1861 @node Register Basics
1862 @subsection Basic Characteristics of Registers
1863
1864 @c prevent bad page break with this line
1865 Registers have various characteristics.
1866
1867 @defmac FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1868 Number of hardware registers known to the compiler. They receive
1869 numbers 0 through @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER-1}; thus, the first
1870 pseudo register's number really is assigned the number
1871 @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
1872 @end defmac
1873
1874 @defmac FIXED_REGISTERS
1875 @cindex fixed register
1876 An initializer that says which registers are used for fixed purposes
1877 all throughout the compiled code and are therefore not available for
1878 general allocation. These would include the stack pointer, the frame
1879 pointer (except on machines where that can be used as a general
1880 register when no frame pointer is needed), the program counter on
1881 machines where that is considered one of the addressable registers,
1882 and any other numbered register with a standard use.
1883
1884 This information is expressed as a sequence of numbers, separated by
1885 commas and surrounded by braces. The @var{n}th number is 1 if
1886 register @var{n} is fixed, 0 otherwise.
1887
1888 The table initialized from this macro, and the table initialized by
1889 the following one, may be overridden at run time either automatically,
1890 by the actions of the macro @code{CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}, or by
1891 the user with the command options @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1892 @option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}.
1893 @end defmac
1894
1895 @defmac CALL_USED_REGISTERS
1896 @cindex call-used register
1897 @cindex call-clobbered register
1898 @cindex call-saved register
1899 Like @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} but has 1 for each register that is
1900 clobbered (in general) by function calls as well as for fixed
1901 registers. This macro therefore identifies the registers that are not
1902 available for general allocation of values that must live across
1903 function calls.
1904
1905 If a register has 0 in @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, the compiler
1906 automatically saves it on function entry and restores it on function
1907 exit, if the register is used within the function.
1908 @end defmac
1909
1910 @defmac CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
1911 @cindex call-used register
1912 @cindex call-clobbered register
1913 @cindex call-saved register
1914 Like @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} except this macro doesn't require
1915 that the entire set of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} be included.
1916 (@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} must be a superset of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}).
1917 This macro is optional. If not specified, it defaults to the value
1918 of @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}.
1919 @end defmac
1920
1921 @defmac HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1922 @cindex call-used register
1923 @cindex call-clobbered register
1924 @cindex call-saved register
1925 A C expression that is nonzero if it is not permissible to store a
1926 value of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} across a
1927 call without some part of it being clobbered. For most machines this
1928 macro need not be defined. It is only required for machines that do not
1929 preserve the entire contents of a register across a call.
1930 @end defmac
1931
1932 @findex fixed_regs
1933 @findex call_used_regs
1934 @findex global_regs
1935 @findex reg_names
1936 @findex reg_class_contents
1937 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE (void)
1938 This hook may conditionally modify five variables
1939 @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}, @code{global_regs},
1940 @code{reg_names}, and @code{reg_class_contents}, to take into account
1941 any dependence of these register sets on target flags. The first three
1942 of these are of type @code{char []} (interpreted as Boolean vectors).
1943 @code{global_regs} is a @code{const char *[]}, and
1944 @code{reg_class_contents} is a @code{HARD_REG_SET}. Before the macro is
1945 called, @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs},
1946 @code{reg_class_contents}, and @code{reg_names} have been initialized
1947 from @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS},
1948 @code{REG_CLASS_CONTENTS}, and @code{REGISTER_NAMES}, respectively.
1949 @code{global_regs} has been cleared, and any @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1950 @option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}
1951 command options have been applied.
1952
1953 @cindex disabling certain registers
1954 @cindex controlling register usage
1955 If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target
1956 flags, you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify
1957 @code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} to 1 for each of the
1958 registers in the classes which should not be used by GCC@. Also define
1959 the macro @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} / @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
1960 to return @code{NO_REGS} if it
1961 is called with a letter for a class that shouldn't be used.
1962
1963 (However, if this class is not included in @code{GENERAL_REGS} and all
1964 of the insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are
1965 controlled by target switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using
1966 these registers when the target switches are opposed to them.)
1967 @end deftypefn
1968
1969 @defmac INCOMING_REGNO (@var{out})
1970 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1971 expression returns the register number as seen by the called function
1972 corresponding to the register number @var{out} as seen by the calling
1973 function. Return @var{out} if register number @var{out} is not an
1974 outbound register.
1975 @end defmac
1976
1977 @defmac OUTGOING_REGNO (@var{in})
1978 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1979 expression returns the register number as seen by the calling function
1980 corresponding to the register number @var{in} as seen by the called
1981 function. Return @var{in} if register number @var{in} is not an inbound
1982 register.
1983 @end defmac
1984
1985 @defmac LOCAL_REGNO (@var{regno})
1986 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1987 expression returns true if the register is call-saved but is in the
1988 register window. Unlike most call-saved registers, such registers
1989 need not be explicitly restored on function exit or during non-local
1990 gotos.
1991 @end defmac
1992
1993 @defmac PC_REGNUM
1994 If the program counter has a register number, define this as that
1995 register number. Otherwise, do not define it.
1996 @end defmac
1997
1998 @node Allocation Order
1999 @subsection Order of Allocation of Registers
2000 @cindex order of register allocation
2001 @cindex register allocation order
2002
2003 @c prevent bad page break with this line
2004 Registers are allocated in order.
2005
2006 @defmac REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2007 If defined, an initializer for a vector of integers, containing the
2008 numbers of hard registers in the order in which GCC should prefer
2009 to use them (from most preferred to least).
2010
2011 If this macro is not defined, registers are used lowest numbered first
2012 (all else being equal).
2013
2014 One use of this macro is on machines where the highest numbered
2015 registers must always be saved and the save-multiple-registers
2016 instruction supports only sequences of consecutive registers. On such
2017 machines, define @code{REG_ALLOC_ORDER} to be an initializer that lists
2018 the highest numbered allocable register first.
2019 @end defmac
2020
2021 @defmac ADJUST_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2022 A C statement (sans semicolon) to choose the order in which to allocate
2023 hard registers for pseudo-registers local to a basic block.
2024
2025 Store the desired register order in the array @code{reg_alloc_order}.
2026 Element 0 should be the register to allocate first; element 1, the next
2027 register; and so on.
2028
2029 The macro body should not assume anything about the contents of
2030 @code{reg_alloc_order} before execution of the macro.
2031
2032 On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2033 @end defmac
2034
2035 @defmac HONOR_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2036 Normally, IRA tries to estimate the costs for saving a register in the
2037 prologue and restoring it in the epilogue. This discourages it from
2038 using call-saved registers. If a machine wants to ensure that IRA
2039 allocates registers in the order given by REG_ALLOC_ORDER even if some
2040 call-saved registers appear earlier than call-used ones, this macro
2041 should be defined.
2042 @end defmac
2043
2044 @defmac IRA_HARD_REGNO_ADD_COST_MULTIPLIER (@var{regno})
2045 In some case register allocation order is not enough for the
2046 Integrated Register Allocator (@acronym{IRA}) to generate a good code.
2047 If this macro is defined, it should return a floating point value
2048 based on @var{regno}. The cost of using @var{regno} for a pseudo will
2049 be increased by approximately the pseudo's usage frequency times the
2050 value returned by this macro. Not defining this macro is equivalent
2051 to having it always return @code{0.0}.
2052
2053 On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2054 @end defmac
2055
2056 @node Values in Registers
2057 @subsection How Values Fit in Registers
2058
2059 This section discusses the macros that describe which kinds of values
2060 (specifically, which machine modes) each register can hold, and how many
2061 consecutive registers are needed for a given mode.
2062
2063 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2064 A C expression for the number of consecutive hard registers, starting
2065 at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode
2066 @var{mode}. This macro must never return zero, even if a register
2067 cannot hold the requested mode - indicate that with HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK
2068 and/or CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS instead.
2069
2070 On a machine where all registers are exactly one word, a suitable
2071 definition of this macro is
2072
2073 @smallexample
2074 #define HARD_REGNO_NREGS(REGNO, MODE) \
2075 ((GET_MODE_SIZE (MODE) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) \
2076 / UNITS_PER_WORD)
2077 @end smallexample
2078 @end defmac
2079
2080 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2081 A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode @var{mode}, stored
2082 in memory, ends with padding that causes it to take up more space than
2083 in registers starting at register number @var{regno} (as determined by
2084 multiplying GCC's notion of the size of the register when containing
2085 this mode by the number of registers returned by
2086 @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}). By default this is zero.
2087
2088 For example, if a floating-point value is stored in three 32-bit
2089 registers but takes up 128 bits in memory, then this would be
2090 nonzero.
2091
2092 This macros only needs to be defined if there are cases where
2093 @code{subreg_get_info}
2094 would otherwise wrongly determine that a @code{subreg} can be
2095 represented by an offset to the register number, when in fact such a
2096 @code{subreg} would contain some of the padding not stored in
2097 registers and so not be representable.
2098 @end defmac
2099
2100 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_WITH_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2101 For values of @var{regno} and @var{mode} for which
2102 @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING} returns nonzero, a C expression
2103 returning the greater number of registers required to hold the value
2104 including any padding. In the example above, the value would be four.
2105 @end defmac
2106
2107 @defmac REGMODE_NATURAL_SIZE (@var{mode})
2108 Define this macro if the natural size of registers that hold values
2109 of mode @var{mode} is not the word size. It is a C expression that
2110 should give the natural size in bytes for the specified mode. It is
2111 used by the register allocator to try to optimize its results. This
2112 happens for example on SPARC 64-bit where the natural size of
2113 floating-point registers is still 32-bit.
2114 @end defmac
2115
2116 @defmac HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2117 A C expression that is nonzero if it is permissible to store a value
2118 of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several
2119 registers starting with that one). For a machine where all registers
2120 are equivalent, a suitable definition is
2121
2122 @smallexample
2123 #define HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK(REGNO, MODE) 1
2124 @end smallexample
2125
2126 You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers,
2127 because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied.
2128
2129 @cindex register pairs
2130 On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd
2131 register pairs. You can implement that by defining this macro to reject
2132 odd register numbers for such modes.
2133
2134 The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
2135 @samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the
2136 register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a
2137 value into the register and back out not alter it.
2138
2139 Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for
2140 all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for
2141 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} to distinguish between these modes, provided
2142 you define patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this. This
2143 is useful because of the interaction between @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}
2144 and @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer modes
2145 to be tieable.
2146
2147 Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic.
2148 Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only
2149 in floating point registers. This is not true. Any registers that
2150 can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine
2151 mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those
2152 registers. Integer move instructions can be used to move the values.
2153
2154 On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine
2155 modes may not go in floating registers. This is true if the floating
2156 registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a
2157 non-floating value there would garble it. In this case,
2158 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in
2159 floating registers. But if the floating registers do not automatically
2160 normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it
2161 unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating
2162 register, so you can define this macro to say so.
2163
2164 The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that
2165 they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic
2166 instructions. However, this is of no concern to
2167 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}. You handle it by writing the proper
2168 constraints for those instructions.
2169
2170 On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access,
2171 so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a
2172 register if floating point arithmetic is not being done. As long as the
2173 floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not
2174 be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one.
2175 @end defmac
2176
2177 @defmac HARD_REGNO_RENAME_OK (@var{from}, @var{to})
2178 A C expression that is nonzero if it is OK to rename a hard register
2179 @var{from} to another hard register @var{to}.
2180
2181 One common use of this macro is to prevent renaming of a register to
2182 another register that is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt
2183 handler.
2184
2185 The default is always nonzero.
2186 @end defmac
2187
2188 @defmac MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})
2189 A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode
2190 @var{mode1} is accessible in mode @var{mode2} without copying.
2191
2192 If @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and
2193 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always the same for
2194 any @var{r}, then @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})}
2195 should be nonzero. If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define
2196 this macro to return zero unless some other mechanism ensures the
2197 accessibility of the value in a narrower mode.
2198
2199 You should define this macro to return nonzero in as many cases as
2200 possible since doing so will allow GCC to perform better register
2201 allocation.
2202 @end defmac
2203
2204 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HARD_REGNO_SCRATCH_OK (unsigned int @var{regno})
2205 This target hook should return @code{true} if it is OK to use a hard register
2206 @var{regno} as scratch reg in peephole2.
2207
2208 One common use of this macro is to prevent using of a register that
2209 is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt handler.
2210
2211 The default version of this hook always returns @code{true}.
2212 @end deftypefn
2213
2214 @defmac AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
2215 Define this macro if the compiler should avoid copies to/from @code{CCmode}
2216 registers. You should only define this macro if support for copying to/from
2217 @code{CCmode} is incomplete.
2218 @end defmac
2219
2220 @node Leaf Functions
2221 @subsection Handling Leaf Functions
2222
2223 @cindex leaf functions
2224 @cindex functions, leaf
2225 On some machines, a leaf function (i.e., one which makes no calls) can run
2226 more efficiently if it does not make its own register window. Often this
2227 means it is required to receive its arguments in the registers where they
2228 are passed by the caller, instead of the registers where they would
2229 normally arrive.
2230
2231 The special treatment for leaf functions generally applies only when
2232 other conditions are met; for example, often they may use only those
2233 registers for its own variables and temporaries. We use the term ``leaf
2234 function'' to mean a function that is suitable for this special
2235 handling, so that functions with no calls are not necessarily ``leaf
2236 functions''.
2237
2238 GCC assigns register numbers before it knows whether the function is
2239 suitable for leaf function treatment. So it needs to renumber the
2240 registers in order to output a leaf function. The following macros
2241 accomplish this.
2242
2243 @defmac LEAF_REGISTERS
2244 Name of a char vector, indexed by hard register number, which
2245 contains 1 for a register that is allowable in a candidate for leaf
2246 function treatment.
2247
2248 If leaf function treatment involves renumbering the registers, then the
2249 registers marked here should be the ones before renumbering---those that
2250 GCC would ordinarily allocate. The registers which will actually be
2251 used in the assembler code, after renumbering, should not be marked with 1
2252 in this vector.
2253
2254 Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize
2255 the treatment of leaf functions.
2256 @end defmac
2257
2258 @defmac LEAF_REG_REMAP (@var{regno})
2259 A C expression whose value is the register number to which @var{regno}
2260 should be renumbered, when a function is treated as a leaf function.
2261
2262 If @var{regno} is a register number which should not appear in a leaf
2263 function before renumbering, then the expression should yield @minus{}1, which
2264 will cause the compiler to abort.
2265
2266 Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize the
2267 treatment of leaf functions, and registers need to be renumbered to do
2268 this.
2269 @end defmac
2270
2271 @findex current_function_is_leaf
2272 @findex current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
2273 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
2274 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must usually treat leaf functions
2275 specially. They can test the C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf}
2276 which is nonzero for leaf functions. @code{current_function_is_leaf} is
2277 set prior to local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
2278 compiler passes. They can also test the C variable
2279 @code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} which is nonzero for leaf
2280 functions which only use leaf registers.
2281 @code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} is valid after all passes
2282 that modify the instructions have been run and is only useful if
2283 @code{LEAF_REGISTERS} is defined.
2284 @c changed this to fix overfull. ALSO: why the "it" at the beginning
2285 @c of the next paragraph?! --mew 2feb93
2286
2287 @node Stack Registers
2288 @subsection Registers That Form a Stack
2289
2290 There are special features to handle computers where some of the
2291 ``registers'' form a stack. Stack registers are normally written by
2292 pushing onto the stack, and are numbered relative to the top of the
2293 stack.
2294
2295 Currently, GCC can only handle one group of stack-like registers, and
2296 they must be consecutively numbered. Furthermore, the existing
2297 support for stack-like registers is specific to the 80387 floating
2298 point coprocessor. If you have a new architecture that uses
2299 stack-like registers, you will need to do substantial work on
2300 @file{reg-stack.c} and write your machine description to cooperate
2301 with it, as well as defining these macros.
2302
2303 @defmac STACK_REGS
2304 Define this if the machine has any stack-like registers.
2305 @end defmac
2306
2307 @defmac STACK_REG_COVER_CLASS
2308 This is a cover class containing the stack registers. Define this if
2309 the machine has any stack-like registers.
2310 @end defmac
2311
2312 @defmac FIRST_STACK_REG
2313 The number of the first stack-like register. This one is the top
2314 of the stack.
2315 @end defmac
2316
2317 @defmac LAST_STACK_REG
2318 The number of the last stack-like register. This one is the bottom of
2319 the stack.
2320 @end defmac
2321
2322 @node Register Classes
2323 @section Register Classes
2324 @cindex register class definitions
2325 @cindex class definitions, register
2326
2327 On many machines, the numbered registers are not all equivalent.
2328 For example, certain registers may not be allowed for indexed addressing;
2329 certain registers may not be allowed in some instructions. These machine
2330 restrictions are described to the compiler using @dfn{register classes}.
2331
2332 You define a number of register classes, giving each one a name and saying
2333 which of the registers belong to it. Then you can specify register classes
2334 that are allowed as operands to particular instruction patterns.
2335
2336 @findex ALL_REGS
2337 @findex NO_REGS
2338 In general, each register will belong to several classes. In fact, one
2339 class must be named @code{ALL_REGS} and contain all the registers. Another
2340 class must be named @code{NO_REGS} and contain no registers. Often the
2341 union of two classes will be another class; however, this is not required.
2342
2343 @findex GENERAL_REGS
2344 One of the classes must be named @code{GENERAL_REGS}. There is nothing
2345 terribly special about the name, but the operand constraint letters
2346 @samp{r} and @samp{g} specify this class. If @code{GENERAL_REGS} is
2347 the same as @code{ALL_REGS}, just define it as a macro which expands
2348 to @code{ALL_REGS}.
2349
2350 Order the classes so that if class @var{x} is contained in class @var{y}
2351 then @var{x} has a lower class number than @var{y}.
2352
2353 The way classes other than @code{GENERAL_REGS} are specified in operand
2354 constraints is through machine-dependent operand constraint letters.
2355 You can define such letters to correspond to various classes, then use
2356 them in operand constraints.
2357
2358 You must define the narrowest register classes for allocatable
2359 registers, so that each class either has no subclasses, or that for
2360 some mode, the move cost between registers within the class is
2361 cheaper than moving a register in the class to or from memory
2362 (@pxref{Costs}).
2363
2364 You should define a class for the union of two classes whenever some
2365 instruction allows both classes. For example, if an instruction allows
2366 either a floating point (coprocessor) register or a general register for a
2367 certain operand, you should define a class @code{FLOAT_OR_GENERAL_REGS}
2368 which includes both of them. Otherwise you will get suboptimal code,
2369 or even internal compiler errors when reload cannot find a register in the
2370 class computed via @code{reg_class_subunion}.
2371
2372 You must also specify certain redundant information about the register
2373 classes: for each class, which classes contain it and which ones are
2374 contained in it; for each pair of classes, the largest class contained
2375 in their union.
2376
2377 When a value occupying several consecutive registers is expected in a
2378 certain class, all the registers used must belong to that class.
2379 Therefore, register classes cannot be used to enforce a requirement for
2380 a register pair to start with an even-numbered register. The way to
2381 specify this requirement is with @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.
2382
2383 Register classes used for input-operands of bitwise-and or shift
2384 instructions have a special requirement: each such class must have, for
2385 each fixed-point machine mode, a subclass whose registers can transfer that
2386 mode to or from memory. For example, on some machines, the operations for
2387 single-byte values (@code{QImode}) are limited to certain registers. When
2388 this is so, each register class that is used in a bitwise-and or shift
2389 instruction must have a subclass consisting of registers from which
2390 single-byte values can be loaded or stored. This is so that
2391 @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} can always have a possible value to return.
2392
2393 @deftp {Data type} {enum reg_class}
2394 An enumerated type that must be defined with all the register class names
2395 as enumerated values. @code{NO_REGS} must be first. @code{ALL_REGS}
2396 must be the last register class, followed by one more enumerated value,
2397 @code{LIM_REG_CLASSES}, which is not a register class but rather
2398 tells how many classes there are.
2399
2400 Each register class has a number, which is the value of casting
2401 the class name to type @code{int}. The number serves as an index
2402 in many of the tables described below.
2403 @end deftp
2404
2405 @defmac N_REG_CLASSES
2406 The number of distinct register classes, defined as follows:
2407
2408 @smallexample
2409 #define N_REG_CLASSES (int) LIM_REG_CLASSES
2410 @end smallexample
2411 @end defmac
2412
2413 @defmac REG_CLASS_NAMES
2414 An initializer containing the names of the register classes as C string
2415 constants. These names are used in writing some of the debugging dumps.
2416 @end defmac
2417
2418 @defmac REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
2419 An initializer containing the contents of the register classes, as integers
2420 which are bit masks. The @var{n}th integer specifies the contents of class
2421 @var{n}. The way the integer @var{mask} is interpreted is that
2422 register @var{r} is in the class if @code{@var{mask} & (1 << @var{r})} is 1.
2423
2424 When the machine has more than 32 registers, an integer does not suffice.
2425 Then the integers are replaced by sub-initializers, braced groupings containing
2426 several integers. Each sub-initializer must be suitable as an initializer
2427 for the type @code{HARD_REG_SET} which is defined in @file{hard-reg-set.h}.
2428 In this situation, the first integer in each sub-initializer corresponds to
2429 registers 0 through 31, the second integer to registers 32 through 63, and
2430 so on.
2431 @end defmac
2432
2433 @defmac REGNO_REG_CLASS (@var{regno})
2434 A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard register
2435 @var{regno}. In general there is more than one such class; choose a class
2436 which is @dfn{minimal}, meaning that no smaller class also contains the
2437 register.
2438 @end defmac
2439
2440 @defmac BASE_REG_CLASS
2441 A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2442 base register must belong. A base register is one used in an address
2443 which is the register value plus a displacement.
2444 @end defmac
2445
2446 @defmac MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2447 This is a variation of the @code{BASE_REG_CLASS} macro which allows
2448 the selection of a base register in a mode dependent manner. If
2449 @var{mode} is VOIDmode then it should return the same value as
2450 @code{BASE_REG_CLASS}.
2451 @end defmac
2452
2453 @defmac MODE_BASE_REG_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2454 A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2455 base register must belong in order to be used in a base plus index
2456 register address. You should define this macro if base plus index
2457 addresses have different requirements than other base register uses.
2458 @end defmac
2459
2460 @defmac MODE_CODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{address_space}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2461 A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2462 base register for a memory reference in mode @var{mode} to address
2463 space @var{address_space} must belong. @var{outer_code} and @var{index_code}
2464 define the context in which the base register occurs. @var{outer_code} is
2465 the code of the immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} for the top level
2466 of an address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2467 @code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the corresponding
2468 index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS}; @code{SCRATCH} otherwise.
2469 @end defmac
2470
2471 @defmac INDEX_REG_CLASS
2472 A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2473 index register must belong. An index register is one used in an
2474 address where its value is either multiplied by a scale factor or
2475 added to another register (as well as added to a displacement).
2476 @end defmac
2477
2478 @defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num})
2479 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2480 suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses.
2481 @end defmac
2482
2483 @defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2484 A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
2485 that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
2486 @var{mode}. You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
2487 reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register. If
2488 you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
2489 @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for
2490 addresses that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an
2491 @code{address_operand}.
2492 @end defmac
2493
2494 @defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_REG_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2495 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is suitable for
2496 use as a base register in base plus index operand addresses, accessing
2497 memory in mode @var{mode}. It may be either a suitable hard register or a
2498 pseudo register that has been allocated such a hard register. You should
2499 define this macro if base plus index addresses have different requirements
2500 than other base register uses.
2501
2502 Use of this macro is deprecated; please use the more general
2503 @code{REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
2504 @end defmac
2505
2506 @defmac REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode}, @var{address_space}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2507 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2508 suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses, accessing
2509 memory in mode @var{mode} in address space @var{address_space}.
2510 This is similar to @code{REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except
2511 that that expression may examine the context in which the register
2512 appears in the memory reference. @var{outer_code} is the code of the
2513 immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} if at the top level of the
2514 address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2515 @code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the
2516 corresponding index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS};
2517 @code{SCRATCH} otherwise. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for addresses
2518 that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an @code{address_operand}.
2519 @end defmac
2520
2521 @defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{num})
2522 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2523 suitable for use as an index register in operand addresses. It may be
2524 either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2525 allocated such a hard register.
2526
2527 The difference between an index register and a base register is that
2528 the index register may be scaled. If an address involves the sum of
2529 two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
2530 labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
2531 labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
2532 may serve in each capacity. The compiler will try both labelings,
2533 looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
2534 only if neither labeling works.
2535 @end defmac
2536
2537 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_RENAME_CLASS (reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2538 A target hook that places additional preference on the register class to use when it is necessary to rename a register in class @var{rclass} to another class, or perhaps @var{NO_REGS}, if no preferred register class is found or hook @code{preferred_rename_class} is not implemented. Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For example, on ARM, thumb-2 instructions using @code{LO_REGS} may be smaller than instructions using @code{GENERIC_REGS}. By returning @code{LO_REGS} from @code{preferred_rename_class}, code size can be reduced.
2539 @end deftypefn
2540
2541 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2542 A target hook that places additional restrictions on the register class
2543 to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2544 @var{rclass}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{rclass}, or perhaps
2545 another, smaller class.
2546
2547 The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass} argument.
2548
2549 Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2550 example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2551 for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2552 @code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{rclass} includes the data registers.
2553 Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2554
2555 One case where @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2556 @var{rclass} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2557 loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2558 force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2559 immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2560 instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2561 register, so @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2562 @var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2563 into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2564 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2565 of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2566
2567 If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2568 through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2569 to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2570 reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2571 this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2572 the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2573 @end deftypefn
2574
2575 @defmac PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2576 A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2577 to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2578 @var{class}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps
2579 another, smaller class. On many machines, the following definition is
2580 safe:
2581
2582 @smallexample
2583 #define PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS(X,CLASS) CLASS
2584 @end smallexample
2585
2586 Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2587 example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2588 for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2589 @code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{class} includes the data registers.
2590 Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2591
2592 One case where @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2593 @var{class} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2594 loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2595 force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2596 immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2597 instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2598 register, so @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2599 @var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2600 into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2601 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2602 of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2603
2604 If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2605 through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2606 to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2607 reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2608 this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2609 the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2610 @end defmac
2611
2612 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2613 Like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2614 input reloads.
2615
2616 The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass}
2617 argument.
2618
2619 You can also use @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2620 reload from using some alternatives, like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2621 @end deftypefn
2622
2623 @defmac LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{class})
2624 A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2625 to use when it is necessary to be able to hold a value of mode
2626 @var{mode} in a reload register for which class @var{class} would
2627 ordinarily be used.
2628
2629 Unlike @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, this macro should be used when
2630 there are certain modes that simply can't go in certain reload classes.
2631
2632 The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps another,
2633 smaller class.
2634
2635 Don't define this macro unless the target machine has limitations which
2636 require the macro to do something nontrivial.
2637 @end defmac
2638
2639 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD (bool @var{in_p}, rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{reload_class}, enum machine_mode @var{reload_mode}, secondary_reload_info *@var{sri})
2640 Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or
2641 from memory or even from other types of registers. An example is the
2642 @samp{MQ} register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or
2643 from general registers, but not memory. Below, we shall be using the
2644 term 'intermediate register' when a move operation cannot be performed
2645 directly, but has to be done by copying the source into the intermediate
2646 register first, and then copying the intermediate register to the
2647 destination. An intermediate register always has the same mode as
2648 source and destination. Since it holds the actual value being copied,
2649 reload might apply optimizations to re-use an intermediate register
2650 and eliding the copy from the source when it can determine that the
2651 intermediate register still holds the required value.
2652
2653 Another kind of secondary reload is required on some machines which
2654 allow copying all registers to and from memory, but require a scratch
2655 register for stores to some memory locations (e.g., those with symbolic
2656 address on the RT, and those with certain symbolic address on the SPARC
2657 when compiling PIC)@. Scratch registers need not have the same mode
2658 as the value being copied, and usually hold a different value than
2659 that being copied. Special patterns in the md file are needed to
2660 describe how the copy is performed with the help of the scratch register;
2661 these patterns also describe the number, register class(es) and mode(s)
2662 of the scratch register(s).
2663
2664 In some cases, both an intermediate and a scratch register are required.
2665
2666 For input reloads, this target hook is called with nonzero @var{in_p},
2667 and @var{x} is an rtx that needs to be copied to a register of class
2668 @var{reload_class} in @var{reload_mode}. For output reloads, this target
2669 hook is called with zero @var{in_p}, and a register of class @var{reload_class}
2670 needs to be copied to rtx @var{x} in @var{reload_mode}.
2671
2672 If copying a register of @var{reload_class} from/to @var{x} requires
2673 an intermediate register, the hook @code{secondary_reload} should
2674 return the register class required for this intermediate register.
2675 If no intermediate register is required, it should return NO_REGS.
2676 If more than one intermediate register is required, describe the one
2677 that is closest in the copy chain to the reload register.
2678
2679 If scratch registers are needed, you also have to describe how to
2680 perform the copy from/to the reload register to/from this
2681 closest intermediate register. Or if no intermediate register is
2682 required, but still a scratch register is needed, describe the
2683 copy from/to the reload register to/from the reload operand @var{x}.
2684
2685 You do this by setting @code{sri->icode} to the instruction code of a pattern
2686 in the md file which performs the move. Operands 0 and 1 are the output
2687 and input of this copy, respectively. Operands from operand 2 onward are
2688 for scratch operands. These scratch operands must have a mode, and a
2689 single-register-class
2690 @c [later: or memory]
2691 output constraint.
2692
2693 When an intermediate register is used, the @code{secondary_reload}
2694 hook will be called again to determine how to copy the intermediate
2695 register to/from the reload operand @var{x}, so your hook must also
2696 have code to handle the register class of the intermediate operand.
2697
2698 @c [For later: maybe we'll allow multi-alternative reload patterns -
2699 @c the port maintainer could name a mov<mode> pattern that has clobbers -
2700 @c and match the constraints of input and output to determine the required
2701 @c alternative. A restriction would be that constraints used to match
2702 @c against reloads registers would have to be written as register class
2703 @c constraints, or we need a new target macro / hook that tells us if an
2704 @c arbitrary constraint can match an unknown register of a given class.
2705 @c Such a macro / hook would also be useful in other places.]
2706
2707
2708 @var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2709 pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2710 Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2711 in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2712
2713 Scratch operands in memory (constraint @code{"=m"} / @code{"=&m"}) are
2714 currently not supported. For the time being, you will have to continue
2715 to use @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} for that purpose.
2716
2717 @code{copy_cost} also uses this target hook to find out how values are
2718 copied. If you want it to include some extra cost for the need to allocate
2719 (a) scratch register(s), set @code{sri->extra_cost} to the additional cost.
2720 Or if two dependent moves are supposed to have a lower cost than the sum
2721 of the individual moves due to expected fortuitous scheduling and/or special
2722 forwarding logic, you can set @code{sri->extra_cost} to a negative amount.
2723 @end deftypefn
2724
2725 @defmac SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2726 @defmacx SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2727 @defmacx SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2728 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
2729 @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD} instead.
2730
2731 These are obsolete macros, replaced by the @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD}
2732 target hook. Older ports still define these macros to indicate to the
2733 reload phase that it may
2734 need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
2735 register to contain the data. Specifically, if copying @var{x} to a
2736 register @var{class} in @var{mode} requires an intermediate register,
2737 you were supposed to define @code{SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to return the
2738 largest register class all of whose registers can be used as
2739 intermediate registers or scratch registers.
2740
2741 If copying a register @var{class} in @var{mode} to @var{x} requires an
2742 intermediate or scratch register, @code{SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS}
2743 was supposed to be defined be defined to return the largest register
2744 class required. If the
2745 requirements for input and output reloads were the same, the macro
2746 @code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS} should have been used instead of defining both
2747 macros identically.
2748
2749 The values returned by these macros are often @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
2750 Return @code{NO_REGS} if no spare register is needed; i.e., if @var{x}
2751 can be directly copied to or from a register of @var{class} in
2752 @var{mode} without requiring a scratch register. Do not define this
2753 macro if it would always return @code{NO_REGS}.
2754
2755 If a scratch register is required (either with or without an
2756 intermediate register), you were supposed to define patterns for
2757 @samp{reload_in@var{m}} or @samp{reload_out@var{m}}, as required
2758 (@pxref{Standard Names}. These patterns, which were normally
2759 implemented with a @code{define_expand}, should be similar to the
2760 @samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, except that operand 2 is the scratch
2761 register.
2762
2763 These patterns need constraints for the reload register and scratch
2764 register that
2765 contain a single register class. If the original reload register (whose
2766 class is @var{class}) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the
2767 value returned by these macros is used for the class of the scratch
2768 register. Otherwise, two additional reload registers are required.
2769 Their classes are obtained from the constraints in the insn pattern.
2770
2771 @var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2772 pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2773 Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2774 in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2775
2776 These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
2777 registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
2778 registers. In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
2779 would not be helpful. Instead, a stack location must be used to perform
2780 the copy and the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern should use memory as an
2781 intermediate storage. This case often occurs between floating-point and
2782 general registers.
2783 @end defmac
2784
2785 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (@var{class1}, @var{class2}, @var{m})
2786 Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied
2787 to some other registers without using memory. Define this macro on
2788 those machines to be a C expression that is nonzero if objects of mode
2789 @var{m} in registers of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of
2790 class @var{class2} by storing a register of @var{class1} into memory
2791 and loading that memory location into a register of @var{class2}.
2792
2793 Do not define this macro if its value would always be zero.
2794 @end defmac
2795
2796 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX (@var{mode})
2797 Normally when @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} is defined, the compiler
2798 allocates a stack slot for a memory location needed for register copies.
2799 If this macro is defined, the compiler instead uses the memory location
2800 defined by this macro.
2801
2802 Do not define this macro if you do not define
2803 @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED}.
2804 @end defmac
2805
2806 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE (@var{mode})
2807 When the compiler needs a secondary memory location to copy between two
2808 registers of mode @var{mode}, it normally allocates sufficient memory to
2809 hold a quantity of @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits and performs the store and
2810 load operations in a mode that many bits wide and whose class is the
2811 same as that of @var{mode}.
2812
2813 This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures that all
2814 bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the registers
2815 in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for floating-point
2816 registers.
2817
2818 However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as
2819 the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers
2820 differently than in integer registers. On those machines, the default
2821 widening will not work correctly and you must define this macro to
2822 suppress that widening in some cases. See the file @file{alpha.h} for
2823 details.
2824
2825 Do not define this macro if you do not define
2826 @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} or if widening @var{mode} to a mode that
2827 is @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits wide is correct for your machine.
2828 @end defmac
2829
2830 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P (reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2831 A target hook which returns @code{true} if pseudos that have been assigned
2832 to registers of class @var{rclass} would likely be spilled because
2833 registers of @var{rclass} are needed for spill registers.
2834
2835 The default version of this target hook returns @code{true} if @var{rclass}
2836 has exactly one register and @code{false} otherwise. On most machines, this
2837 default should be used. Only use this target hook to some other expression
2838 if pseudos allocated by @file{local-alloc.c} end up in memory because their
2839 hard registers were needed for spill registers. If this target hook returns
2840 @code{false} for those classes, those pseudos will only be allocated by
2841 @file{global.c}, which knows how to reallocate the pseudo to another
2842 register. If there would not be another register available for reallocation,
2843 you should not change the implementation of this target hook since
2844 the only effect of such implementation would be to slow down register
2845 allocation.
2846 @end deftypefn
2847
2848 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned char} TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS (reg_class_t @var{rclass}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
2849 A target hook returns the maximum number of consecutive registers
2850 of class @var{rclass} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2851
2852 This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2853 the value returned by @code{TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{rclass},
2854 @var{mode})} target hook should be the maximum value of
2855 @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})} for all @var{regno}
2856 values in the class @var{rclass}.
2857
2858 This target hook helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2859 in the reload pass.
2860
2861 The default version of this target hook returns the size of @var{mode}
2862 in words.
2863 @end deftypefn
2864
2865 @defmac CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})
2866 A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers
2867 of class @var{class} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2868
2869 This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2870 the value of the macro @code{CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})}
2871 should be the maximum value of @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno},
2872 @var{mode})} for all @var{regno} values in the class @var{class}.
2873
2874 This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2875 in the reload pass.
2876 @end defmac
2877
2878 @defmac CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS (@var{from}, @var{to}, @var{class})
2879 If defined, a C expression that returns nonzero for a @var{class} for which
2880 a change from mode @var{from} to mode @var{to} is invalid.
2881
2882 For the example, loading 32-bit integer or floating-point objects into
2883 floating-point registers on the Alpha extends them to 64 bits.
2884 Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a 32-bit object
2885 does not store the low-order 32 bits, as would be the case for a normal
2886 register. Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS}
2887 as below:
2888
2889 @smallexample
2890 #define CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS(FROM, TO, CLASS) \
2891 (GET_MODE_SIZE (FROM) != GET_MODE_SIZE (TO) \
2892 ? reg_classes_intersect_p (FLOAT_REGS, (CLASS)) : 0)
2893 @end smallexample
2894 @end defmac
2895
2896 @node Old Constraints
2897 @section Obsolete Macros for Defining Constraints
2898 @cindex defining constraints, obsolete method
2899 @cindex constraints, defining, obsolete method
2900
2901 Machine-specific constraints can be defined with these macros instead
2902 of the machine description constructs described in @ref{Define
2903 Constraints}. This mechanism is obsolete. New ports should not use
2904 it; old ports should convert to the new mechanism.
2905
2906 @defmac CONSTRAINT_LEN (@var{char}, @var{str})
2907 For the constraint at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter
2908 @var{c}, return the length. This allows you to have register class /
2909 constant / extra constraints that are longer than a single letter;
2910 you don't need to define this macro if you can do with single-letter
2911 constraints only. The definition of this macro should use
2912 DEFAULT_CONSTRAINT_LEN for all the characters that you don't want
2913 to handle specially.
2914 There are some sanity checks in genoutput.c that check the constraint lengths
2915 for the md file, so you can also use this macro to help you while you are
2916 transitioning from a byzantine single-letter-constraint scheme: when you
2917 return a negative length for a constraint you want to re-use, genoutput
2918 will complain about every instance where it is used in the md file.
2919 @end defmac
2920
2921 @defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER (@var{char})
2922 A C expression which defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2923 letters for register classes. If @var{char} is such a letter, the
2924 value should be the register class corresponding to it. Otherwise,
2925 the value should be @code{NO_REGS}. The register letter @samp{r},
2926 corresponding to class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, will not be passed
2927 to this macro; you do not need to handle it.
2928 @end defmac
2929
2930 @defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT (@var{char}, @var{str})
2931 Like @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER}, but you also get the constraint string
2932 passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between
2933 different variants.
2934 @end defmac
2935
2936 @defmac CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2937 A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2938 letters (@samp{I}, @samp{J}, @samp{K}, @dots{} @samp{P}) that specify
2939 particular ranges of integer values. If @var{c} is one of those
2940 letters, the expression should check that @var{value}, an integer, is in
2941 the appropriate range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is
2942 not one of those letters, the value should be 0 regardless of
2943 @var{value}.
2944 @end defmac
2945
2946 @defmac CONST_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2947 Like @code{CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2948 string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2949 between different variants.
2950 @end defmac
2951
2952 @defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2953 A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2954 letters that specify particular ranges of @code{const_double} values
2955 (@samp{G} or @samp{H}).
2956
2957 If @var{c} is one of those letters, the expression should check that
2958 @var{value}, an RTX of code @code{const_double}, is in the appropriate
2959 range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is not one of those
2960 letters, the value should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2961
2962 @code{const_double} is used for all floating-point constants and for
2963 @code{DImode} fixed-point constants. A given letter can accept either
2964 or both kinds of values. It can use @code{GET_MODE} to distinguish
2965 between these kinds.
2966 @end defmac
2967
2968 @defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2969 Like @code{CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2970 string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2971 between different variants.
2972 @end defmac
2973
2974 @defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT (@var{value}, @var{c})
2975 A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2976 letters that can be used to segregate specific types of operands, usually
2977 memory references, for the target machine. Any letter that is not
2978 elsewhere defined and not matched by @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} /
2979 @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
2980 may be used. Normally this macro will not be defined.
2981
2982 If it is required for a particular target machine, it should return 1
2983 if @var{value} corresponds to the operand type represented by the
2984 constraint letter @var{c}. If @var{c} is not defined as an extra
2985 constraint, the value returned should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2986
2987 For example, on the ROMP, load instructions cannot have their output
2988 in r0 if the memory reference contains a symbolic address. Constraint
2989 letter @samp{Q} is defined as representing a memory address that does
2990 @emph{not} contain a symbolic address. An alternative is specified with
2991 a @samp{Q} constraint on the input and @samp{r} on the output. The next
2992 alternative specifies @samp{m} on the input and a register class that
2993 does not include r0 on the output.
2994 @end defmac
2995
2996 @defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2997 Like @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, but you also get the constraint string passed
2998 in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between different
2999 variants.
3000 @end defmac
3001
3002 @defmac EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
3003 A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
3004 letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, that should
3005 be treated like memory constraints by the reload pass.
3006
3007 It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
3008 at the start of @var{str}, the first letter of which is the letter @var{c},
3009 comprises a subset of all memory references including
3010 all those whose address is simply a base register. This allows the reload
3011 pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
3012 type of @var{c}, by copying its address into a base register.
3013
3014 For example, on the S/390, some instructions do not accept arbitrary
3015 memory references, but only those that do not make use of an index
3016 register. The constraint letter @samp{Q} is defined via
3017 @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} as representing a memory address of this type.
3018 If the letter @samp{Q} is marked as @code{EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT},
3019 a @samp{Q} constraint can handle any memory operand, because the
3020 reload pass knows it can be reloaded by copying the memory address
3021 into a base register if required. This is analogous to the way
3022 an @samp{o} constraint can handle any memory operand.
3023 @end defmac
3024
3025 @defmac EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
3026 A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
3027 letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} /
3028 @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR}, that should
3029 be treated like address constraints by the reload pass.
3030
3031 It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
3032 at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter @var{c}, comprises
3033 a subset of all memory addresses including
3034 all those that consist of just a base register. This allows the reload
3035 pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
3036 type of @var{str}, by copying it into a base register.
3037
3038 Any constraint marked as @code{EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT} can only
3039 be used with the @code{address_operand} predicate. It is treated
3040 analogously to the @samp{p} constraint.
3041 @end defmac
3042
3043 @node Stack and Calling
3044 @section Stack Layout and Calling Conventions
3045 @cindex calling conventions
3046
3047 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3048 This describes the stack layout and calling conventions.
3049
3050 @menu
3051 * Frame Layout::
3052 * Exception Handling::
3053 * Stack Checking::
3054 * Frame Registers::
3055 * Elimination::
3056 * Stack Arguments::
3057 * Register Arguments::
3058 * Scalar Return::
3059 * Aggregate Return::
3060 * Caller Saves::
3061 * Function Entry::
3062 * Profiling::
3063 * Tail Calls::
3064 * Stack Smashing Protection::
3065 @end menu
3066
3067 @node Frame Layout
3068 @subsection Basic Stack Layout
3069 @cindex stack frame layout
3070 @cindex frame layout
3071
3072 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3073 Here is the basic stack layout.
3074
3075 @defmac STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3076 Define this macro if pushing a word onto the stack moves the stack
3077 pointer to a smaller address.
3078
3079 When we say, ``define this macro if @dots{}'', it means that the
3080 compiler checks this macro only with @code{#ifdef} so the precise
3081 definition used does not matter.
3082 @end defmac
3083
3084 @defmac STACK_PUSH_CODE
3085 This macro defines the operation used when something is pushed
3086 on the stack. In RTL, a push operation will be
3087 @code{(set (mem (STACK_PUSH_CODE (reg sp))) @dots{})}
3088
3089 The choices are @code{PRE_DEC}, @code{POST_DEC}, @code{PRE_INC},
3090 and @code{POST_INC}. Which of these is correct depends on
3091 the stack direction and on whether the stack pointer points
3092 to the last item on the stack or whether it points to the
3093 space for the next item on the stack.
3094
3095 The default is @code{PRE_DEC} when @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is
3096 defined, which is almost always right, and @code{PRE_INC} otherwise,
3097 which is often wrong.
3098 @end defmac
3099
3100 @defmac FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3101 Define this macro to nonzero value if the addresses of local variable slots
3102 are at negative offsets from the frame pointer.
3103 @end defmac
3104
3105 @defmac ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
3106 Define this macro if successive arguments to a function occupy decreasing
3107 addresses on the stack.
3108 @end defmac
3109
3110 @defmac STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
3111 Offset from the frame pointer to the first local variable slot to be allocated.
3112
3113 If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, find the next slot's offset by
3114 subtracting the first slot's length from @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3115 Otherwise, it is found by adding the length of the first slot to the
3116 value @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3117 @c i'm not sure if the above is still correct.. had to change it to get
3118 @c rid of an overfull. --mew 2feb93
3119 @end defmac
3120
3121 @defmac STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED
3122 Define to zero to disable final alignment of the stack during reload.
3123 The nonzero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
3124
3125 On ports where @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET} is nonzero or where there
3126 is a register save block following the local block that doesn't require
3127 alignment to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, it may be beneficial to disable
3128 stack alignment and do it in the backend.
3129 @end defmac
3130
3131 @defmac STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
3132 Offset from the stack pointer register to the first location at which
3133 outgoing arguments are placed. If not specified, the default value of
3134 zero is used. This is the proper value for most machines.
3135
3136 If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3137 the first location at which outgoing arguments are placed.
3138 @end defmac
3139
3140 @defmac FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3141 Offset from the argument pointer register to the first argument's
3142 address. On some machines it may depend on the data type of the
3143 function.
3144
3145 If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3146 the first argument's address.
3147 @end defmac
3148
3149 @defmac STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3150 Offset from the stack pointer register to an item dynamically allocated
3151 on the stack, e.g., by @code{alloca}.
3152
3153 The default value for this macro is @code{STACK_POINTER_OFFSET} plus the
3154 length of the outgoing arguments. The default is correct for most
3155 machines. See @file{function.c} for details.
3156 @end defmac
3157
3158 @defmac INITIAL_FRAME_ADDRESS_RTX
3159 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address of the initial
3160 stack frame. This address is passed to @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and
3161 @code{DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS}. If you don't define this macro, a reasonable
3162 default value will be used. Define this macro in order to make frame pointer
3163 elimination work in the presence of @code{__builtin_frame_address (count)} and
3164 @code{__builtin_return_address (count)} for @code{count} not equal to zero.
3165 @end defmac
3166
3167 @defmac DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS (@var{frameaddr})
3168 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack
3169 frame where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored. Assume that
3170 @var{frameaddr} is an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame
3171 itself.
3172
3173 If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value
3174 of @var{frameaddr}---that is, the stack frame address is also the
3175 address of the stack word that points to the previous frame.
3176 @end defmac
3177
3178 @defmac SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
3179 If defined, a C expression that produces the machine-specific code to
3180 setup the stack so that arbitrary frames can be accessed. For example,
3181 on the SPARC, we must flush all of the register windows to the stack
3182 before we can access arbitrary stack frames. You will seldom need to
3183 define this macro.
3184 @end defmac
3185
3186 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE (void)
3187 This target hook should return an rtx that is used to store
3188 the address of the current frame into the built in @code{setjmp} buffer.
3189 The default value, @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx}, is correct for most
3190 machines. One reason you may need to define this target hook is if
3191 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} is the appropriate value on your machine.
3192 @end deftypefn
3193
3194 @defmac FRAME_ADDR_RTX (@var{frameaddr})
3195 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the frame
3196 address for the current frame. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer
3197 of the current frame. This is used for __builtin_frame_address.
3198 You need only define this macro if the frame address is not the same
3199 as the frame pointer. Most machines do not need to define it.
3200 @end defmac
3201
3202 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_RTX (@var{count}, @var{frameaddr})
3203 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
3204 address for the frame @var{count} steps up from the current frame, after
3205 the prologue. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer of the @var{count}
3206 frame, or the frame pointer of the @var{count} @minus{} 1 frame if
3207 @code{RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME} is defined.
3208
3209 The value of the expression must always be the correct address when
3210 @var{count} is zero, but may be @code{NULL_RTX} if there is no way to
3211 determine the return address of other frames.
3212 @end defmac
3213
3214 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
3215 Define this if the return address of a particular stack frame is accessed
3216 from the frame pointer of the previous stack frame.
3217 @end defmac
3218
3219 @defmac INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
3220 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the location of the
3221 incoming return address at the beginning of any function, before the
3222 prologue. This RTL is either a @code{REG}, indicating that the return
3223 value is saved in @samp{REG}, or a @code{MEM} representing a location in
3224 the stack.
3225
3226 You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3227 debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3228
3229 If this RTL is a @code{REG}, you should also define
3230 @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO)}.
3231 @end defmac
3232
3233 @defmac DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
3234 A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 column
3235 number that may be used as an alternative return column. The column
3236 must not correspond to any gcc hard register (that is, it must not
3237 be in the range of @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM}).
3238
3239 This macro can be useful if @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} is set to a
3240 general register, but an alternative column needs to be used for signal
3241 frames. Some targets have also used different frame return columns
3242 over time.
3243 @end defmac
3244
3245 @defmac DWARF_ZERO_REG
3246 A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 register
3247 number that is considered to always have the value zero. This should
3248 only be defined if the target has an architected zero register, and
3249 someone decided it was a good idea to use that register number to
3250 terminate the stack backtrace. New ports should avoid this.
3251 @end defmac
3252
3253 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_DWARF_HANDLE_FRAME_UNSPEC (const char *@var{label}, rtx @var{pattern}, int @var{index})
3254 This target hook allows the backend to emit frame-related insns that
3255 contain UNSPECs or UNSPEC_VOLATILEs. The DWARF 2 call frame debugging
3256 info engine will invoke it on insns of the form
3257 @smallexample
3258 (set (reg) (unspec [@dots{}] UNSPEC_INDEX))
3259 @end smallexample
3260 and
3261 @smallexample
3262 (set (reg) (unspec_volatile [@dots{}] UNSPECV_INDEX)).
3263 @end smallexample
3264 to let the backend emit the call frame instructions. @var{label} is
3265 the CFI label attached to the insn, @var{pattern} is the pattern of
3266 the insn and @var{index} is @code{UNSPEC_INDEX} or @code{UNSPECV_INDEX}.
3267 @end deftypefn
3268
3269 @defmac INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
3270 A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3271 from the value of the stack pointer register to the top of the stack
3272 frame at the beginning of any function, before the prologue. The top of
3273 the frame is defined to be the value of the stack pointer in the
3274 previous frame, just before the call instruction.
3275
3276 You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3277 debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3278 @end defmac
3279
3280 @defmac ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3281 A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3282 from the argument pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa). The
3283 final value should coincide with that calculated by
3284 @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}. Which is unfortunately not usable
3285 during virtual register instantiation.
3286
3287 The default value for this macro is
3288 @code{FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (fundecl) + crtl->args.pretend_args_size},
3289 which is correct for most machines; in general, the arguments are found
3290 immediately before the stack frame. Note that this is not the case on
3291 some targets that save registers into the caller's frame, such as SPARC
3292 and rs6000, and so such targets need to define this macro.
3293
3294 You only need to define this macro if the default is incorrect, and you
3295 want to support call frame debugging information like that provided by
3296 DWARF 2.
3297 @end defmac
3298
3299 @defmac FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3300 If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3301 in bytes from the frame pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa).
3302 The final value should coincide with that calculated by
3303 @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}.
3304
3305 Normally the CFA is calculated as an offset from the argument pointer,
3306 via @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}, but if the argument pointer is
3307 variable due to the ABI, this may not be possible. If this macro is
3308 defined, it implies that the virtual register instantiation should be
3309 based on the frame pointer instead of the argument pointer. Only one
3310 of @code{FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET} and @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}
3311 should be defined.
3312 @end defmac
3313
3314 @defmac CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3315 If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3316 in bytes from the canonical frame address (cfa) to the frame base used
3317 in DWARF 2 debug information. The default is zero. A different value
3318 may reduce the size of debug information on some ports.
3319 @end defmac
3320
3321 @node Exception Handling
3322 @subsection Exception Handling Support
3323 @cindex exception handling
3324
3325 @defmac EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (@var{N})
3326 A C expression whose value is the @var{N}th register number used for
3327 data by exception handlers, or @code{INVALID_REGNUM} if fewer than
3328 @var{N} registers are usable.
3329
3330 The exception handling library routines communicate with the exception
3331 handlers via a set of agreed upon registers. Ideally these registers
3332 should be call-clobbered; it is possible to use call-saved registers,
3333 but may negatively impact code size. The target must support at least
3334 2 data registers, but should define 4 if there are enough free registers.
3335
3336 You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
3337 handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
3338 @end defmac
3339
3340 @defmac EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
3341 A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3342 to store a stack adjustment to be applied before function return.
3343 This is used to unwind the stack to an exception handler's call frame.
3344 It will be assigned zero on code paths that return normally.
3345
3346 Typically this is a call-clobbered hard register that is otherwise
3347 untouched by the epilogue, but could also be a stack slot.
3348
3349 Do not define this macro if the stack pointer is saved and restored
3350 by the regular prolog and epilog code in the call frame itself; in
3351 this case, the exception handling library routines will update the
3352 stack location to be restored in place. Otherwise, you must define
3353 this macro if you want to support call frame exception handling like
3354 that provided by DWARF 2.
3355 @end defmac
3356
3357 @defmac EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
3358 A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3359 to store the address of an exception handler to which we should
3360 return. It will not be assigned on code paths that return normally.
3361
3362 Typically this is the location in the call frame at which the normal
3363 return address is stored. For targets that return by popping an
3364 address off the stack, this might be a memory address just below
3365 the @emph{target} call frame rather than inside the current call
3366 frame. If defined, @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX} will have already
3367 been assigned, so it may be used to calculate the location of the
3368 target call frame.
3369
3370 Some targets have more complex requirements than storing to an
3371 address calculable during initial code generation. In that case
3372 the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern should be used instead.
3373
3374 If you want to support call frame exception handling, you must
3375 define either this macro or the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern.
3376 @end defmac
3377
3378 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_OFFSET
3379 If defined, an integer-valued C expression for which rtl will be generated
3380 to add it to the exception handler address before it is searched in the
3381 exception handling tables, and to subtract it again from the address before
3382 using it to return to the exception handler.
3383 @end defmac
3384
3385 @defmac ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (@var{code}, @var{global})
3386 This macro chooses the encoding of pointers embedded in the exception
3387 handling sections. If at all possible, this should be defined such
3388 that the exception handling section will not require dynamic relocations,
3389 and so may be read-only.
3390
3391 @var{code} is 0 for data, 1 for code labels, 2 for function pointers.
3392 @var{global} is true if the symbol may be affected by dynamic relocations.
3393 The macro should return a combination of the @code{DW_EH_PE_*} defines
3394 as found in @file{dwarf2.h}.
3395
3396 If this macro is not defined, pointers will not be encoded but
3397 represented directly.
3398 @end defmac
3399
3400 @defmac ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX (@var{file}, @var{encoding}, @var{size}, @var{addr}, @var{done})
3401 This macro allows the target to emit whatever special magic is required
3402 to represent the encoding chosen by @code{ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT}.
3403 Generic code takes care of pc-relative and indirect encodings; this must
3404 be defined if the target uses text-relative or data-relative encodings.
3405
3406 This is a C statement that branches to @var{done} if the format was
3407 handled. @var{encoding} is the format chosen, @var{size} is the number
3408 of bytes that the format occupies, @var{addr} is the @code{SYMBOL_REF}
3409 to be emitted.
3410 @end defmac
3411
3412 @defmac MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3413 This macro allows the target to add CPU and operating system specific
3414 code to the call-frame unwinder for use when there is no unwind data
3415 available. The most common reason to implement this macro is to unwind
3416 through signal frames.
3417
3418 This macro is called from @code{uw_frame_state_for} in
3419 @file{unwind-dw2.c}, @file{unwind-dw2-xtensa.c} and
3420 @file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3421 @var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{context->ra}
3422 for the address of the code being executed and @code{context->cfa} for
3423 the stack pointer value. If the frame can be decoded, the register
3424 save addresses should be updated in @var{fs} and the macro should
3425 evaluate to @code{_URC_NO_REASON}. If the frame cannot be decoded,
3426 the macro should evaluate to @code{_URC_END_OF_STACK}.
3427
3428 For proper signal handling in Java this macro is accompanied by
3429 @code{MAKE_THROW_FRAME}, defined in @file{libjava/include/*-signal.h} headers.
3430 @end defmac
3431
3432 @defmac MD_HANDLE_UNWABI (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3433 This macro allows the target to add operating system specific code to the
3434 call-frame unwinder to handle the IA-64 @code{.unwabi} unwinding directive,
3435 usually used for signal or interrupt frames.
3436
3437 This macro is called from @code{uw_update_context} in libgcc's
3438 @file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3439 @var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{fs->unwabi}
3440 for the abi and context in the @code{.unwabi} directive. If the
3441 @code{.unwabi} directive can be handled, the register save addresses should
3442 be updated in @var{fs}.
3443 @end defmac
3444
3445 @defmac TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
3446 A C expression that evaluates to true if the target requires unwind
3447 info to be given comdat linkage. Define it to be @code{1} if comdat
3448 linkage is necessary. The default is @code{0}.
3449 @end defmac
3450
3451 @node Stack Checking
3452 @subsection Specifying How Stack Checking is Done
3453
3454 GCC will check that stack references are within the boundaries of the
3455 stack, if the option @option{-fstack-check} is specified, in one of
3456 three ways:
3457
3458 @enumerate
3459 @item
3460 If the value of the @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC
3461 will assume that you have arranged for full stack checking to be done
3462 at appropriate places in the configuration files. GCC will not do
3463 other special processing.
3464
3465 @item
3466 If @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} is zero and the value of the
3467 @code{STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC will assume
3468 that you have arranged for static stack checking (checking of the
3469 static stack frame of functions) to be done at appropriate places
3470 in the configuration files. GCC will only emit code to do dynamic
3471 stack checking (checking on dynamic stack allocations) using the third
3472 approach below.
3473
3474 @item
3475 If neither of the above are true, GCC will generate code to periodically
3476 ``probe'' the stack pointer using the values of the macros defined below.
3477 @end enumerate
3478
3479 If neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined,
3480 GCC will change its allocation strategy for large objects if the option
3481 @option{-fstack-check} is specified: they will always be allocated
3482 dynamically if their size exceeds @code{STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE} bytes.
3483
3484 @defmac STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3485 A nonzero value if stack checking is done by the configuration files in a
3486 machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if stack checking
3487 is required by the ABI of your machine or if you would like to do stack
3488 checking in some more efficient way than the generic approach. The default
3489 value of this macro is zero.
3490 @end defmac
3491
3492 @defmac STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN
3493 A nonzero value if static stack checking is done by the configuration files
3494 in a machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if you would
3495 like to do static stack checking in some more efficient way than the generic
3496 approach. The default value of this macro is zero.
3497 @end defmac
3498
3499 @defmac STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL_EXP
3500 An integer specifying the interval at which GCC must generate stack probe
3501 instructions, defined as 2 raised to this integer. You will normally
3502 define this macro so that the interval be no larger than the size of
3503 the ``guard pages'' at the end of a stack area. The default value
3504 of 12 (4096-byte interval) is suitable for most systems.
3505 @end defmac
3506
3507 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MOVING_SP
3508 An integer which is nonzero if GCC should move the stack pointer page by page
3509 when doing probes. This can be necessary on systems where the stack pointer
3510 contains the bottom address of the memory area accessible to the executing
3511 thread at any point in time. In this situation an alternate signal stack
3512 is required in order to be able to recover from a stack overflow. The
3513 default value of this macro is zero.
3514 @end defmac
3515
3516 @defmac STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
3517 The number of bytes of stack needed to recover from a stack overflow, for
3518 languages where such a recovery is supported. The default value of 75 words
3519 with the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism and
3520 8192 bytes with other exception handling mechanisms should be adequate for
3521 most machines.
3522 @end defmac
3523
3524 The following macros are relevant only if neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3525 nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined; you can omit them altogether
3526 in the opposite case.
3527
3528 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
3529 The maximum size of a stack frame, in bytes. GCC will generate probe
3530 instructions in non-leaf functions to ensure at least this many bytes of
3531 stack are available. If a stack frame is larger than this size, stack
3532 checking will not be reliable and GCC will issue a warning. The
3533 default is chosen so that GCC only generates one instruction on most
3534 systems. You should normally not change the default value of this macro.
3535 @end defmac
3536
3537 @defmac STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
3538 GCC uses this value to generate the above warning message. It
3539 represents the amount of fixed frame used by a function, not including
3540 space for any callee-saved registers, temporaries and user variables.
3541 You need only specify an upper bound for this amount and will normally
3542 use the default of four words.
3543 @end defmac
3544
3545 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
3546 The maximum size, in bytes, of an object that GCC will place in the
3547 fixed area of the stack frame when the user specifies
3548 @option{-fstack-check}.
3549 GCC computed the default from the values of the above macros and you will
3550 normally not need to override that default.
3551 @end defmac
3552
3553 @need 2000
3554 @node Frame Registers
3555 @subsection Registers That Address the Stack Frame
3556
3557 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3558 This discusses registers that address the stack frame.
3559
3560 @defmac STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
3561 The register number of the stack pointer register, which must also be a
3562 fixed register according to @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}. On most machines,
3563 the hardware determines which register this is.
3564 @end defmac
3565
3566 @defmac FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3567 The register number of the frame pointer register, which is used to
3568 access automatic variables in the stack frame. On some machines, the
3569 hardware determines which register this is. On other machines, you can
3570 choose any register you wish for this purpose.
3571 @end defmac
3572
3573 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3574 On some machines the offset between the frame pointer and starting
3575 offset of the automatic variables is not known until after register
3576 allocation has been done (for example, because the saved registers are
3577 between these two locations). On those machines, define
3578 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} the number of a special, fixed register to
3579 be used internally until the offset is known, and define
3580 @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} to be the actual hard register number
3581 used for the frame pointer.
3582
3583 You should define this macro only in the very rare circumstances when it
3584 is not possible to calculate the offset between the frame pointer and
3585 the automatic variables until after register allocation has been
3586 completed. When this macro is defined, you must also indicate in your
3587 definition of @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} how to eliminate
3588 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} into either @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}
3589 or @code{STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3590
3591 Do not define this macro if it would be the same as
3592 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3593 @end defmac
3594
3595 @defmac ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
3596 The register number of the arg pointer register, which is used to access
3597 the function's argument list. On some machines, this is the same as the
3598 frame pointer register. On some machines, the hardware determines which
3599 register this is. On other machines, you can choose any register you
3600 wish for this purpose. If this is not the same register as the frame
3601 pointer register, then you must mark it as a fixed register according to
3602 @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, or arrange to be able to eliminate it
3603 (@pxref{Elimination}).
3604 @end defmac
3605
3606 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_FRAME_POINTER
3607 Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3608 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{frame_pointer_rtx} should be
3609 the same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3610 == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3611 definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3612 @end defmac
3613
3614 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_ARG_POINTER
3615 Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3616 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{arg_pointer_rtx} should be the
3617 same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM ==
3618 ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3619 definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3620 @end defmac
3621
3622 @defmac RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
3623 The register number of the return address pointer register, which is used to
3624 access the current function's return address from the stack. On some
3625 machines, the return address is not at a fixed offset from the frame
3626 pointer or stack pointer or argument pointer. This register can be defined
3627 to point to the return address on the stack, and then be converted by
3628 @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} into either the frame pointer or stack pointer.
3629
3630 Do not define this macro unless there is no other way to get the return
3631 address from the stack.
3632 @end defmac
3633
3634 @defmac STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
3635 @defmacx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
3636 Register numbers used for passing a function's static chain pointer. If
3637 register windows are used, the register number as seen by the called
3638 function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM}, while the register
3639 number as seen by the calling function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM}. If
3640 these registers are the same, @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM} need
3641 not be defined.
3642
3643 The static chain register need not be a fixed register.
3644
3645 If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros should not be
3646 defined; instead, the @code{TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN} hook should be used.
3647 @end defmac
3648
3649 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN (const_tree @var{fndecl}, bool @var{incoming_p})
3650 This hook replaces the use of @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al for
3651 targets that may use different static chain locations for different
3652 nested functions. This may be required if the target has function
3653 attributes that affect the calling conventions of the function and
3654 those calling conventions use different static chain locations.
3655
3656 The default version of this hook uses @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al.
3657
3658 If the static chain is passed in memory, this hook should be used to
3659 provide rtx giving @code{mem} expressions that denote where they are stored.
3660 Often the @code{mem} expression as seen by the caller will be at an offset
3661 from the stack pointer and the @code{mem} expression as seen by the callee
3662 will be at an offset from the frame pointer.
3663 @findex stack_pointer_rtx
3664 @findex frame_pointer_rtx
3665 @findex arg_pointer_rtx
3666 The variables @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, @code{frame_pointer_rtx}, and
3667 @code{arg_pointer_rtx} will have been initialized and should be used
3668 to refer to those items.
3669 @end deftypefn
3670
3671 @defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3672 This macro specifies the maximum number of hard registers that can be
3673 saved in a call frame. This is used to size data structures used in
3674 DWARF2 exception handling.
3675
3676 Prior to GCC 3.0, this macro was needed in order to establish a stable
3677 exception handling ABI in the face of adding new hard registers for ISA
3678 extensions. In GCC 3.0 and later, the EH ABI is insulated from changes
3679 in the number of hard registers. Nevertheless, this macro can still be
3680 used to reduce the runtime memory requirements of the exception handling
3681 routines, which can be substantial if the ISA contains a lot of
3682 registers that are not call-saved.
3683
3684 If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3685 @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
3686 @end defmac
3687
3688 @defmac PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3689
3690 This macro is similar to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}, but is provided
3691 for backward compatibility in pre GCC 3.0 compiled code.
3692
3693 If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3694 @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}.
3695 @end defmac
3696
3697 @defmac DWARF_REG_TO_UNWIND_COLUMN (@var{regno})
3698
3699 Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3700 is different than the internal representation for unwind column.
3701 Given a dwarf register, this macro should return the internal unwind
3702 column number to use instead.
3703
3704 See the PowerPC's SPE target for an example.
3705 @end defmac
3706
3707 @defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (@var{regno})
3708
3709 Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3710 used in .eh_frame or .debug_frame is different from that used in other
3711 debug info sections. Given a GCC hard register number, this macro
3712 should return the .eh_frame register number. The default is
3713 @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})}.
3714
3715 @end defmac
3716
3717 @defmac DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (@var{regno}, @var{for_eh})
3718
3719 Define this macro to map register numbers held in the call frame info
3720 that GCC has collected using @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM} to those that
3721 should be output in .debug_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is zero) and
3722 .eh_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is nonzero). The default is to
3723 return @code{@var{regno}}.
3724
3725 @end defmac
3726
3727 @defmac REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3728
3729 Define this macro if the target stores register values as
3730 @code{_Unwind_Word} type in unwind context. It should be defined if
3731 target register size is larger than the size of @code{void *}. The
3732 default is to store register values as @code{void *} type.
3733
3734 @end defmac
3735
3736 @defmac ASSUME_EXTENDED_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3737
3738 Define this macro to be 1 if the target always uses extended unwind
3739 context with version, args_size and by_value fields. If it is undefined,
3740 it will be defined to 1 when @code{REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT} is
3741 defined and 0 otherwise.
3742
3743 @end defmac
3744
3745 @node Elimination
3746 @subsection Eliminating Frame Pointer and Arg Pointer
3747
3748 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3749 This is about eliminating the frame pointer and arg pointer.
3750
3751 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED (void)
3752 This target hook should return @code{true} if a function must have and use
3753 a frame pointer. This target hook is called in the reload pass. If its return
3754 value is @code{true} the function will have a frame pointer.
3755
3756 This target hook can in principle examine the current function and decide
3757 according to the facts, but on most machines the constant @code{false} or the
3758 constant @code{true} suffices. Use @code{false} when the machine allows code
3759 to be generated with no frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space.
3760 Use @code{true} when there is no possible advantage to avoiding a frame
3761 pointer.
3762
3763 In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code
3764 without a frame pointer. The compiler recognizes those cases and
3765 automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what
3766 @code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} returns. You don't need to worry about
3767 them.
3768
3769 In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer
3770 register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a
3771 fixed register. See @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} for more information.
3772
3773 Default return value is @code{false}.
3774 @end deftypefn
3775
3776 @findex get_frame_size
3777 @defmac INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (@var{depth-var})
3778 A C statement to store in the variable @var{depth-var} the difference
3779 between the frame pointer and the stack pointer values immediately after
3780 the function prologue. The value would be computed from information
3781 such as the result of @code{get_frame_size ()} and the tables of
3782 registers @code{regs_ever_live} and @code{call_used_regs}.
3783
3784 If @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is defined, this macro will be not be used and
3785 need not be defined. Otherwise, it must be defined even if
3786 @code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} always returns true; in that
3787 case, you may set @var{depth-var} to anything.
3788 @end defmac
3789
3790 @defmac ELIMINABLE_REGS
3791 If defined, this macro specifies a table of register pairs used to
3792 eliminate unneeded registers that point into the stack frame. If it is not
3793 defined, the only elimination attempted by the compiler is to replace
3794 references to the frame pointer with references to the stack pointer.
3795
3796 The definition of this macro is a list of structure initializations, each
3797 of which specifies an original and replacement register.
3798
3799 On some machines, the position of the argument pointer is not known until
3800 the compilation is completed. In such a case, a separate hard register
3801 must be used for the argument pointer. This register can be eliminated by
3802 replacing it with either the frame pointer or the argument pointer,
3803 depending on whether or not the frame pointer has been eliminated.
3804
3805 In this case, you might specify:
3806 @smallexample
3807 #define ELIMINABLE_REGS \
3808 @{@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3809 @{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3810 @{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}@}
3811 @end smallexample
3812
3813 Note that the elimination of the argument pointer with the stack pointer is
3814 specified first since that is the preferred elimination.
3815 @end defmac
3816
3817 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE (const int @var{from_reg}, const int @var{to_reg})
3818 This target hook should returns @code{true} if the compiler is allowed to
3819 try to replace register number @var{from_reg} with register number
3820 @var{to_reg}. This target hook need only be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS}
3821 is defined, and will usually be @code{true}, since most of the cases
3822 preventing register elimination are things that the compiler already
3823 knows about.
3824
3825 Default return value is @code{true}.
3826 @end deftypefn
3827
3828 @defmac INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg}, @var{offset-var})
3829 This macro is similar to @code{INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET}. It
3830 specifies the initial difference between the specified pair of
3831 registers. This macro must be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is
3832 defined.
3833 @end defmac
3834
3835 @node Stack Arguments
3836 @subsection Passing Function Arguments on the Stack
3837 @cindex arguments on stack
3838 @cindex stack arguments
3839
3840 The macros in this section control how arguments are passed
3841 on the stack. See the following section for other macros that
3842 control passing certain arguments in registers.
3843
3844 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES (const_tree @var{fntype})
3845 This target hook returns @code{true} if an argument declared in a
3846 prototype as an integral type smaller than @code{int} should actually be
3847 passed as an @code{int}. In addition to avoiding errors in certain
3848 cases of mismatch, it also makes for better code on certain machines.
3849 The default is to not promote prototypes.
3850 @end deftypefn
3851
3852 @defmac PUSH_ARGS
3853 A C expression. If nonzero, push insns will be used to pass
3854 outgoing arguments.
3855 If the target machine does not have a push instruction, set it to zero.
3856 That directs GCC to use an alternate strategy: to
3857 allocate the entire argument block and then store the arguments into
3858 it. When @code{PUSH_ARGS} is nonzero, @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} must be defined too.
3859 @end defmac
3860
3861 @defmac PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
3862 A C expression. If nonzero, function arguments will be evaluated from
3863 last to first, rather than from first to last. If this macro is not
3864 defined, it defaults to @code{PUSH_ARGS} on targets where the stack
3865 and args grow in opposite directions, and 0 otherwise.
3866 @end defmac
3867
3868 @defmac PUSH_ROUNDING (@var{npushed})
3869 A C expression that is the number of bytes actually pushed onto the
3870 stack when an instruction attempts to push @var{npushed} bytes.
3871
3872 On some machines, the definition
3873
3874 @smallexample
3875 #define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (BYTES)
3876 @end smallexample
3877
3878 @noindent
3879 will suffice. But on other machines, instructions that appear
3880 to push one byte actually push two bytes in an attempt to maintain
3881 alignment. Then the definition should be
3882
3883 @smallexample
3884 #define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (((BYTES) + 1) & ~1)
3885 @end smallexample
3886
3887 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
3888 @end defmac
3889
3890 @findex current_function_outgoing_args_size
3891 @defmac ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3892 A C expression. If nonzero, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments
3893 will be computed and placed into the variable
3894 @code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}. No space will be pushed
3895 onto the stack for each call; instead, the function prologue should
3896 increase the stack frame size by this amount.
3897
3898 Setting both @code{PUSH_ARGS} and @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS}
3899 is not proper.
3900 @end defmac
3901
3902 @defmac REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3903 Define this macro if functions should assume that stack space has been
3904 allocated for arguments even when their values are passed in
3905 registers.
3906
3907 The value of this macro is the size, in bytes, of the area reserved for
3908 arguments passed in registers for the function represented by @var{fndecl},
3909 which can be zero if GCC is calling a library function.
3910 The argument @var{fndecl} can be the FUNCTION_DECL, or the type itself
3911 of the function.
3912
3913 This space can be allocated by the caller, or be a part of the
3914 machine-dependent stack frame: @code{OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} says
3915 which.
3916 @end defmac
3917 @c above is overfull. not sure what to do. --mew 5feb93 did
3918 @c something, not sure if it looks good. --mew 10feb93
3919
3920 @defmac OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fntype})
3921 Define this to a nonzero value if it is the responsibility of the
3922 caller to allocate the area reserved for arguments passed in registers
3923 when calling a function of @var{fntype}. @var{fntype} may be NULL
3924 if the function called is a library function.
3925
3926 If @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, this macro controls
3927 whether the space for these arguments counts in the value of
3928 @code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}.
3929 @end defmac
3930
3931 @defmac STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
3932 Define this macro if @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is defined, but the
3933 stack parameters don't skip the area specified by it.
3934 @c i changed this, makes more sens and it should have taken care of the
3935 @c overfull.. not as specific, tho. --mew 5feb93
3936
3937 Normally, when a parameter is not passed in registers, it is placed on the
3938 stack beyond the @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} area. Defining this macro
3939 suppresses this behavior and causes the parameter to be passed on the
3940 stack in its natural location.
3941 @end defmac
3942
3943 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_RETURN_POPS_ARGS (tree @var{fundecl}, tree @var{funtype}, int @var{size})
3944 This target hook returns the number of bytes of its own arguments that
3945 a function pops on returning, or 0 if the function pops no arguments
3946 and the caller must therefore pop them all after the function returns.
3947
3948 @var{fundecl} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that describes
3949 the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3950 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} that describes the declaration of the function.
3951 From this you can obtain the @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of the function.
3952
3953 @var{funtype} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that
3954 describes the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3955 @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} that describes the data type of the function.
3956 From this it is possible to obtain the data types of the value and
3957 arguments (if known).
3958
3959 When a call to a library function is being considered, @var{fundecl}
3960 will contain an identifier node for the library function. Thus, if
3961 you need to distinguish among various library functions, you can do so
3962 by their names. Note that ``library function'' in this context means
3963 a function used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known specially
3964 in the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being compiled.
3965
3966 @var{size} is the number of bytes of arguments passed on the
3967 stack. If a variable number of bytes is passed, it is zero, and
3968 argument popping will always be the responsibility of the calling function.
3969
3970 On the VAX, all functions always pop their arguments, so the definition
3971 of this macro is @var{size}. On the 68000, using the standard
3972 calling convention, no functions pop their arguments, so the value of
3973 the macro is always 0 in this case. But an alternative calling
3974 convention is available in which functions that take a fixed number of
3975 arguments pop them but other functions (such as @code{printf}) pop
3976 nothing (the caller pops all). When this convention is in use,
3977 @var{funtype} is examined to determine whether a function takes a fixed
3978 number of arguments.
3979 @end deftypefn
3980
3981 @defmac CALL_POPS_ARGS (@var{cum})
3982 A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes a call sequence
3983 pops off the stack. It is added to the value of @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS}
3984 when compiling a function call.
3985
3986 @var{cum} is the variable in which all arguments to the called function
3987 have been accumulated.
3988
3989 On certain architectures, such as the SH5, a call trampoline is used
3990 that pops certain registers off the stack, depending on the arguments
3991 that have been passed to the function. Since this is a property of the
3992 call site, not of the called function, @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is not
3993 appropriate.
3994 @end defmac
3995
3996 @node Register Arguments
3997 @subsection Passing Arguments in Registers
3998 @cindex arguments in registers
3999 @cindex registers arguments
4000
4001 This section describes the macros which let you control how various
4002 types of arguments are passed in registers or how they are arranged in
4003 the stack.
4004
4005 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4006 Return an RTX indicating whether a function argument is passed in a
4007 register and if so, which register.
4008
4009 The arguments are @var{ca}, which summarizes all the previous
4010 arguments; @var{mode}, the machine mode of the argument; @var{type},
4011 the data type of the argument as a tree node or 0 if that is not known
4012 (which happens for C support library functions); and @var{named},
4013 which is @code{true} for an ordinary argument and @code{false} for
4014 nameless arguments that correspond to @samp{@dots{}} in the called
4015 function's prototype. @var{type} can be an incomplete type if a
4016 syntax error has previously occurred.
4017
4018 The return value is usually either a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
4019 register in which to pass the argument, or zero to pass the argument
4020 on the stack.
4021
4022 The value of the expression can also be a @code{parallel} RTX@. This is
4023 used when an argument is passed in multiple locations. The mode of the
4024 @code{parallel} should be the mode of the entire argument. The
4025 @code{parallel} holds any number of @code{expr_list} pairs; each one
4026 describes where part of the argument is passed. In each
4027 @code{expr_list} the first operand must be a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
4028 register in which to pass this part of the argument, and the mode of the
4029 register RTX indicates how large this part of the argument is. The
4030 second operand of the @code{expr_list} is a @code{const_int} which gives
4031 the offset in bytes into the entire argument of where this part starts.
4032 As a special exception the first @code{expr_list} in the @code{parallel}
4033 RTX may have a first operand of zero. This indicates that the entire
4034 argument is also stored on the stack.
4035
4036 The last time this hook is called, it is called with @code{MODE ==
4037 VOIDmode}, and its result is passed to the @code{call} or @code{call_value}
4038 pattern as operands 2 and 3 respectively.
4039
4040 @cindex @file{stdarg.h} and register arguments
4041 The usual way to make the ISO library @file{stdarg.h} work on a
4042 machine where some arguments are usually passed in registers, is to
4043 cause nameless arguments to be passed on the stack instead. This is
4044 done by making @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} return 0 whenever
4045 @var{named} is @code{false}.
4046
4047 @cindex @code{TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
4048 @cindex @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
4049 You may use the hook @code{targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack}
4050 in the definition of this macro to determine if this argument is of a
4051 type that must be passed in the stack. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}
4052 is not defined and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} returns nonzero for such an
4053 argument, the compiler will abort. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is
4054 defined, the argument will be computed in the stack and then loaded into
4055 a register.
4056 @end deftypefn
4057
4058 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4059 This target hook should return @code{true} if we should not pass @var{type}
4060 solely in registers. The file @file{expr.h} defines a
4061 definition that is usually appropriate, refer to @file{expr.h} for additional
4062 documentation.
4063 @end deftypefn
4064
4065 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4066 Define this hook if the target machine has ``register windows'', so
4067 that the register in which a function sees an arguments is not
4068 necessarily the same as the one in which the caller passed the
4069 argument.
4070
4071 For such machines, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} computes the register in
4072 which the caller passes the value, and
4073 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} should be defined in a similar
4074 fashion to tell the function being called where the arguments will
4075 arrive.
4076
4077 If @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} is not defined,
4078 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} serves both purposes.
4079 @end deftypefn
4080
4081 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4082 This target hook returns the number of bytes at the beginning of an
4083 argument that must be put in registers. The value must be zero for
4084 arguments that are passed entirely in registers or that are entirely
4085 pushed on the stack.
4086
4087 On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in
4088 registers and partially in memory. On these machines, typically the
4089 first few words of arguments are passed in registers, and the rest
4090 on the stack. If a multi-word argument (a @code{double} or a
4091 structure) crosses that boundary, its first few words must be passed
4092 in registers and the rest must be pushed. This macro tells the
4093 compiler when this occurs, and how many bytes should go in registers.
4094
4095 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for these arguments should return the first
4096 register to be used by the caller for this argument; likewise
4097 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG}, for the called function.
4098 @end deftypefn
4099
4100 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4101 This target hook should return @code{true} if an argument at the
4102 position indicated by @var{cum} should be passed by reference. This
4103 predicate is queried after target independent reasons for being
4104 passed by reference, such as @code{TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type)}.
4105
4106 If the hook returns true, a copy of that argument is made in memory and a
4107 pointer to the argument is passed instead of the argument itself.
4108 The pointer is passed in whatever way is appropriate for passing a pointer
4109 to that type.
4110 @end deftypefn
4111
4112 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CALLEE_COPIES (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4113 The function argument described by the parameters to this hook is
4114 known to be passed by reference. The hook should return true if the
4115 function argument should be copied by the callee instead of copied
4116 by the caller.
4117
4118 For any argument for which the hook returns true, if it can be
4119 determined that the argument is not modified, then a copy need
4120 not be generated.
4121
4122 The default version of this hook always returns false.
4123 @end deftypefn
4124
4125 @defmac CUMULATIVE_ARGS
4126 A C type for declaring a variable that is used as the first argument
4127 of @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} and other related values. For some
4128 target machines, the type @code{int} suffices and can hold the number
4129 of bytes of argument so far.
4130
4131 There is no need to record in @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} anything about the
4132 arguments that have been passed on the stack. The compiler has other
4133 variables to keep track of that. For target machines on which all
4134 arguments are passed on the stack, there is no need to store anything in
4135 @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}; however, the data structure must exist and
4136 should not be empty, so use @code{int}.
4137 @end defmac
4138
4139 @defmac OVERRIDE_ABI_FORMAT (@var{fndecl})
4140 If defined, this macro is called before generating any code for a
4141 function, but after the @var{cfun} descriptor for the function has been
4142 created. The back end may use this macro to update @var{cfun} to
4143 reflect an ABI other than that which would normally be used by default.
4144 If the compiler is generating code for a compiler-generated function,
4145 @var{fndecl} may be @code{NULL}.
4146 @end defmac
4147
4148 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname}, @var{fndecl}, @var{n_named_args})
4149 A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable
4150 @var{cum} for the state at the beginning of the argument list. The
4151 variable has type @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}. The value of @var{fntype}
4152 is the tree node for the data type of the function which will receive
4153 the args, or 0 if the args are to a compiler support library function.
4154 For direct calls that are not libcalls, @var{fndecl} contain the
4155 declaration node of the function. @var{fndecl} is also set when
4156 @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used to find arguments for the function
4157 being compiled. @var{n_named_args} is set to the number of named
4158 arguments, including a structure return address if it is passed as a
4159 parameter, when making a call. When processing incoming arguments,
4160 @var{n_named_args} is set to @minus{}1.
4161
4162 When processing a call to a compiler support library function,
4163 @var{libname} identifies which one. It is a @code{symbol_ref} rtx which
4164 contains the name of the function, as a string. @var{libname} is 0 when
4165 an ordinary C function call is being processed. Thus, each time this
4166 macro is called, either @var{libname} or @var{fntype} is nonzero, but
4167 never both of them at once.
4168 @end defmac
4169
4170 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{libname})
4171 Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but only used for outgoing libcalls,
4172 it gets a @code{MODE} argument instead of @var{fntype}, that would be
4173 @code{NULL}. @var{indirect} would always be zero, too. If this macro
4174 is not defined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (cum, NULL_RTX, libname,
4175 0)} is used instead.
4176 @end defmac
4177
4178 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname})
4179 Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but overrides it for the purposes of
4180 finding the arguments for the function being compiled. If this macro is
4181 undefined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used instead.
4182
4183 The value passed for @var{libname} is always 0, since library routines
4184 with special calling conventions are never compiled with GCC@. The
4185 argument @var{libname} exists for symmetry with
4186 @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.
4187 @c could use "this macro" in place of @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}, maybe.
4188 @c --mew 5feb93 i switched the order of the sentences. --mew 10feb93
4189 @end defmac
4190
4191 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4192 This hook updates the summarizer variable pointed to by @var{ca} to
4193 advance past an argument in the argument list. The values @var{mode},
4194 @var{type} and @var{named} describe that argument. Once this is done,
4195 the variable @var{cum} is suitable for analyzing the @emph{following}
4196 argument with @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}, etc.
4197
4198 This hook need not do anything if the argument in question was passed
4199 on the stack. The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space
4200 used for arguments without any special help.
4201 @end deftypefn
4202
4203 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_OFFSET (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4204 If defined, a C expression that is the number of bytes to add to the
4205 offset of the argument passed in memory. This is needed for the SPU,
4206 which passes @code{char} and @code{short} arguments in the preferred
4207 slot that is in the middle of the quad word instead of starting at the
4208 top.
4209 @end defmac
4210
4211 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4212 If defined, a C expression which determines whether, and in which direction,
4213 to pad out an argument with extra space. The value should be of type
4214 @code{enum direction}: either @code{upward} to pad above the argument,
4215 @code{downward} to pad below, or @code{none} to inhibit padding.
4216
4217 The @emph{amount} of padding is not controlled by this macro, but by the
4218 target hook @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY}. It is
4219 always just enough to reach the next multiple of that boundary.
4220
4221 This macro has a default definition which is right for most systems.
4222 For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward. For
4223 big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of
4224 constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise.
4225 @end defmac
4226
4227 @defmac PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
4228 If defined, a C expression which determines whether the default
4229 implementation of va_arg will attempt to pad down before reading the
4230 next argument, if that argument is smaller than its aligned space as
4231 controlled by @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}. If this macro is not defined, all such
4232 arguments are padded down if @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN} is true.
4233 @end defmac
4234
4235 @defmac BLOCK_REG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{first})
4236 Specify padding for the last element of a block move between registers and
4237 memory. @var{first} is nonzero if this is the only element. Defining this
4238 macro allows better control of register function parameters on big-endian
4239 machines, without using @code{PARALLEL} rtl. In particular,
4240 @code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK} need not test padding and mode of types in
4241 registers, as there is no longer a "wrong" part of a register; For example,
4242 a three byte aggregate may be passed in the high part of a register if so
4243 required.
4244 @end defmac
4245
4246 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4247 This hook returns the alignment boundary, in bits, of an argument
4248 with the specified mode and type. The default hook returns
4249 @code{PARM_BOUNDARY} for all arguments.
4250 @end deftypefn
4251
4252 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4253 Normally, the size of an argument is rounded up to @code{PARM_BOUNDARY},
4254 which is the default value for this hook. You can define this hook to
4255 return a different value if an argument size must be rounded to a larger
4256 value.
4257 @end deftypefn
4258
4259 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4260 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4261 register in which function arguments are sometimes passed. This does
4262 @emph{not} include implicit arguments such as the static chain and
4263 the structure-value address. On many machines, no registers can be
4264 used for this purpose since all function arguments are pushed on the
4265 stack.
4266 @end defmac
4267
4268 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SPLIT_COMPLEX_ARG (const_tree @var{type})
4269 This hook should return true if parameter of type @var{type} are passed
4270 as two scalar parameters. By default, GCC will attempt to pack complex
4271 arguments into the target's word size. Some ABIs require complex arguments
4272 to be split and treated as their individual components. For example, on
4273 AIX64, complex floats should be passed in a pair of floating point
4274 registers, even though a complex float would fit in one 64-bit floating
4275 point register.
4276
4277 The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which is treated as always
4278 false.
4279 @end deftypefn
4280
4281 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST (void)
4282 This hook returns a type node for @code{va_list} for the target.
4283 The default version of the hook returns @code{void*}.
4284 @end deftypefn
4285
4286 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ENUM_VA_LIST_P (int @var{idx}, const char **@var{pname}, tree *@var{ptree})
4287 This target hook is used in function @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins}
4288 to iterate through the target specific builtin types for va_list. The
4289 variable @var{idx} is used as iterator. @var{pname} has to be a pointer
4290 to a @code{const char *} and @var{ptree} a pointer to a @code{tree} typed
4291 variable.
4292 The arguments @var{pname} and @var{ptree} are used to store the result of
4293 this macro and are set to the name of the va_list builtin type and its
4294 internal type.
4295 If the return value of this macro is zero, then there is no more element.
4296 Otherwise the @var{IDX} should be increased for the next call of this
4297 macro to iterate through all types.
4298 @end deftypefn
4299
4300 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FN_ABI_VA_LIST (tree @var{fndecl})
4301 This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by
4302 @var{fndecl}.
4303 The default version of this hook returns @code{va_list_type_node}.
4304 @end deftypefn
4305
4306 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CANONICAL_VA_LIST_TYPE (tree @var{type})
4307 This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by the
4308 type of @var{type}. If @var{type} is not a valid va_list type, it returns
4309 @code{NULL_TREE}.
4310 @end deftypefn
4311
4312 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GIMPLIFY_VA_ARG_EXPR (tree @var{valist}, tree @var{type}, gimple_seq *@var{pre_p}, gimple_seq *@var{post_p})
4313 This hook performs target-specific gimplification of
4314 @code{VA_ARG_EXPR}. The first two parameters correspond to the
4315 arguments to @code{va_arg}; the latter two are as in
4316 @code{gimplify.c:gimplify_expr}.
4317 @end deftypefn
4318
4319 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
4320 Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
4321 with machine mode @var{mode}. The default version of this
4322 hook returns true for both @code{ptr_mode} and @code{Pmode}.
4323 @end deftypefn
4324
4325 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_REF_MAY_ALIAS_ERRNO (struct ao_ref_s *@var{ref})
4326 Define this to return nonzero if the memory reference @var{ref} may alias with the system C library errno location. The default version of this hook assumes the system C library errno location is either a declaration of type int or accessed by dereferencing a pointer to int.
4327 @end deftypefn
4328
4329 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
4330 Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4331 insns involving scalar mode @var{mode}. For a scalar mode to be
4332 considered supported, all the basic arithmetic and comparisons
4333 must work.
4334
4335 The default version of this hook returns true for any mode
4336 required to handle the basic C types (as defined by the port).
4337 Included here are the double-word arithmetic supported by the
4338 code in @file{optabs.c}.
4339 @end deftypefn
4340
4341 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
4342 Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4343 insns involving vector mode @var{mode}. At the very least, it
4344 must have move patterns for this mode.
4345 @end deftypefn
4346
4347 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ARRAY_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{nelems})
4348 Return true if GCC should try to use a scalar mode to store an array
4349 of @var{nelems} elements, given that each element has mode @var{mode}.
4350 Returning true here overrides the usual @code{MAX_FIXED_MODE} limit
4351 and allows GCC to use any defined integer mode.
4352
4353 One use of this hook is to support vector load and store operations
4354 that operate on several homogeneous vectors. For example, ARM NEON
4355 has operations like:
4356
4357 @smallexample
4358 int8x8x3_t vld3_s8 (const int8_t *)
4359 @end smallexample
4360
4361 where the return type is defined as:
4362
4363 @smallexample
4364 typedef struct int8x8x3_t
4365 @{
4366 int8x8_t val[3];
4367 @} int8x8x3_t;
4368 @end smallexample
4369
4370 If this hook allows @code{val} to have a scalar mode, then
4371 @code{int8x8x3_t} can have the same mode. GCC can then store
4372 @code{int8x8x3_t}s in registers rather than forcing them onto the stack.
4373 @end deftypefn
4374
4375 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES_FOR_MODE_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
4376 Define this to return nonzero for machine modes for which the port has
4377 small register classes. If this target hook returns nonzero for a given
4378 @var{mode}, the compiler will try to minimize the lifetime of registers
4379 in @var{mode}. The hook may be called with @code{VOIDmode} as argument.
4380 In this case, the hook is expected to return nonzero if it returns nonzero
4381 for any mode.
4382
4383 On some machines, it is risky to let hard registers live across arbitrary
4384 insns. Typically, these machines have instructions that require values
4385 to be in specific registers (like an accumulator), and reload will fail
4386 if the required hard register is used for another purpose across such an
4387 insn.
4388
4389 Passes before reload do not know which hard registers will be used
4390 in an instruction, but the machine modes of the registers set or used in
4391 the instruction are already known. And for some machines, register
4392 classes are small for, say, integer registers but not for floating point
4393 registers. For example, the AMD x86-64 architecture requires specific
4394 registers for the legacy x86 integer instructions, but there are many
4395 SSE registers for floating point operations. On such targets, a good
4396 strategy may be to return nonzero from this hook for @code{INTEGRAL_MODE_P}
4397 machine modes but zero for the SSE register classes.
4398
4399 The default version of this hook returns false for any mode. It is always
4400 safe to redefine this hook to return with a nonzero value. But if you
4401 unnecessarily define it, you will reduce the amount of optimizations
4402 that can be performed in some cases. If you do not define this hook
4403 to return a nonzero value when it is required, the compiler will run out
4404 of spill registers and print a fatal error message.
4405 @end deftypefn
4406
4407 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FLAGS_REGNUM
4408 If the target has a dedicated flags register, and it needs to use the post-reload comparison elimination pass, then this value should be set appropriately.
4409 @end deftypevr
4410
4411 @node Scalar Return
4412 @subsection How Scalar Function Values Are Returned
4413 @cindex return values in registers
4414 @cindex values, returned by functions
4415 @cindex scalars, returned as values
4416
4417 This section discusses the macros that control returning scalars as
4418 values---values that can fit in registers.
4419
4420 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE (const_tree @var{ret_type}, const_tree @var{fn_decl_or_type}, bool @var{outgoing})
4421
4422 Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function
4423 returns or receives a value of data type @var{ret_type}, a tree node
4424 representing a data type. @var{fn_decl_or_type} is a tree node
4425 representing @code{FUNCTION_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} of a
4426 function being called. If @var{outgoing} is false, the hook should
4427 compute the register in which the caller will see the return value.
4428 Otherwise, the hook should return an RTX representing the place where
4429 a function returns a value.
4430
4431 On many machines, only @code{TYPE_MODE (@var{ret_type})} is relevant.
4432 (Actually, on most machines, scalar values are returned in the same
4433 place regardless of mode.) The value of the expression is usually a
4434 @code{reg} RTX for the hard register where the return value is stored.
4435 The value can also be a @code{parallel} RTX, if the return value is in
4436 multiple places. See @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for an explanation of the
4437 @code{parallel} form. Note that the callee will populate every
4438 location specified in the @code{parallel}, but if the first element of
4439 the @code{parallel} contains the whole return value, callers will use
4440 that element as the canonical location and ignore the others. The m68k
4441 port uses this type of @code{parallel} to return pointers in both
4442 @samp{%a0} (the canonical location) and @samp{%d0}.
4443
4444 If @code{TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN} returns true, you must apply
4445 the same promotion rules specified in @code{PROMOTE_MODE} if
4446 @var{valtype} is a scalar type.
4447
4448 If the precise function being called is known, @var{func} is a tree
4449 node (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
4450 pointer. This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
4451 convention for specific functions when all their calls are
4452 known.
4453
4454 Some target machines have ``register windows'' so that the register in
4455 which a function returns its value is not the same as the one in which
4456 the caller sees the value. For such machines, you should return
4457 different RTX depending on @var{outgoing}.
4458
4459 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} is not used for return values with
4460 aggregate data types, because these are returned in another way. See
4461 @code{TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX} and related macros, below.
4462 @end deftypefn
4463
4464 @defmac FUNCTION_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
4465 This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} for
4466 a new target instead.
4467 @end defmac
4468
4469 @defmac LIBCALL_VALUE (@var{mode})
4470 A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a library
4471 function returns a value of mode @var{mode}.
4472
4473 Note that ``library function'' in this context means a compiler
4474 support routine, used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known
4475 specially by the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being
4476 compiled.
4477 @end defmac
4478
4479 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_rtx @var{fun})
4480 Define this hook if the back-end needs to know the name of the libcall
4481 function in order to determine where the result should be returned.
4482
4483 The mode of the result is given by @var{mode} and the name of the called
4484 library function is given by @var{fun}. The hook should return an RTX
4485 representing the place where the library function result will be returned.
4486
4487 If this hook is not defined, then LIBCALL_VALUE will be used.
4488 @end deftypefn
4489
4490 @defmac FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4491 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4492 register in which the values of called function may come back.
4493
4494 A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4495 second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4496 recognized by this macro. So for most machines, this definition
4497 suffices:
4498
4499 @smallexample
4500 #define FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P(N) ((N) == 0)
4501 @end smallexample
4502
4503 If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4504 function use different registers for the return value, this macro
4505 should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4506
4507 This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P}
4508 for a new target instead.
4509 @end defmac
4510
4511 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (const unsigned int @var{regno})
4512 A target hook that return @code{true} if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4513 register in which the values of called function may come back.
4514
4515 A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4516 second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4517 recognized by this target hook.
4518
4519 If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4520 function use different registers for the return value, this target hook
4521 should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4522
4523 If this hook is not defined, then FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P will be used.
4524 @end deftypefn
4525
4526 @defmac APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
4527 Define this macro if @samp{untyped_call} and @samp{untyped_return}
4528 need more space than is implied by @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} for
4529 saving and restoring an arbitrary return value.
4530 @end defmac
4531
4532 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MSB (const_tree @var{type})
4533 This hook should return true if values of type @var{type} are returned
4534 at the most significant end of a register (in other words, if they are
4535 padded at the least significant end). You can assume that @var{type}
4536 is returned in a register; the caller is required to check this.
4537
4538 Note that the register provided by @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must
4539 be able to hold the complete return value. For example, if a 1-, 2-
4540 or 3-byte structure is returned at the most significant end of a
4541 4-byte register, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} should provide an
4542 @code{SImode} rtx.
4543 @end deftypefn
4544
4545 @node Aggregate Return
4546 @subsection How Large Values Are Returned
4547 @cindex aggregates as return values
4548 @cindex large return values
4549 @cindex returning aggregate values
4550 @cindex structure value address
4551
4552 When a function value's mode is @code{BLKmode} (and in some other
4553 cases), the value is not returned according to
4554 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} (@pxref{Scalar Return}). Instead, the
4555 caller passes the address of a block of memory in which the value
4556 should be stored. This address is called the @dfn{structure value
4557 address}.
4558
4559 This section describes how to control returning structure values in
4560 memory.
4561
4562 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY (const_tree @var{type}, const_tree @var{fntype})
4563 This target hook should return a nonzero value to say to return the
4564 function value in memory, just as large structures are always returned.
4565 Here @var{type} will be the data type of the value, and @var{fntype}
4566 will be the type of the function doing the returning, or @code{NULL} for
4567 libcalls.
4568
4569 Note that values of mode @code{BLKmode} must be explicitly handled
4570 by this function. Also, the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
4571 takes effect regardless of this macro. On most systems, it is
4572 possible to leave the hook undefined; this causes a default
4573 definition to be used, whose value is the constant 1 for @code{BLKmode}
4574 values, and 0 otherwise.
4575
4576 Do not use this hook to indicate that structures and unions should always
4577 be returned in memory. You should instead use @code{DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN}
4578 to indicate this.
4579 @end deftypefn
4580
4581 @defmac DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
4582 Define this macro to be 1 if all structure and union return values must be
4583 in memory. Since this results in slower code, this should be defined
4584 only if needed for compatibility with other compilers or with an ABI@.
4585 If you define this macro to be 0, then the conventions used for structure
4586 and union return values are decided by the @code{TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY}
4587 target hook.
4588
4589 If not defined, this defaults to the value 1.
4590 @end defmac
4591
4592 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{incoming})
4593 This target hook should return the location of the structure value
4594 address (normally a @code{mem} or @code{reg}), or 0 if the address is
4595 passed as an ``invisible'' first argument. Note that @var{fndecl} may
4596 be @code{NULL}, for libcalls. You do not need to define this target
4597 hook if the address is always passed as an ``invisible'' first
4598 argument.
4599
4600 On some architectures the place where the structure value address
4601 is found by the called function is not the same place that the
4602 caller put it. This can be due to register windows, or it could
4603 be because the function prologue moves it to a different place.
4604 @var{incoming} is @code{1} or @code{2} when the location is needed in
4605 the context of the called function, and @code{0} in the context of
4606 the caller.
4607
4608 If @var{incoming} is nonzero and the address is to be found on the
4609 stack, return a @code{mem} which refers to the frame pointer. If
4610 @var{incoming} is @code{2}, the result is being used to fetch the
4611 structure value address at the beginning of a function. If you need
4612 to emit adjusting code, you should do it at this point.
4613 @end deftypefn
4614
4615 @defmac PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
4616 Define this macro if the usual system convention on the target machine
4617 for returning structures and unions is for the called function to return
4618 the address of a static variable containing the value.
4619
4620 Do not define this if the usual system convention is for the caller to
4621 pass an address to the subroutine.
4622
4623 This macro has effect in @option{-fpcc-struct-return} mode, but it does
4624 nothing when you use @option{-freg-struct-return} mode.
4625 @end defmac
4626
4627 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_GET_RAW_RESULT_MODE (int @var{regno})
4628 This target hook returns the mode to be used when accessing raw return registers in @code{__builtin_return}. Define this macro if the value in @var{reg_raw_mode} is not correct.
4629 @end deftypefn
4630
4631 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_GET_RAW_ARG_MODE (int @var{regno})
4632 This target hook returns the mode to be used when accessing raw argument registers in @code{__builtin_apply_args}. Define this macro if the value in @var{reg_raw_mode} is not correct.
4633 @end deftypefn
4634
4635 @node Caller Saves
4636 @subsection Caller-Saves Register Allocation
4637
4638 If you enable it, GCC can save registers around function calls. This
4639 makes it possible to use call-clobbered registers to hold variables that
4640 must live across calls.
4641
4642 @defmac CALLER_SAVE_PROFITABLE (@var{refs}, @var{calls})
4643 A C expression to determine whether it is worthwhile to consider placing
4644 a pseudo-register in a call-clobbered hard register and saving and
4645 restoring it around each function call. The expression should be 1 when
4646 this is worth doing, and 0 otherwise.
4647
4648 If you don't define this macro, a default is used which is good on most
4649 machines: @code{4 * @var{calls} < @var{refs}}.
4650 @end defmac
4651
4652 @defmac HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE (@var{regno}, @var{nregs})
4653 A C expression specifying which mode is required for saving @var{nregs}
4654 of a pseudo-register in call-clobbered hard register @var{regno}. If
4655 @var{regno} is unsuitable for caller save, @code{VOIDmode} should be
4656 returned. For most machines this macro need not be defined since GCC
4657 will select the smallest suitable mode.
4658 @end defmac
4659
4660 @node Function Entry
4661 @subsection Function Entry and Exit
4662 @cindex function entry and exit
4663 @cindex prologue
4664 @cindex epilogue
4665
4666 This section describes the macros that output function entry
4667 (@dfn{prologue}) and exit (@dfn{epilogue}) code.
4668
4669 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
4670 If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for entry to a
4671 function. The prologue is responsible for setting up the stack frame,
4672 initializing the frame pointer register, saving registers that must be
4673 saved, and allocating @var{size} additional bytes of storage for the
4674 local variables. @var{size} is an integer. @var{file} is a stdio
4675 stream to which the assembler code should be output.
4676
4677 The label for the beginning of the function need not be output by this
4678 macro. That has already been done when the macro is run.
4679
4680 @findex regs_ever_live
4681 To determine which registers to save, the macro can refer to the array
4682 @code{regs_ever_live}: element @var{r} is nonzero if hard register
4683 @var{r} is used anywhere within the function. This implies the function
4684 prologue should save register @var{r}, provided it is not one of the
4685 call-used registers. (@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must likewise use
4686 @code{regs_ever_live}.)
4687
4688 On machines that have ``register windows'', the function entry code does
4689 not save on the stack the registers that are in the windows, even if
4690 they are supposed to be preserved by function calls; instead it takes
4691 appropriate steps to ``push'' the register stack, if any non-call-used
4692 registers are used in the function.
4693
4694 @findex frame_pointer_needed
4695 On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4696 function entry code must vary accordingly; it must set up the frame
4697 pointer if one is wanted, and not otherwise. To determine whether a
4698 frame pointer is in wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4699 @code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 at run
4700 time in a function that needs a frame pointer. @xref{Elimination}.
4701
4702 The function entry code is responsible for allocating any stack space
4703 required for the function. This stack space consists of the regions
4704 listed below. In most cases, these regions are allocated in the
4705 order listed, with the last listed region closest to the top of the
4706 stack (the lowest address if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and
4707 the highest address if it is not defined). You can use a different order
4708 for a machine if doing so is more convenient or required for
4709 compatibility reasons. Except in cases where required by standard
4710 or by a debugger, there is no reason why the stack layout used by GCC
4711 need agree with that used by other compilers for a machine.
4712 @end deftypefn
4713
4714 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4715 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the end of a
4716 prologue. This should be used when the function prologue is being
4717 emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4718 emitted. @xref{prologue instruction pattern}.
4719 @end deftypefn
4720
4721 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_BEGIN_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4722 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the start of an
4723 epilogue. This should be used when the function epilogue is being
4724 emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4725 emitted. @xref{epilogue instruction pattern}.
4726 @end deftypefn
4727
4728 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
4729 If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for exit from a
4730 function. The epilogue is responsible for restoring the saved
4731 registers and stack pointer to their values when the function was
4732 called, and returning control to the caller. This macro takes the
4733 same arguments as the macro @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}, and the
4734 registers to restore are determined from @code{regs_ever_live} and
4735 @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} in the same way.
4736
4737 On some machines, there is a single instruction that does all the work
4738 of returning from the function. On these machines, give that
4739 instruction the name @samp{return} and do not define the macro
4740 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} at all.
4741
4742 Do not define a pattern named @samp{return} if you want the
4743 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to be used. If you want the target
4744 switches to control whether return instructions or epilogues are used,
4745 define a @samp{return} pattern with a validity condition that tests the
4746 target switches appropriately. If the @samp{return} pattern's validity
4747 condition is false, epilogues will be used.
4748
4749 On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4750 function exit code must vary accordingly. Sometimes the code for these
4751 two cases is completely different. To determine whether a frame pointer
4752 is wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4753 @code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 when compiling
4754 a function that needs a frame pointer.
4755
4756 Normally, @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
4757 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must treat leaf functions specially.
4758 The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
4759 function. @xref{Leaf Functions}.
4760
4761 On some machines, some functions pop their arguments on exit while
4762 others leave that for the caller to do. For example, the 68020 when
4763 given @option{-mrtd} pops arguments in functions that take a fixed
4764 number of arguments.
4765
4766 @findex current_function_pops_args
4767 Your definition of the macro @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} decides which
4768 functions pop their own arguments. @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}
4769 needs to know what was decided. The number of bytes of the current
4770 function's arguments that this function should pop is available in
4771 @code{crtl->args.pops_args}. @xref{Scalar Return}.
4772 @end deftypefn
4773
4774 @itemize @bullet
4775 @item
4776 @findex current_function_pretend_args_size
4777 A region of @code{current_function_pretend_args_size} bytes of
4778 uninitialized space just underneath the first argument arriving on the
4779 stack. (This may not be at the very start of the allocated stack region
4780 if the calling sequence has pushed anything else since pushing the stack
4781 arguments. But usually, on such machines, nothing else has been pushed
4782 yet, because the function prologue itself does all the pushing.) This
4783 region is used on machines where an argument may be passed partly in
4784 registers and partly in memory, and, in some cases to support the
4785 features in @code{<stdarg.h>}.
4786
4787 @item
4788 An area of memory used to save certain registers used by the function.
4789 The size of this area, which may also include space for such things as
4790 the return address and pointers to previous stack frames, is
4791 machine-specific and usually depends on which registers have been used
4792 in the function. Machines with register windows often do not require
4793 a save area.
4794
4795 @item
4796 A region of at least @var{size} bytes, possibly rounded up to an allocation
4797 boundary, to contain the local variables of the function. On some machines,
4798 this region and the save area may occur in the opposite order, with the
4799 save area closer to the top of the stack.
4800
4801 @item
4802 @cindex @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} and stack frames
4803 Optionally, when @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, a region of
4804 @code{current_function_outgoing_args_size} bytes to be used for outgoing
4805 argument lists of the function. @xref{Stack Arguments}.
4806 @end itemize
4807
4808 @defmac EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
4809 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if the return
4810 instruction or the function epilogue ignores the value of the stack
4811 pointer; in other words, if it is safe to delete an instruction to
4812 adjust the stack pointer before a return from the function. The
4813 default is 0.
4814
4815 Note that this macro's value is relevant only for functions for which
4816 frame pointers are maintained. It is never safe to delete a final
4817 stack adjustment in a function that has no frame pointer, and the
4818 compiler knows this regardless of @code{EXIT_IGNORE_STACK}.
4819 @end defmac
4820
4821 @defmac EPILOGUE_USES (@var{regno})
4822 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4823 used by the epilogue or the @samp{return} pattern. The stack and frame
4824 pointer registers are already assumed to be used as needed.
4825 @end defmac
4826
4827 @defmac EH_USES (@var{regno})
4828 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4829 used by the exception handling mechanism, and so should be considered live
4830 on entry to an exception edge.
4831 @end defmac
4832
4833 @defmac DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE
4834 Define this macro if the function epilogue contains delay slots to which
4835 instructions from the rest of the function can be ``moved''. The
4836 definition should be a C expression whose value is an integer
4837 representing the number of delay slots there.
4838 @end defmac
4839
4840 @defmac ELIGIBLE_FOR_EPILOGUE_DELAY (@var{insn}, @var{n})
4841 A C expression that returns 1 if @var{insn} can be placed in delay
4842 slot number @var{n} of the epilogue.
4843
4844 The argument @var{n} is an integer which identifies the delay slot now
4845 being considered (since different slots may have different rules of
4846 eligibility). It is never negative and is always less than the number
4847 of epilogue delay slots (what @code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE} returns).
4848 If you reject a particular insn for a given delay slot, in principle, it
4849 may be reconsidered for a subsequent delay slot. Also, other insns may
4850 (at least in principle) be considered for the so far unfilled delay
4851 slot.
4852
4853 @findex current_function_epilogue_delay_list
4854 @findex final_scan_insn
4855 The insns accepted to fill the epilogue delay slots are put in an RTL
4856 list made with @code{insn_list} objects, stored in the variable
4857 @code{current_function_epilogue_delay_list}. The insn for the first
4858 delay slot comes first in the list. Your definition of the macro
4859 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} should fill the delay slots by
4860 outputting the insns in this list, usually by calling
4861 @code{final_scan_insn}.
4862
4863 You need not define this macro if you did not define
4864 @code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE}.
4865 @end defmac
4866
4867 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, tree @var{function})
4868 A function that outputs the assembler code for a thunk
4869 function, used to implement C++ virtual function calls with multiple
4870 inheritance. The thunk acts as a wrapper around a virtual function,
4871 adjusting the implicit object parameter before handing control off to
4872 the real function.
4873
4874 First, emit code to add the integer @var{delta} to the location that
4875 contains the incoming first argument. Assume that this argument
4876 contains a pointer, and is the one used to pass the @code{this} pointer
4877 in C++. This is the incoming argument @emph{before} the function prologue,
4878 e.g.@: @samp{%o0} on a sparc. The addition must preserve the values of
4879 all other incoming arguments.
4880
4881 Then, if @var{vcall_offset} is nonzero, an additional adjustment should be
4882 made after adding @code{delta}. In particular, if @var{p} is the
4883 adjusted pointer, the following adjustment should be made:
4884
4885 @smallexample
4886 p += (*((ptrdiff_t **)p))[vcall_offset/sizeof(ptrdiff_t)]
4887 @end smallexample
4888
4889 After the additions, emit code to jump to @var{function}, which is a
4890 @code{FUNCTION_DECL}. This is a direct pure jump, not a call, and does
4891 not touch the return address. Hence returning from @var{FUNCTION} will
4892 return to whoever called the current @samp{thunk}.
4893
4894 The effect must be as if @var{function} had been called directly with
4895 the adjusted first argument. This macro is responsible for emitting all
4896 of the code for a thunk function; @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4897 and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} are not invoked.
4898
4899 The @var{thunk_fndecl} is redundant. (@var{delta} and @var{function}
4900 have already been extracted from it.) It might possibly be useful on
4901 some targets, but probably not.
4902
4903 If you do not define this macro, the target-independent code in the C++
4904 front end will generate a less efficient heavyweight thunk that calls
4905 @var{function} instead of jumping to it. The generic approach does
4906 not support varargs.
4907 @end deftypefn
4908
4909 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (const_tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, const_tree @var{function})
4910 A function that returns true if TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK would be able
4911 to output the assembler code for the thunk function specified by the
4912 arguments it is passed, and false otherwise. In the latter case, the
4913 generic approach will be used by the C++ front end, with the limitations
4914 previously exposed.
4915 @end deftypefn
4916
4917 @node Profiling
4918 @subsection Generating Code for Profiling
4919 @cindex profiling, code generation
4920
4921 These macros will help you generate code for profiling.
4922
4923 @defmac FUNCTION_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
4924 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
4925 assembler code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount}.
4926
4927 @findex mcount
4928 The details of how @code{mcount} expects to be called are determined by
4929 your operating system environment, not by GCC@. To figure them out,
4930 compile a small program for profiling using the system's installed C
4931 compiler and look at the assembler code that results.
4932
4933 Older implementations of @code{mcount} expect the address of a counter
4934 variable to be loaded into some register. The name of this variable is
4935 @samp{LP} followed by the number @var{labelno}, so you would generate
4936 the name using @samp{LP%d} in a @code{fprintf}.
4937 @end defmac
4938
4939 @defmac PROFILE_HOOK
4940 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some assembly
4941 code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount} even the target does
4942 not support profiling.
4943 @end defmac
4944
4945 @defmac NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
4946 Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if the
4947 @code{mcount} subroutine on your system does not need a counter variable
4948 allocated for each function. This is true for almost all modern
4949 implementations. If you define this macro, you must not use the
4950 @var{labelno} argument to @code{FUNCTION_PROFILER}.
4951 @end defmac
4952
4953 @defmac PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
4954 Define this macro if the code for function profiling should come before
4955 the function prologue. Normally, the profiling code comes after.
4956 @end defmac
4957
4958 @node Tail Calls
4959 @subsection Permitting tail calls
4960 @cindex tail calls
4961
4962 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{exp})
4963 True if it is ok to do sibling call optimization for the specified
4964 call expression @var{exp}. @var{decl} will be the called function,
4965 or @code{NULL} if this is an indirect call.
4966
4967 It is not uncommon for limitations of calling conventions to prevent
4968 tail calls to functions outside the current unit of translation, or
4969 during PIC compilation. The hook is used to enforce these restrictions,
4970 as the @code{sibcall} md pattern can not fail, or fall over to a
4971 ``normal'' call. The criteria for successful sibling call optimization
4972 may vary greatly between different architectures.
4973 @end deftypefn
4974
4975 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXTRA_LIVE_ON_ENTRY (bitmap @var{regs})
4976 Add any hard registers to @var{regs} that are live on entry to the
4977 function. This hook only needs to be defined to provide registers that
4978 cannot be found by examination of FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P, the callee saved
4979 registers, STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM, STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM,
4980 TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, EH_USES,
4981 FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, and the PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM.
4982 @end deftypefn
4983
4984 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_UP_BY_PROLOGUE (struct hard_reg_set_container *@var{})
4985 This hook should add additional registers that are computed by the prologue to the hard regset for shrink-wrapping optimization purposes.
4986 @end deftypefn
4987
4988 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_WARN_FUNC_RETURN (tree)
4989 True if a function's return statements should be checked for matching the function's return type. This includes checking for falling off the end of a non-void function. Return false if no such check should be made.
4990 @end deftypefn
4991
4992 @node Stack Smashing Protection
4993 @subsection Stack smashing protection
4994 @cindex stack smashing protection
4995
4996 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_GUARD (void)
4997 This hook returns a @code{DECL} node for the external variable to use
4998 for the stack protection guard. This variable is initialized by the
4999 runtime to some random value and is used to initialize the guard value
5000 that is placed at the top of the local stack frame. The type of this
5001 variable must be @code{ptr_type_node}.
5002
5003 The default version of this hook creates a variable called
5004 @samp{__stack_chk_guard}, which is normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
5005 @end deftypefn
5006
5007 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_FAIL (void)
5008 This hook returns a @code{CALL_EXPR} that alerts the runtime that the
5009 stack protect guard variable has been modified. This expression should
5010 involve a call to a @code{noreturn} function.
5011
5012 The default version of this hook invokes a function called
5013 @samp{__stack_chk_fail}, taking no arguments. This function is
5014 normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
5015 @end deftypefn
5016
5017 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_SUPPORTS_SPLIT_STACK (bool @var{report}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
5018 Whether this target supports splitting the stack when the options described in @var{opts} have been passed. This is called after options have been parsed, so the target may reject splitting the stack in some configurations. The default version of this hook returns false. If @var{report} is true, this function may issue a warning or error; if @var{report} is false, it must simply return a value
5019 @end deftypefn
5020
5021 @node Varargs
5022 @section Implementing the Varargs Macros
5023 @cindex varargs implementation
5024
5025 GCC comes with an implementation of @code{<varargs.h>} and
5026 @code{<stdarg.h>} that work without change on machines that pass arguments
5027 on the stack. Other machines require their own implementations of
5028 varargs, and the two machine independent header files must have
5029 conditionals to include it.
5030
5031 ISO @code{<stdarg.h>} differs from traditional @code{<varargs.h>} mainly in
5032 the calling convention for @code{va_start}. The traditional
5033 implementation takes just one argument, which is the variable in which
5034 to store the argument pointer. The ISO implementation of
5035 @code{va_start} takes an additional second argument. The user is
5036 supposed to write the last named argument of the function here.
5037
5038 However, @code{va_start} should not use this argument. The way to find
5039 the end of the named arguments is with the built-in functions described
5040 below.
5041
5042 @defmac __builtin_saveregs ()
5043 Use this built-in function to save the argument registers in memory so
5044 that the varargs mechanism can access them. Both ISO and traditional
5045 versions of @code{va_start} must use @code{__builtin_saveregs}, unless
5046 you use @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} (see below) instead.
5047
5048 On some machines, @code{__builtin_saveregs} is open-coded under the
5049 control of the target hook @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. On
5050 other machines, it calls a routine written in assembler language,
5051 found in @file{libgcc2.c}.
5052
5053 Code generated for the call to @code{__builtin_saveregs} appears at the
5054 beginning of the function, as opposed to where the call to
5055 @code{__builtin_saveregs} is written, regardless of what the code is.
5056 This is because the registers must be saved before the function starts
5057 to use them for its own purposes.
5058 @c i rewrote the first sentence above to fix an overfull hbox. --mew
5059 @c 10feb93
5060 @end defmac
5061
5062 @defmac __builtin_next_arg (@var{lastarg})
5063 This builtin returns the address of the first anonymous stack
5064 argument, as type @code{void *}. If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, it
5065 returns the address of the location above the first anonymous stack
5066 argument. Use it in @code{va_start} to initialize the pointer for
5067 fetching arguments from the stack. Also use it in @code{va_start} to
5068 verify that the second parameter @var{lastarg} is the last named argument
5069 of the current function.
5070 @end defmac
5071
5072 @defmac __builtin_classify_type (@var{object})
5073 Since each machine has its own conventions for which data types are
5074 passed in which kind of register, your implementation of @code{va_arg}
5075 has to embody these conventions. The easiest way to categorize the
5076 specified data type is to use @code{__builtin_classify_type} together
5077 with @code{sizeof} and @code{__alignof__}.
5078
5079 @code{__builtin_classify_type} ignores the value of @var{object},
5080 considering only its data type. It returns an integer describing what
5081 kind of type that is---integer, floating, pointer, structure, and so on.
5082
5083 The file @file{typeclass.h} defines an enumeration that you can use to
5084 interpret the values of @code{__builtin_classify_type}.
5085 @end defmac
5086
5087 These machine description macros help implement varargs:
5088
5089 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS (void)
5090 If defined, this hook produces the machine-specific code for a call to
5091 @code{__builtin_saveregs}. This code will be moved to the very
5092 beginning of the function, before any parameter access are made. The
5093 return value of this function should be an RTX that contains the value
5094 to use as the return of @code{__builtin_saveregs}.
5095 @end deftypefn
5096
5097 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS (cumulative_args_t @var{args_so_far}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, int *@var{pretend_args_size}, int @var{second_time})
5098 This target hook offers an alternative to using
5099 @code{__builtin_saveregs} and defining the hook
5100 @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. Use it to store the anonymous
5101 register arguments into the stack so that all the arguments appear to
5102 have been passed consecutively on the stack. Once this is done, you can
5103 use the standard implementation of varargs that works for machines that
5104 pass all their arguments on the stack.
5105
5106 The argument @var{args_so_far} points to the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data
5107 structure, containing the values that are obtained after processing the
5108 named arguments. The arguments @var{mode} and @var{type} describe the
5109 last named argument---its machine mode and its data type as a tree node.
5110
5111 The target hook should do two things: first, push onto the stack all the
5112 argument registers @emph{not} used for the named arguments, and second,
5113 store the size of the data thus pushed into the @code{int}-valued
5114 variable pointed to by @var{pretend_args_size}. The value that you
5115 store here will serve as additional offset for setting up the stack
5116 frame.
5117
5118 Because you must generate code to push the anonymous arguments at
5119 compile time without knowing their data types,
5120 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is only useful on machines that
5121 have just a single category of argument register and use it uniformly
5122 for all data types.
5123
5124 If the argument @var{second_time} is nonzero, it means that the
5125 arguments of the function are being analyzed for the second time. This
5126 happens for an inline function, which is not actually compiled until the
5127 end of the source file. The hook @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} should
5128 not generate any instructions in this case.
5129 @end deftypefn
5130
5131 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING (cumulative_args_t @var{ca})
5132 Define this hook to return @code{true} if the location where a function
5133 argument is passed depends on whether or not it is a named argument.
5134
5135 This hook controls how the @var{named} argument to @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
5136 is set for varargs and stdarg functions. If this hook returns
5137 @code{true}, the @var{named} argument is always true for named
5138 arguments, and false for unnamed arguments. If it returns @code{false},
5139 but @code{TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED} returns @code{true},
5140 then all arguments are treated as named. Otherwise, all named arguments
5141 except the last are treated as named.
5142
5143 You need not define this hook if it always returns @code{false}.
5144 @end deftypefn
5145
5146 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED (cumulative_args_t @var{ca})
5147 If you need to conditionally change ABIs so that one works with
5148 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}, but the other works like neither
5149 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} nor @code{TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING} was
5150 defined, then define this hook to return @code{true} if
5151 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is used, @code{false} otherwise.
5152 Otherwise, you should not define this hook.
5153 @end deftypefn
5154
5155 @node Trampolines
5156 @section Trampolines for Nested Functions
5157 @cindex trampolines for nested functions
5158 @cindex nested functions, trampolines for
5159
5160 A @dfn{trampoline} is a small piece of code that is created at run time
5161 when the address of a nested function is taken. It normally resides on
5162 the stack, in the stack frame of the containing function. These macros
5163 tell GCC how to generate code to allocate and initialize a
5164 trampoline.
5165
5166 The instructions in the trampoline must do two things: load a constant
5167 address into the static chain register, and jump to the real address of
5168 the nested function. On CISC machines such as the m68k, this requires
5169 two instructions, a move immediate and a jump. Then the two addresses
5170 exist in the trampoline as word-long immediate operands. On RISC
5171 machines, it is often necessary to load each address into a register in
5172 two parts. Then pieces of each address form separate immediate
5173 operands.
5174
5175 The code generated to initialize the trampoline must store the variable
5176 parts---the static chain value and the function address---into the
5177 immediate operands of the instructions. On a CISC machine, this is
5178 simply a matter of copying each address to a memory reference at the
5179 proper offset from the start of the trampoline. On a RISC machine, it
5180 may be necessary to take out pieces of the address and store them
5181 separately.
5182
5183 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE (FILE *@var{f})
5184 This hook is called by @code{assemble_trampoline_template} to output,
5185 on the stream @var{f}, assembler code for a block of data that contains
5186 the constant parts of a trampoline. This code should not include a
5187 label---the label is taken care of automatically.
5188
5189 If you do not define this hook, it means no template is needed
5190 for the target. Do not define this hook on systems where the block move
5191 code to copy the trampoline into place would be larger than the code
5192 to generate it on the spot.
5193 @end deftypefn
5194
5195 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
5196 Return the section into which the trampoline template is to be placed
5197 (@pxref{Sections}). The default value is @code{readonly_data_section}.
5198 @end defmac
5199
5200 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
5201 A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
5202 @end defmac
5203
5204 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
5205 Alignment required for trampolines, in bits.
5206
5207 If you don't define this macro, the value of @code{FUNCTION_ALIGNMENT}
5208 is used for aligning trampolines.
5209 @end defmac
5210
5211 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT (rtx @var{m_tramp}, tree @var{fndecl}, rtx @var{static_chain})
5212 This hook is called to initialize a trampoline.
5213 @var{m_tramp} is an RTX for the memory block for the trampoline; @var{fndecl}
5214 is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} for the nested function; @var{static_chain} is an
5215 RTX for the static chain value that should be passed to the function
5216 when it is called.
5217
5218 If the target defines @code{TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE}, then the
5219 first thing this hook should do is emit a block move into @var{m_tramp}
5220 from the memory block returned by @code{assemble_trampoline_template}.
5221 Note that the block move need only cover the constant parts of the
5222 trampoline. If the target isolates the variable parts of the trampoline
5223 to the end, not all @code{TRAMPOLINE_SIZE} bytes need be copied.
5224
5225 If the target requires any other actions, such as flushing caches or
5226 enabling stack execution, these actions should be performed after
5227 initializing the trampoline proper.
5228 @end deftypefn
5229
5230 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS (rtx @var{addr})
5231 This hook should perform any machine-specific adjustment in
5232 the address of the trampoline. Its argument contains the address of the
5233 memory block that was passed to @code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT}. In case
5234 the address to be used for a function call should be different from the
5235 address at which the template was stored, the different address should
5236 be returned; otherwise @var{addr} should be returned unchanged.
5237 If this hook is not defined, @var{addr} will be used for function calls.
5238 @end deftypefn
5239
5240 Implementing trampolines is difficult on many machines because they have
5241 separate instruction and data caches. Writing into a stack location
5242 fails to clear the memory in the instruction cache, so when the program
5243 jumps to that location, it executes the old contents.
5244
5245 Here are two possible solutions. One is to clear the relevant parts of
5246 the instruction cache whenever a trampoline is set up. The other is to
5247 make all trampolines identical, by having them jump to a standard
5248 subroutine. The former technique makes trampoline execution faster; the
5249 latter makes initialization faster.
5250
5251 To clear the instruction cache when a trampoline is initialized, define
5252 the following macro.
5253
5254 @defmac CLEAR_INSN_CACHE (@var{beg}, @var{end})
5255 If defined, expands to a C expression clearing the @emph{instruction
5256 cache} in the specified interval. The definition of this macro would
5257 typically be a series of @code{asm} statements. Both @var{beg} and
5258 @var{end} are both pointer expressions.
5259 @end defmac
5260
5261 To use a standard subroutine, define the following macro. In addition,
5262 you must make sure that the instructions in a trampoline fill an entire
5263 cache line with identical instructions, or else ensure that the
5264 beginning of the trampoline code is always aligned at the same point in
5265 its cache line. Look in @file{m68k.h} as a guide.
5266
5267 @defmac TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
5268 Define this macro if trampolines need a special subroutine to do their
5269 work. The macro should expand to a series of @code{asm} statements
5270 which will be compiled with GCC@. They go in a library function named
5271 @code{__transfer_from_trampoline}.
5272
5273 If you need to avoid executing the ordinary prologue code of a compiled
5274 C function when you jump to the subroutine, you can do so by placing a
5275 special label of your own in the assembler code. Use one @code{asm}
5276 statement to generate an assembler label, and another to make the label
5277 global. Then trampolines can use that label to jump directly to your
5278 special assembler code.
5279 @end defmac
5280
5281 @node Library Calls
5282 @section Implicit Calls to Library Routines
5283 @cindex library subroutine names
5284 @cindex @file{libgcc.a}
5285
5286 @c prevent bad page break with this line
5287 Here is an explanation of implicit calls to library routines.
5288
5289 @defmac DECLARE_LIBRARY_RENAMES
5290 This macro, if defined, should expand to a piece of C code that will get
5291 expanded when compiling functions for libgcc.a. It can be used to
5292 provide alternate names for GCC's internal library functions if there
5293 are ABI-mandated names that the compiler should provide.
5294 @end defmac
5295
5296 @findex set_optab_libfunc
5297 @findex init_one_libfunc
5298 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS (void)
5299 This hook should declare additional library routines or rename
5300 existing ones, using the functions @code{set_optab_libfunc} and
5301 @code{init_one_libfunc} defined in @file{optabs.c}.
5302 @code{init_optabs} calls this macro after initializing all the normal
5303 library routines.
5304
5305 The default is to do nothing. Most ports don't need to define this hook.
5306 @end deftypefn
5307
5308 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX
5309 If false (the default), internal library routines start with two
5310 underscores. If set to true, these routines start with @code{__gnu_}
5311 instead. E.g., @code{__muldi3} changes to @code{__gnu_muldi3}. This
5312 currently only affects functions defined in @file{libgcc2.c}. If this
5313 is set to true, the @file{tm.h} file must also
5314 @code{#define LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX}.
5315 @end deftypevr
5316
5317 @defmac FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL (@var{mode}, @var{comparison})
5318 This macro should return @code{true} if the library routine that
5319 implements the floating point comparison operator @var{comparison} in
5320 mode @var{mode} will return a boolean, and @var{false} if it will
5321 return a tristate.
5322
5323 GCC's own floating point libraries return tristates from the
5324 comparison operators, so the default returns false always. Most ports
5325 don't need to define this macro.
5326 @end defmac
5327
5328 @defmac TARGET_LIB_INT_CMP_BIASED
5329 This macro should evaluate to @code{true} if the integer comparison
5330 functions (like @code{__cmpdi2}) return 0 to indicate that the first
5331 operand is smaller than the second, 1 to indicate that they are equal,
5332 and 2 to indicate that the first operand is greater than the second.
5333 If this macro evaluates to @code{false} the comparison functions return
5334 @minus{}1, 0, and 1 instead of 0, 1, and 2. If the target uses the routines
5335 in @file{libgcc.a}, you do not need to define this macro.
5336 @end defmac
5337
5338 @cindex @code{EDOM}, implicit usage
5339 @findex matherr
5340 @defmac TARGET_EDOM
5341 The value of @code{EDOM} on the target machine, as a C integer constant
5342 expression. If you don't define this macro, GCC does not attempt to
5343 deposit the value of @code{EDOM} into @code{errno} directly. Look in
5344 @file{/usr/include/errno.h} to find the value of @code{EDOM} on your
5345 system.
5346
5347 If you do not define @code{TARGET_EDOM}, then compiled code reports
5348 domain errors by calling the library function and letting it report the
5349 error. If mathematical functions on your system use @code{matherr} when
5350 there is an error, then you should leave @code{TARGET_EDOM} undefined so
5351 that @code{matherr} is used normally.
5352 @end defmac
5353
5354 @cindex @code{errno}, implicit usage
5355 @defmac GEN_ERRNO_RTX
5356 Define this macro as a C expression to create an rtl expression that
5357 refers to the global ``variable'' @code{errno}. (On certain systems,
5358 @code{errno} may not actually be a variable.) If you don't define this
5359 macro, a reasonable default is used.
5360 @end defmac
5361
5362 @cindex C99 math functions, implicit usage
5363 @defmac TARGET_C99_FUNCTIONS
5364 When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize @code{sin} calls into
5365 @code{sinf} and similarly for other functions defined by C99 standard. The
5366 default is zero because a number of existing systems lack support for these
5367 functions in their runtime so this macro needs to be redefined to one on
5368 systems that do support the C99 runtime.
5369 @end defmac
5370
5371 @cindex sincos math function, implicit usage
5372 @defmac TARGET_HAS_SINCOS
5373 When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize calls to @code{sin}
5374 and @code{cos} with the same argument to a call to @code{sincos}. The
5375 default is zero. The target has to provide the following functions:
5376 @smallexample
5377 void sincos(double x, double *sin, double *cos);
5378 void sincosf(float x, float *sin, float *cos);
5379 void sincosl(long double x, long double *sin, long double *cos);
5380 @end smallexample
5381 @end defmac
5382
5383 @defmac NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
5384 Set this macro to 1 to use the "NeXT" Objective-C message sending conventions
5385 by default. This calling convention involves passing the object, the selector
5386 and the method arguments all at once to the method-lookup library function.
5387 This is the usual setting when targeting Darwin/Mac OS X systems, which have
5388 the NeXT runtime installed.
5389
5390 If the macro is set to 0, the "GNU" Objective-C message sending convention
5391 will be used by default. This convention passes just the object and the
5392 selector to the method-lookup function, which returns a pointer to the method.
5393
5394 In either case, it remains possible to select code-generation for the alternate
5395 scheme, by means of compiler command line switches.
5396 @end defmac
5397
5398 @node Addressing Modes
5399 @section Addressing Modes
5400 @cindex addressing modes
5401
5402 @c prevent bad page break with this line
5403 This is about addressing modes.
5404
5405 @defmac HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
5406 @defmacx HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
5407 @defmacx HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
5408 @defmacx HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
5409 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre-increment,
5410 pre-decrement, post-increment, or post-decrement addressing respectively.
5411 @end defmac
5412
5413 @defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
5414 @defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
5415 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5416 post-address side-effect generation involving constants other than
5417 the size of the memory operand.
5418 @end defmac
5419
5420 @defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
5421 @defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
5422 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5423 post-address side-effect generation involving a register displacement.
5424 @end defmac
5425
5426 @defmac CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (@var{x})
5427 A C expression that is 1 if the RTX @var{x} is a constant which
5428 is a valid address. On most machines the default definition of
5429 @code{(CONSTANT_P (@var{x}) && GET_CODE (@var{x}) != CONST_DOUBLE)}
5430 is acceptable, but a few machines are more restrictive as to which
5431 constant addresses are supported.
5432 @end defmac
5433
5434 @defmac CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5435 @code{CONSTANT_P}, which is defined by target-independent code,
5436 accepts integer-values expressions whose values are not explicitly
5437 known, such as @code{symbol_ref}, @code{label_ref}, and @code{high}
5438 expressions and @code{const} arithmetic expressions, in addition to
5439 @code{const_int} and @code{const_double} expressions.
5440 @end defmac
5441
5442 @defmac MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
5443 A number, the maximum number of registers that can appear in a valid
5444 memory address. Note that it is up to you to specify a value equal to
5445 the maximum number that @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} would ever
5446 accept.
5447 @end defmac
5448
5449 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, bool @var{strict})
5450 A function that returns whether @var{x} (an RTX) is a legitimate memory
5451 address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5452
5453 Legitimate addresses are defined in two variants: a strict variant and a
5454 non-strict one. The @var{strict} parameter chooses which variant is
5455 desired by the caller.
5456
5457 The strict variant is used in the reload pass. It must be defined so
5458 that any pseudo-register that has not been allocated a hard register is
5459 considered a memory reference. This is because in contexts where some
5460 kind of register is required, a pseudo-register with no hard register
5461 must be rejected. For non-hard registers, the strict variant should look
5462 up the @code{reg_renumber} array; it should then proceed using the hard
5463 register number in the array, or treat the pseudo as a memory reference
5464 if the array holds @code{-1}.
5465
5466 The non-strict variant is used in other passes. It must be defined to
5467 accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of
5468 register is required.
5469
5470 Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a @code{symbol_ref}
5471 and an integer are stored inside a @code{const} RTX to mark them as
5472 constant. Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums
5473 specifically as legitimate addresses. Normally you would simply
5474 recognize any @code{const} as legitimate.
5475
5476 Usually @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS} is not prepared to handle constant
5477 sums that are not marked with @code{const}. It assumes that a naked
5478 @code{plus} indicates indexing. If so, then you @emph{must} reject such
5479 naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will
5480 be given to @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
5481
5482 @cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} and address validation
5483 On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on
5484 the section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the
5485 target hook @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information
5486 into the @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. When you see a
5487 @code{const}, you will have to look inside it to find the
5488 @code{symbol_ref} in order to determine the section. @xref{Assembler
5489 Format}.
5490
5491 @cindex @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}
5492 Some ports are still using a deprecated legacy substitute for
5493 this hook, the @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} macro. This macro
5494 has this syntax:
5495
5496 @example
5497 #define GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{label})
5498 @end example
5499
5500 @noindent
5501 and should @code{goto @var{label}} if the address @var{x} is a valid
5502 address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5503
5504 @findex REG_OK_STRICT
5505 Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this
5506 macro define the macro @code{REG_OK_STRICT}. You should use an
5507 @code{#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT} conditional to define the strict variant in
5508 that case and the non-strict variant otherwise.
5509
5510 Using the hook is usually simpler because it limits the number of
5511 files that are recompiled when changes are made.
5512 @end deftypefn
5513
5514 @defmac TARGET_MEM_CONSTRAINT
5515 A single character to be used instead of the default @code{'m'}
5516 character for general memory addresses. This defines the constraint
5517 letter which matches the memory addresses accepted by
5518 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P}. Define this macro if you want to
5519 support new address formats in your back end without changing the
5520 semantics of the @code{'m'} constraint. This is necessary in order to
5521 preserve functionality of inline assembly constructs using the
5522 @code{'m'} constraint.
5523 @end defmac
5524
5525 @defmac FIND_BASE_TERM (@var{x})
5526 A C expression to determine the base term of address @var{x},
5527 or to provide a simplified version of @var{x} from which @file{alias.c}
5528 can easily find the base term. This macro is used in only two places:
5529 @code{find_base_value} and @code{find_base_term} in @file{alias.c}.
5530
5531 It is always safe for this macro to not be defined. It exists so
5532 that alias analysis can understand machine-dependent addresses.
5533
5534 The typical use of this macro is to handle addresses containing
5535 a label_ref or symbol_ref within an UNSPEC@.
5536 @end defmac
5537
5538 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x}, rtx @var{oldx}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
5539 This hook is given an invalid memory address @var{x} for an
5540 operand of mode @var{mode} and should try to return a valid memory
5541 address.
5542
5543 @findex break_out_memory_refs
5544 @var{x} will always be the result of a call to @code{break_out_memory_refs},
5545 and @var{oldx} will be the operand that was given to that function to produce
5546 @var{x}.
5547
5548 The code of the hook should not alter the substructure of
5549 @var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5550 should return the new @var{x}.
5551
5552 It is not necessary for this hook to come up with a legitimate address,
5553 with the exception of native TLS addresses (@pxref{Emulated TLS}).
5554 The compiler has standard ways of doing so in all cases. In fact, if
5555 the target supports only emulated TLS, it
5556 is safe to omit this hook or make it return @var{x} if it cannot find
5557 a valid way to legitimize the address. But often a machine-dependent
5558 strategy can generate better code.
5559 @end deftypefn
5560
5561 @defmac LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{opnum}, @var{type}, @var{ind_levels}, @var{win})
5562 A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x}, which is an address
5563 that needs reloading, with a valid memory address for an operand of mode
5564 @var{mode}. @var{win} will be a C statement label elsewhere in the code.
5565 It is not necessary to define this macro, but it might be useful for
5566 performance reasons.
5567
5568 For example, on the i386, it is sometimes possible to use a single
5569 reload register instead of two by reloading a sum of two pseudo
5570 registers into a register. On the other hand, for number of RISC
5571 processors offsets are limited so that often an intermediate address
5572 needs to be generated in order to address a stack slot. By defining
5573 @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} appropriately, the intermediate addresses
5574 generated for adjacent some stack slots can be made identical, and thus
5575 be shared.
5576
5577 @emph{Note}: This macro should be used with caution. It is necessary
5578 to know something of how reload works in order to effectively use this,
5579 and it is quite easy to produce macros that build in too much knowledge
5580 of reload internals.
5581
5582 @emph{Note}: This macro must be able to reload an address created by a
5583 previous invocation of this macro. If it fails to handle such addresses
5584 then the compiler may generate incorrect code or abort.
5585
5586 @findex push_reload
5587 The macro definition should use @code{push_reload} to indicate parts that
5588 need reloading; @var{opnum}, @var{type} and @var{ind_levels} are usually
5589 suitable to be passed unaltered to @code{push_reload}.
5590
5591 The code generated by this macro must not alter the substructure of
5592 @var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5593 should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
5594 This also applies to parts that you change indirectly by calling
5595 @code{push_reload}.
5596
5597 @findex strict_memory_address_p
5598 The macro definition may use @code{strict_memory_address_p} to test if
5599 the address has become legitimate.
5600
5601 @findex copy_rtx
5602 If you want to change only a part of @var{x}, one standard way of doing
5603 this is to use @code{copy_rtx}. Note, however, that it unshares only a
5604 single level of rtl. Thus, if the part to be changed is not at the
5605 top level, you'll need to replace first the top level.
5606 It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
5607 address; but often a machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
5608 @end defmac
5609
5610 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P (const_rtx @var{addr})
5611 This hook returns @code{true} if memory address @var{addr} can have
5612 different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5613 reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5614 but not others.
5615
5616 Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5617 effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5618 of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5619 addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5620
5621 You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5622
5623 The default version of this hook returns @code{false}.
5624 @end deftypefn
5625
5626 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x})
5627 This hook returns true if @var{x} is a legitimate constant for a
5628 @var{mode}-mode immediate operand on the target machine. You can assume that
5629 @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not check this.
5630
5631 The default definition returns true.
5632 @end deftypefn
5633
5634 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DELEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x})
5635 This hook is used to undo the possibly obfuscating effects of the
5636 @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} and @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} target
5637 macros. Some backend implementations of these macros wrap symbol
5638 references inside an @code{UNSPEC} rtx to represent PIC or similar
5639 addressing modes. This target hook allows GCC's optimizers to understand
5640 the semantics of these opaque @code{UNSPEC}s by converting them back
5641 into their original form.
5642 @end deftypefn
5643
5644 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CONST_NOT_OK_FOR_DEBUG_P (rtx @var{x})
5645 This hook should return true if @var{x} should not be emitted into
5646 debug sections.
5647 @end deftypefn
5648
5649 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x})
5650 This hook should return true if @var{x} is of a form that cannot (or
5651 should not) be spilled to the constant pool. @var{mode} is the mode
5652 of @var{x}.
5653
5654 The default version of this hook returns false.
5655
5656 The primary reason to define this hook is to prevent reload from
5657 deciding that a non-legitimate constant would be better reloaded
5658 from the constant pool instead of spilling and reloading a register
5659 holding the constant. This restriction is often true of addresses
5660 of TLS symbols for various targets.
5661 @end deftypefn
5662
5663 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_CONSTANT_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_rtx @var{x})
5664 This hook should return true if pool entries for constant @var{x} can
5665 be placed in an @code{object_block} structure. @var{mode} is the mode
5666 of @var{x}.
5667
5668 The default version returns false for all constants.
5669 @end deftypefn
5670
5671 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_RECIPROCAL (unsigned @var{fn}, bool @var{md_fn}, bool @var{sqrt})
5672 This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements reciprocal of
5673 the builtin function with builtin function code @var{fn}, or
5674 @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available. @var{md_fn} is true
5675 when @var{fn} is a code of a machine-dependent builtin function. When
5676 @var{sqrt} is true, additional optimizations that apply only to the reciprocal
5677 of a square root function are performed, and only reciprocals of @code{sqrt}
5678 function are valid.
5679 @end deftypefn
5680
5681 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MASK_FOR_LOAD (void)
5682 This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that given an
5683 address @var{addr} as an argument returns a mask @var{m} that can be
5684 used to extract from two vectors the relevant data that resides in
5685 @var{addr} in case @var{addr} is not properly aligned.
5686
5687 The autovectorizer, when vectorizing a load operation from an address
5688 @var{addr} that may be unaligned, will generate two vector loads from
5689 the two aligned addresses around @var{addr}. It then generates a
5690 @code{REALIGN_LOAD} operation to extract the relevant data from the
5691 two loaded vectors. The first two arguments to @code{REALIGN_LOAD},
5692 @var{v1} and @var{v2}, are the two vectors, each of size @var{VS}, and
5693 the third argument, @var{OFF}, defines how the data will be extracted
5694 from these two vectors: if @var{OFF} is 0, then the returned vector is
5695 @var{v2}; otherwise, the returned vector is composed from the last
5696 @var{VS}-@var{OFF} elements of @var{v1} concatenated to the first
5697 @var{OFF} elements of @var{v2}.
5698
5699 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will generate a call
5700 to @var{f} (using the DECL tree that this hook returns) and will
5701 use the return value of @var{f} as the argument @var{OFF} to
5702 @code{REALIGN_LOAD}. Therefore, the mask @var{m} returned by @var{f}
5703 should comply with the semantics expected by @code{REALIGN_LOAD}
5704 described above.
5705 If this hook is not defined, then @var{addr} will be used as
5706 the argument @var{OFF} to @code{REALIGN_LOAD}, in which case the low
5707 log2(@var{VS}) @minus{} 1 bits of @var{addr} will be considered.
5708 @end deftypefn
5709
5710 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZATION_COST (enum vect_cost_for_stmt @var{type_of_cost}, tree @var{vectype}, int @var{misalign})
5711 Returns cost of different scalar or vector statements for vectorization cost model.
5712 For vector memory operations the cost may depend on type (@var{vectype}) and
5713 misalignment value (@var{misalign}).
5714 @end deftypefn
5715
5716 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT_REACHABLE (const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{is_packed})
5717 Return true if vector alignment is reachable (by peeling N iterations) for the given type.
5718 @end deftypefn
5719
5720 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_VEC_PERM_CONST_OK (enum @var{machine_mode}, const unsigned char *@var{sel})
5721 Return true if a vector created for @code{vec_perm_const} is valid.
5722 @end deftypefn
5723
5724 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION (unsigned @var{code}, tree @var{dest_type}, tree @var{src_type})
5725 This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements conversion of the
5726 input vector of type @var{src_type} to type @var{dest_type}.
5727 The value of @var{code} is one of the enumerators in @code{enum tree_code} and
5728 specifies how the conversion is to be applied
5729 (truncation, rounding, etc.).
5730
5731 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use the
5732 @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION} target hook when vectorizing
5733 conversion. Otherwise, it will return @code{NULL_TREE}.
5734 @end deftypefn
5735
5736 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{vec_type_out}, tree @var{vec_type_in})
5737 This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the
5738 vectorized variant of the builtin function with builtin function code
5739 @var{code} or @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.
5740 The value of @var{fndecl} is the builtin function declaration. The
5741 return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type
5742 @var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}.
5743 @end deftypefn
5744
5745 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_SUPPORT_VECTOR_MISALIGNMENT (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, int @var{misalignment}, bool @var{is_packed})
5746 This hook should return true if the target supports misaligned vector
5747 store/load of a specific factor denoted in the @var{misalignment}
5748 parameter. The vector store/load should be of machine mode @var{mode} and
5749 the elements in the vectors should be of type @var{type}. @var{is_packed}
5750 parameter is true if the memory access is defined in a packed struct.
5751 @end deftypefn
5752
5753 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
5754 This hook should return the preferred mode for vectorizing scalar
5755 mode @var{mode}. The default is
5756 equal to @code{word_mode}, because the vectorizer can do some
5757 transformations even in absence of specialized @acronym{SIMD} hardware.
5758 @end deftypefn
5759
5760 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_VECTORIZE_AUTOVECTORIZE_VECTOR_SIZES (void)
5761 This hook should return a mask of sizes that should be iterated over
5762 after trying to autovectorize using the vector size derived from the
5763 mode returned by @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE}.
5764 The default is zero which means to not iterate over other vector sizes.
5765 @end deftypefn
5766
5767 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_VECTORIZE_INIT_COST (struct loop *@var{loop_info})
5768 This hook should initialize target-specific data structures in preparation for modeling the costs of vectorizing a loop or basic block. The default allocates three unsigned integers for accumulating costs for the prologue, body, and epilogue of the loop or basic block. If @var{loop_info} is non-NULL, it identifies the loop being vectorized; otherwise a single block is being vectorized.
5769 @end deftypefn
5770
5771 @deftypefn {Target Hook} unsigned TARGET_VECTORIZE_ADD_STMT_COST (void *@var{data}, int @var{count}, enum vect_cost_for_stmt @var{kind}, struct _stmt_vec_info *@var{stmt_info}, int @var{misalign}, enum vect_cost_model_location @var{where})
5772 This hook should update the target-specific @var{data} in response to adding @var{count} copies of the given @var{kind} of statement to a loop or basic block. The default adds the builtin vectorizer cost for the copies of the statement to the accumulator specified by @var{where}, (the prologue, body, or epilogue) and returns the amount added. The return value should be viewed as a tentative cost that may later be revised.
5773 @end deftypefn
5774
5775 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_VECTORIZE_FINISH_COST (void *@var{data}, unsigned *@var{prologue_cost}, unsigned *@var{body_cost}, unsigned *@var{epilogue_cost})
5776 This hook should complete calculations of the cost of vectorizing a loop or basic block based on @var{data}, and return the prologue, body, and epilogue costs as unsigned integers. The default returns the value of the three accumulators.
5777 @end deftypefn
5778
5779 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_VECTORIZE_DESTROY_COST_DATA (void *@var{data})
5780 This hook should release @var{data} and any related data structures allocated by TARGET_VECTORIZE_INIT_COST. The default releases the accumulator.
5781 @end deftypefn
5782
5783 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_TM_LOAD (tree)
5784 This hook should return the built-in decl needed to load a vector of the given type within a transaction.
5785 @end deftypefn
5786
5787 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_TM_STORE (tree)
5788 This hook should return the built-in decl needed to store a vector of the given type within a transaction.
5789 @end deftypefn
5790
5791 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_GATHER (const_tree @var{mem_vectype}, const_tree @var{index_type}, int @var{scale})
5792 Target builtin that implements vector gather operation. @var{mem_vectype}
5793 is the vector type of the load and @var{index_type} is scalar type of
5794 the index, scaled by @var{scale}.
5795 The default is @code{NULL_TREE} which means to not vectorize gather
5796 loads.
5797 @end deftypefn
5798
5799 @node Anchored Addresses
5800 @section Anchored Addresses
5801 @cindex anchored addresses
5802 @cindex @option{-fsection-anchors}
5803
5804 GCC usually addresses every static object as a separate entity.
5805 For example, if we have:
5806
5807 @smallexample
5808 static int a, b, c;
5809 int foo (void) @{ return a + b + c; @}
5810 @end smallexample
5811
5812 the code for @code{foo} will usually calculate three separate symbolic
5813 addresses: those of @code{a}, @code{b} and @code{c}. On some targets,
5814 it would be better to calculate just one symbolic address and access
5815 the three variables relative to it. The equivalent pseudocode would
5816 be something like:
5817
5818 @smallexample
5819 int foo (void)
5820 @{
5821 register int *xr = &x;
5822 return xr[&a - &x] + xr[&b - &x] + xr[&c - &x];
5823 @}
5824 @end smallexample
5825
5826 (which isn't valid C). We refer to shared addresses like @code{x} as
5827 ``section anchors''. Their use is controlled by @option{-fsection-anchors}.
5828
5829 The hooks below describe the target properties that GCC needs to know
5830 in order to make effective use of section anchors. It won't use
5831 section anchors at all unless either @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}
5832 or @code{TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET} is set to a nonzero value.
5833
5834 @deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5835 The minimum offset that should be applied to a section anchor.
5836 On most targets, it should be the smallest offset that can be
5837 applied to a base register while still giving a legitimate address
5838 for every mode. The default value is 0.
5839 @end deftypevr
5840
5841 @deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5842 Like @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}, but the maximum (inclusive)
5843 offset that should be applied to section anchors. The default
5844 value is 0.
5845 @end deftypevr
5846
5847 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ANCHOR (rtx @var{x})
5848 Write the assembly code to define section anchor @var{x}, which is a
5849 @code{SYMBOL_REF} for which @samp{SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})} is true.
5850 The hook is called with the assembly output position set to the beginning
5851 of @code{SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK (@var{x})}.
5852
5853 If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is available, the hook's default definition uses
5854 it to define the symbol as @samp{. + SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK_OFFSET (@var{x})}.
5855 If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is not available, the hook's default definition
5856 is @code{NULL}, which disables the use of section anchors altogether.
5857 @end deftypefn
5858
5859 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_ANCHORS_FOR_SYMBOL_P (const_rtx @var{x})
5860 Return true if GCC should attempt to use anchors to access @code{SYMBOL_REF}
5861 @var{x}. You can assume @samp{SYMBOL_REF_HAS_BLOCK_INFO_P (@var{x})} and
5862 @samp{!SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})}.
5863
5864 The default version is correct for most targets, but you might need to
5865 intercept this hook to handle things like target-specific attributes
5866 or target-specific sections.
5867 @end deftypefn
5868
5869 @node Condition Code
5870 @section Condition Code Status
5871 @cindex condition code status
5872
5873 The macros in this section can be split in two families, according to the
5874 two ways of representing condition codes in GCC.
5875
5876 The first representation is the so called @code{(cc0)} representation
5877 (@pxref{Jump Patterns}), where all instructions can have an implicit
5878 clobber of the condition codes. The second is the condition code
5879 register representation, which provides better schedulability for
5880 architectures that do have a condition code register, but on which
5881 most instructions do not affect it. The latter category includes
5882 most RISC machines.
5883
5884 The implicit clobbering poses a strong restriction on the placement of
5885 the definition and use of the condition code, which need to be in adjacent
5886 insns for machines using @code{(cc0)}. This can prevent important
5887 optimizations on some machines. For example, on the IBM RS/6000, there
5888 is a delay for taken branches unless the condition code register is set
5889 three instructions earlier than the conditional branch. The instruction
5890 scheduler cannot perform this optimization if it is not permitted to
5891 separate the definition and use of the condition code register.
5892
5893 For this reason, it is possible and suggested to use a register to
5894 represent the condition code for new ports. If there is a specific
5895 condition code register in the machine, use a hard register. If the
5896 condition code or comparison result can be placed in any general register,
5897 or if there are multiple condition registers, use a pseudo register.
5898 Registers used to store the condition code value will usually have a mode
5899 that is in class @code{MODE_CC}.
5900
5901 Alternatively, you can use @code{BImode} if the comparison operator is
5902 specified already in the compare instruction. In this case, you are not
5903 interested in most macros in this section.
5904
5905 @menu
5906 * CC0 Condition Codes:: Old style representation of condition codes.
5907 * MODE_CC Condition Codes:: Modern representation of condition codes.
5908 * Cond Exec Macros:: Macros to control conditional execution.
5909 @end menu
5910
5911 @node CC0 Condition Codes
5912 @subsection Representation of condition codes using @code{(cc0)}
5913 @findex cc0
5914
5915 @findex cc_status
5916 The file @file{conditions.h} defines a variable @code{cc_status} to
5917 describe how the condition code was computed (in case the interpretation of
5918 the condition code depends on the instruction that it was set by). This
5919 variable contains the RTL expressions on which the condition code is
5920 currently based, and several standard flags.
5921
5922 Sometimes additional machine-specific flags must be defined in the machine
5923 description header file. It can also add additional machine-specific
5924 information by defining @code{CC_STATUS_MDEP}.
5925
5926 @defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP
5927 C code for a data type which is used for declaring the @code{mdep}
5928 component of @code{cc_status}. It defaults to @code{int}.
5929
5930 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5931 @end defmac
5932
5933 @defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
5934 A C expression to initialize the @code{mdep} field to ``empty''.
5935 The default definition does nothing, since most machines don't use
5936 the field anyway. If you want to use the field, you should probably
5937 define this macro to initialize it.
5938
5939 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5940 @end defmac
5941
5942 @defmac NOTICE_UPDATE_CC (@var{exp}, @var{insn})
5943 A C compound statement to set the components of @code{cc_status}
5944 appropriately for an insn @var{insn} whose body is @var{exp}. It is
5945 this macro's responsibility to recognize insns that set the condition
5946 code as a byproduct of other activity as well as those that explicitly
5947 set @code{(cc0)}.
5948
5949 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5950
5951 If there are insns that do not set the condition code but do alter
5952 other machine registers, this macro must check to see whether they
5953 invalidate the expressions that the condition code is recorded as
5954 reflecting. For example, on the 68000, insns that store in address
5955 registers do not set the condition code, which means that usually
5956 @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} can leave @code{cc_status} unaltered for such
5957 insns. But suppose that the previous insn set the condition code
5958 based on location @samp{a4@@(102)} and the current insn stores a new
5959 value in @samp{a4}. Although the condition code is not changed by
5960 this, it will no longer be true that it reflects the contents of
5961 @samp{a4@@(102)}. Therefore, @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must alter
5962 @code{cc_status} in this case to say that nothing is known about the
5963 condition code value.
5964
5965 The definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must be prepared to deal
5966 with the results of peephole optimization: insns whose patterns are
5967 @code{parallel} RTXs containing various @code{reg}, @code{mem} or
5968 constants which are just the operands. The RTL structure of these
5969 insns is not sufficient to indicate what the insns actually do. What
5970 @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} should do when it sees one is just to run
5971 @code{CC_STATUS_INIT}.
5972
5973 A possible definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} is to call a function
5974 that looks at an attribute (@pxref{Insn Attributes}) named, for example,
5975 @samp{cc}. This avoids having detailed information about patterns in
5976 two places, the @file{md} file and in @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}.
5977 @end defmac
5978
5979 @node MODE_CC Condition Codes
5980 @subsection Representation of condition codes using registers
5981 @findex CCmode
5982 @findex MODE_CC
5983
5984 @defmac SELECT_CC_MODE (@var{op}, @var{x}, @var{y})
5985 On many machines, the condition code may be produced by other instructions
5986 than compares, for example the branch can use directly the condition
5987 code set by a subtract instruction. However, on some machines
5988 when the condition code is set this way some bits (such as the overflow
5989 bit) are not set in the same way as a test instruction, so that a different
5990 branch instruction must be used for some conditional branches. When
5991 this happens, use the machine mode of the condition code register to
5992 record different formats of the condition code register. Modes can
5993 also be used to record which compare instruction (e.g. a signed or an
5994 unsigned comparison) produced the condition codes.
5995
5996 If other modes than @code{CCmode} are required, add them to
5997 @file{@var{machine}-modes.def} and define @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} to choose
5998 a mode given an operand of a compare. This is needed because the modes
5999 have to be chosen not only during RTL generation but also, for example,
6000 by instruction combination. The result of @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} should
6001 be consistent with the mode used in the patterns; for example to support
6002 the case of the add on the SPARC discussed above, we have the pattern
6003
6004 @smallexample
6005 (define_insn ""
6006 [(set (reg:CC_NOOV 0)
6007 (compare:CC_NOOV
6008 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "%r")
6009 (match_operand:SI 1 "arith_operand" "rI"))
6010 (const_int 0)))]
6011 ""
6012 "@dots{}")
6013 @end smallexample
6014
6015 @noindent
6016 together with a @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} that returns @code{CC_NOOVmode}
6017 for comparisons whose argument is a @code{plus}:
6018
6019 @smallexample
6020 #define SELECT_CC_MODE(OP,X,Y) \
6021 (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (X)) == MODE_FLOAT \
6022 ? ((OP == EQ || OP == NE) ? CCFPmode : CCFPEmode) \
6023 : ((GET_CODE (X) == PLUS || GET_CODE (X) == MINUS \
6024 || GET_CODE (X) == NEG) \
6025 ? CC_NOOVmode : CCmode))
6026 @end smallexample
6027
6028 Another reason to use modes is to retain information on which operands
6029 were used by the comparison; see @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE} later in
6030 this section.
6031
6032 You should define this macro if and only if you define extra CC modes
6033 in @file{@var{machine}-modes.def}.
6034 @end defmac
6035
6036 @defmac CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON (@var{code}, @var{op0}, @var{op1})
6037 On some machines not all possible comparisons are defined, but you can
6038 convert an invalid comparison into a valid one. For example, the Alpha
6039 does not have a @code{GT} comparison, but you can use an @code{LT}
6040 comparison instead and swap the order of the operands.
6041
6042 On such machines, define this macro to be a C statement to do any
6043 required conversions. @var{code} is the initial comparison code
6044 and @var{op0} and @var{op1} are the left and right operands of the
6045 comparison, respectively. You should modify @var{code}, @var{op0}, and
6046 @var{op1} as required.
6047
6048 GCC will not assume that the comparison resulting from this macro is
6049 valid but will see if the resulting insn matches a pattern in the
6050 @file{md} file.
6051
6052 You need not define this macro if it would never change the comparison
6053 code or operands.
6054 @end defmac
6055
6056 @defmac REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})
6057 A C expression whose value is one if it is always safe to reverse a
6058 comparison whose mode is @var{mode}. If @code{SELECT_CC_MODE}
6059 can ever return @var{mode} for a floating-point inequality comparison,
6060 then @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} must be zero.
6061
6062 You need not define this macro if it would always returns zero or if the
6063 floating-point format is anything other than @code{IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT}.
6064 For example, here is the definition used on the SPARC, where floating-point
6065 inequality comparisons are always given @code{CCFPEmode}:
6066
6067 @smallexample
6068 #define REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE(MODE) ((MODE) != CCFPEmode)
6069 @end smallexample
6070 @end defmac
6071
6072 @defmac REVERSE_CONDITION (@var{code}, @var{mode})
6073 A C expression whose value is reversed condition code of the @var{code} for
6074 comparison done in CC_MODE @var{mode}. The macro is used only in case
6075 @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} is nonzero. Define this macro in case
6076 machine has some non-standard way how to reverse certain conditionals. For
6077 instance in case all floating point conditions are non-trapping, compiler may
6078 freely convert unordered compares to ordered one. Then definition may look
6079 like:
6080
6081 @smallexample
6082 #define REVERSE_CONDITION(CODE, MODE) \
6083 ((MODE) != CCFPmode ? reverse_condition (CODE) \
6084 : reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (CODE))
6085 @end smallexample
6086 @end defmac
6087
6088 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FIXED_CONDITION_CODE_REGS (unsigned int *@var{p1}, unsigned int *@var{p2})
6089 On targets which do not use @code{(cc0)}, and which use a hard
6090 register rather than a pseudo-register to hold condition codes, the
6091 regular CSE passes are often not able to identify cases in which the
6092 hard register is set to a common value. Use this hook to enable a
6093 small pass which optimizes such cases. This hook should return true
6094 to enable this pass, and it should set the integers to which its
6095 arguments point to the hard register numbers used for condition codes.
6096 When there is only one such register, as is true on most systems, the
6097 integer pointed to by @var{p2} should be set to
6098 @code{INVALID_REGNUM}.
6099
6100 The default version of this hook returns false.
6101 @end deftypefn
6102
6103 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_CC_MODES_COMPATIBLE (enum machine_mode @var{m1}, enum machine_mode @var{m2})
6104 On targets which use multiple condition code modes in class
6105 @code{MODE_CC}, it is sometimes the case that a comparison can be
6106 validly done in more than one mode. On such a system, define this
6107 target hook to take two mode arguments and to return a mode in which
6108 both comparisons may be validly done. If there is no such mode,
6109 return @code{VOIDmode}.
6110
6111 The default version of this hook checks whether the modes are the
6112 same. If they are, it returns that mode. If they are different, it
6113 returns @code{VOIDmode}.
6114 @end deftypefn
6115
6116 @node Cond Exec Macros
6117 @subsection Macros to control conditional execution
6118 @findex conditional execution
6119 @findex predication
6120
6121 There is one macro that may need to be defined for targets
6122 supporting conditional execution, independent of how they
6123 represent conditional branches.
6124
6125 @node Costs
6126 @section Describing Relative Costs of Operations
6127 @cindex costs of instructions
6128 @cindex relative costs
6129 @cindex speed of instructions
6130
6131 These macros let you describe the relative speed of various operations
6132 on the target machine.
6133
6134 @defmac REGISTER_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{from}, @var{to})
6135 A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} from a
6136 register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes are
6137 expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}. A
6138 value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6139 that.
6140
6141 It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6142 same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6143 registers if they are not general registers.
6144
6145 If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6146 hard registers, and if @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6147 classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6148 constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6149 allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6150 if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6151
6152 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6153 @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} instead.
6154 @end defmac
6155
6156 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{from}, reg_class_t @var{to})
6157 This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6158 from a register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes
6159 are expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
6160 A value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6161 that.
6162
6163 It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6164 same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6165 registers if they are not general registers.
6166
6167 If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6168 hard registers, and if @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6169 classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6170 constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6171 allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6172 if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6173
6174 The default version of this function returns 2.
6175 @end deftypefn
6176
6177 @defmac MEMORY_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{class}, @var{in})
6178 A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} between a
6179 register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is zero if the value
6180 is to be written to memory, nonzero if it is to be read in. This cost
6181 is relative to those in @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST}. If moving between
6182 registers and memory is more expensive than between two registers, you
6183 should define this macro to express the relative cost.
6184
6185 If you do not define this macro, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6186 the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6187 needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6188 between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is
6189 more complex than copying via an intermediate, define this macro to
6190 reflect the actual cost of the move.
6191
6192 GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6193 secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6194 a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6195 secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
6196 4 is not correct for your machine, define this macro to add some other
6197 value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6198 are the same as to this macro.
6199
6200 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6201 @code{TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST} instead.
6202 @end defmac
6203
6204 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{rclass}, bool @var{in})
6205 This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6206 between a register of class @var{rclass} and memory; @var{in} is @code{false}
6207 if the value is to be written to memory, @code{true} if it is to be read in.
6208 This cost is relative to those in @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST}.
6209 If moving between registers and memory is more expensive than between two
6210 registers, you should add this target hook to express the relative cost.
6211
6212 If you do not add this target hook, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6213 the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6214 needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6215 between memory and a register of @var{rclass} but the reload mechanism is
6216 more complex than copying via an intermediate, use this target hook to
6217 reflect the actual cost of the move.
6218
6219 GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6220 secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6221 a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6222 secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
6223 4 is not correct for your machine, use this target hook to add some other
6224 value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6225 are the same as to this target hook.
6226 @end deftypefn
6227
6228 @defmac BRANCH_COST (@var{speed_p}, @var{predictable_p})
6229 A C expression for the cost of a branch instruction. A value of 1 is
6230 the default; other values are interpreted relative to that. Parameter
6231 @var{speed_p} is true when the branch in question should be optimized
6232 for speed. When it is false, @code{BRANCH_COST} should return a value
6233 optimal for code size rather than performance. @var{predictable_p} is
6234 true for well-predicted branches. On many architectures the
6235 @code{BRANCH_COST} can be reduced then.
6236 @end defmac
6237
6238 Here are additional macros which do not specify precise relative costs,
6239 but only that certain actions are more expensive than GCC would
6240 ordinarily expect.
6241
6242 @defmac SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
6243 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if accessing less
6244 than a word of memory (i.e.@: a @code{char} or a @code{short}) is no
6245 faster than accessing a word of memory, i.e., if such access
6246 require more than one instruction or if there is no difference in cost
6247 between byte and (aligned) word loads.
6248
6249 When this macro is not defined, the compiler will access a field by
6250 finding the smallest containing object; when it is defined, a fullword
6251 load will be used if alignment permits. Unless bytes accesses are
6252 faster than word accesses, using word accesses is preferable since it
6253 may eliminate subsequent memory access if subsequent accesses occur to
6254 other fields in the same word of the structure, but to different bytes.
6255 @end defmac
6256
6257 @defmac SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (@var{mode}, @var{alignment})
6258 Define this macro to be the value 1 if memory accesses described by the
6259 @var{mode} and @var{alignment} parameters have a cost many times greater
6260 than aligned accesses, for example if they are emulated in a trap
6261 handler.
6262
6263 When this macro is nonzero, the compiler will act as if
6264 @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were nonzero when generating code for block
6265 moves. This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced.
6266 Therefore, do not set this macro nonzero if unaligned accesses only add a
6267 cycle or two to the time for a memory access.
6268
6269 If the value of this macro is always zero, it need not be defined. If
6270 this macro is defined, it should produce a nonzero value when
6271 @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} is nonzero.
6272 @end defmac
6273
6274 @defmac MOVE_RATIO (@var{speed})
6275 The threshold of number of scalar memory-to-memory move insns, @emph{below}
6276 which a sequence of insns should be generated instead of a
6277 string move insn or a library call. Increasing the value will always
6278 make code faster, but eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6279
6280 Note that on machines where the corresponding move insn is a
6281 @code{define_expand} that emits a sequence of insns, this macro counts
6282 the number of such sequences.
6283
6284 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6285 optimized for speed rather than size.
6286
6287 If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6288 @end defmac
6289
6290 @defmac MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6291 A C expression used to determine whether @code{move_by_pieces} will be used to
6292 copy a chunk of memory, or whether some other block move mechanism
6293 will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6294 than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6295 @end defmac
6296
6297 @defmac MOVE_MAX_PIECES
6298 A C expression used by @code{move_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6299 a load or store used to copy memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX}.
6300 @end defmac
6301
6302 @defmac CLEAR_RATIO (@var{speed})
6303 The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6304 of insns should be generated to clear memory instead of a string clear insn
6305 or a library call. Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6306 eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6307
6308 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6309 optimized for speed rather than size.
6310
6311 If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6312 @end defmac
6313
6314 @defmac CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6315 A C expression used to determine whether @code{clear_by_pieces} will be used
6316 to clear a chunk of memory, or whether some other block clear mechanism
6317 will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6318 than @code{CLEAR_RATIO}.
6319 @end defmac
6320
6321 @defmac SET_RATIO (@var{speed})
6322 The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6323 of insns should be generated to set memory to a constant value, instead of
6324 a block set insn or a library call.
6325 Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6326 eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6327
6328 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6329 optimized for speed rather than size.
6330
6331 If you don't define this, it defaults to the value of @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6332 @end defmac
6333
6334 @defmac SET_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6335 A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
6336 used to set a chunk of memory to a constant value, or whether some
6337 other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_memset} when
6338 storing values other than constant zero.
6339 Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6340 than @code{SET_RATIO}.
6341 @end defmac
6342
6343 @defmac STORE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6344 A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
6345 used to set a chunk of memory to a constant string value, or whether some
6346 other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_strcpy} when
6347 called with a constant source string.
6348 Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6349 than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6350 @end defmac
6351
6352 @defmac USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6353 A C expression used to determine whether a load postincrement is a good
6354 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6355 @code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6356 @end defmac
6357
6358 @defmac USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6359 A C expression used to determine whether a load postdecrement is a good
6360 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6361 @code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6362 @end defmac
6363
6364 @defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6365 A C expression used to determine whether a load preincrement is a good
6366 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6367 @code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6368 @end defmac
6369
6370 @defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6371 A C expression used to determine whether a load predecrement is a good
6372 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6373 @code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6374 @end defmac
6375
6376 @defmac USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6377 A C expression used to determine whether a store postincrement is a good
6378 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6379 @code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6380 @end defmac
6381
6382 @defmac USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6383 A C expression used to determine whether a store postdecrement is a good
6384 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6385 @code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6386 @end defmac
6387
6388 @defmac USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6389 This macro is used to determine whether a store preincrement is a good
6390 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6391 @code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6392 @end defmac
6393
6394 @defmac USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6395 This macro is used to determine whether a store predecrement is a good
6396 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6397 @code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6398 @end defmac
6399
6400 @defmac NO_FUNCTION_CSE
6401 Define this macro if it is as good or better to call a constant
6402 function address than to call an address kept in a register.
6403 @end defmac
6404
6405 @defmac LOGICAL_OP_NON_SHORT_CIRCUIT
6406 Define this macro if a non-short-circuit operation produced by
6407 @samp{fold_range_test ()} is optimal. This macro defaults to true if
6408 @code{BRANCH_COST} is greater than or equal to the value 2.
6409 @end defmac
6410
6411 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RTX_COSTS (rtx @var{x}, int @var{code}, int @var{outer_code}, int @var{opno}, int *@var{total}, bool @var{speed})
6412 This target hook describes the relative costs of RTL expressions.
6413
6414 The cost may depend on the precise form of the expression, which is
6415 available for examination in @var{x}, and the fact that @var{x} appears
6416 as operand @var{opno} of an expression with rtx code @var{outer_code}.
6417 That is, the hook can assume that there is some rtx @var{y} such
6418 that @samp{GET_CODE (@var{y}) == @var{outer_code}} and such that
6419 either (a) @samp{XEXP (@var{y}, @var{opno}) == @var{x}} or
6420 (b) @samp{XVEC (@var{y}, @var{opno})} contains @var{x}.
6421
6422 @var{code} is @var{x}'s expression code---redundant, since it can be
6423 obtained with @code{GET_CODE (@var{x})}.
6424
6425 In implementing this hook, you can use the construct
6426 @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
6427 instructions.
6428
6429 On entry to the hook, @code{*@var{total}} contains a default estimate
6430 for the cost of the expression. The hook should modify this value as
6431 necessary. Traditionally, the default costs are @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (5)}
6432 for multiplications, @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (7)} for division and modulus
6433 operations, and @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (1)} for all other operations.
6434
6435 When optimizing for code size, i.e.@: when @code{speed} is
6436 false, this target hook should be used to estimate the relative
6437 size cost of an expression, again relative to @code{COSTS_N_INSNS}.
6438
6439 The hook returns true when all subexpressions of @var{x} have been
6440 processed, and false when @code{rtx_cost} should recurse.
6441 @end deftypefn
6442
6443 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ADDRESS_COST (rtx @var{address}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as}, bool @var{speed})
6444 This hook computes the cost of an addressing mode that contains
6445 @var{address}. If not defined, the cost is computed from
6446 the @var{address} expression and the @code{TARGET_RTX_COST} hook.
6447
6448 For most CISC machines, the default cost is a good approximation of the
6449 true cost of the addressing mode. However, on RISC machines, all
6450 instructions normally have the same length and execution time. Hence
6451 all addresses will have equal costs.
6452
6453 In cases where more than one form of an address is known, the form with
6454 the lowest cost will be used. If multiple forms have the same, lowest,
6455 cost, the one that is the most complex will be used.
6456
6457 For example, suppose an address that is equal to the sum of a register
6458 and a constant is used twice in the same basic block. When this macro
6459 is not defined, the address will be computed in a register and memory
6460 references will be indirect through that register. On machines where
6461 the cost of the addressing mode containing the sum is no higher than
6462 that of a simple indirect reference, this will produce an additional
6463 instruction and possibly require an additional register. Proper
6464 specification of this macro eliminates this overhead for such machines.
6465
6466 This hook is never called with an invalid address.
6467
6468 On machines where an address involving more than one register is as
6469 cheap as an address computation involving only one register, defining
6470 @code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} to reflect this can cause two registers to
6471 be live over a region of code where only one would have been if
6472 @code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} were not defined in that manner. This effect
6473 should be considered in the definition of this macro. Equivalent costs
6474 should probably only be given to addresses with different numbers of
6475 registers on machines with lots of registers.
6476 @end deftypefn
6477
6478 @node Scheduling
6479 @section Adjusting the Instruction Scheduler
6480
6481 The instruction scheduler may need a fair amount of machine-specific
6482 adjustment in order to produce good code. GCC provides several target
6483 hooks for this purpose. It is usually enough to define just a few of
6484 them: try the first ones in this list first.
6485
6486 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE (void)
6487 This hook returns the maximum number of instructions that can ever
6488 issue at the same time on the target machine. The default is one.
6489 Although the insn scheduler can define itself the possibility of issue
6490 an insn on the same cycle, the value can serve as an additional
6491 constraint to issue insns on the same simulated processor cycle (see
6492 hooks @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER} and @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}).
6493 This value must be constant over the entire compilation. If you need
6494 it to vary depending on what the instructions are, you must use
6495 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}.
6496 @end deftypefn
6497
6498 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx @var{insn}, int @var{more})
6499 This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled an insn
6500 from the ready list. It should return the number of insns which can
6501 still be issued in the current cycle. The default is
6502 @samp{@w{@var{more} - 1}} for insns other than @code{CLOBBER} and
6503 @code{USE}, which normally are not counted against the issue rate.
6504 You should define this hook if some insns take more machine resources
6505 than others, so that fewer insns can follow them in the same cycle.
6506 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6507 debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6508 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{insn} is the instruction that
6509 was scheduled.
6510 @end deftypefn
6511
6512 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST (rtx @var{insn}, rtx @var{link}, rtx @var{dep_insn}, int @var{cost})
6513 This function corrects the value of @var{cost} based on the
6514 relationship between @var{insn} and @var{dep_insn} through the
6515 dependence @var{link}. It should return the new value. The default
6516 is to make no adjustment to @var{cost}. This can be used for example
6517 to specify to the scheduler using the traditional pipeline description
6518 that an output- or anti-dependence does not incur the same cost as a
6519 data-dependence. If the scheduler using the automaton based pipeline
6520 description, the cost of anti-dependence is zero and the cost of
6521 output-dependence is maximum of one and the difference of latency
6522 times of the first and the second insns. If these values are not
6523 acceptable, you could use the hook to modify them too. See also
6524 @pxref{Processor pipeline description}.
6525 @end deftypefn
6526
6527 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_PRIORITY (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{priority})
6528 This hook adjusts the integer scheduling priority @var{priority} of
6529 @var{insn}. It should return the new priority. Increase the priority to
6530 execute @var{insn} earlier, reduce the priority to execute @var{insn}
6531 later. Do not define this hook if you do not need to adjust the
6532 scheduling priorities of insns.
6533 @end deftypefn
6534
6535 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx *@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
6536 This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled the ready
6537 list, to allow the machine description to reorder it (for example to
6538 combine two small instructions together on @samp{VLIW} machines).
6539 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6540 debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6541 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{ready} is a pointer to the ready
6542 list of instructions that are ready to be scheduled. @var{n_readyp} is
6543 a pointer to the number of elements in the ready list. The scheduler
6544 reads the ready list in reverse order, starting with
6545 @var{ready}[@var{*n_readyp} @minus{} 1] and going to @var{ready}[0]. @var{clock}
6546 is the timer tick of the scheduler. You may modify the ready list and
6547 the number of ready insns. The return value is the number of insns that
6548 can issue this cycle; normally this is just @code{issue_rate}. See also
6549 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}.
6550 @end deftypefn
6551
6552 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2 (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx *@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
6553 Like @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}, but called at a different time. That
6554 function is called whenever the scheduler starts a new cycle. This one
6555 is called once per iteration over a cycle, immediately after
6556 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}; it can reorder the ready list and
6557 return the number of insns to be scheduled in the same cycle. Defining
6558 this hook can be useful if there are frequent situations where
6559 scheduling one insn causes other insns to become ready in the same
6560 cycle. These other insns can then be taken into account properly.
6561 @end deftypefn
6562
6563 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DEPENDENCIES_EVALUATION_HOOK (rtx @var{head}, rtx @var{tail})
6564 This hook is called after evaluation forward dependencies of insns in
6565 chain given by two parameter values (@var{head} and @var{tail}
6566 correspondingly) but before insns scheduling of the insn chain. For
6567 example, it can be used for better insn classification if it requires
6568 analysis of dependencies. This hook can use backward and forward
6569 dependencies of the insn scheduler because they are already
6570 calculated.
6571 @end deftypefn
6572
6573 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{max_ready})
6574 This hook is executed by the scheduler at the beginning of each block of
6575 instructions that are to be scheduled. @var{file} is either a null
6576 pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to. @var{verbose}
6577 is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6578 @var{max_ready} is the maximum number of insns in the current scheduling
6579 region that can be live at the same time. This can be used to allocate
6580 scratch space if it is needed, e.g.@: by @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}.
6581 @end deftypefn
6582
6583 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
6584 This hook is executed by the scheduler at the end of each block of
6585 instructions that are to be scheduled. It can be used to perform
6586 cleanup of any actions done by the other scheduling hooks. @var{file}
6587 is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output
6588 to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6589 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6590 @end deftypefn
6591
6592 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{old_max_uid})
6593 This hook is executed by the scheduler after function level initializations.
6594 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6595 @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6596 @var{old_max_uid} is the maximum insn uid when scheduling begins.
6597 @end deftypefn
6598
6599 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
6600 This is the cleanup hook corresponding to @code{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL}.
6601 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6602 @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6603 @end deftypefn
6604
6605 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6606 The hook returns an RTL insn. The automaton state used in the
6607 pipeline hazard recognizer is changed as if the insn were scheduled
6608 when the new simulated processor cycle starts. Usage of the hook may
6609 simplify the automaton pipeline description for some @acronym{VLIW}
6610 processors. If the hook is defined, it is used only for the automaton
6611 based pipeline description. The default is not to change the state
6612 when the new simulated processor cycle starts.
6613 @end deftypefn
6614
6615 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6616 The hook can be used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6617 @end deftypefn
6618
6619 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6620 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6621 to changed the state as if the insn were scheduled when the new
6622 simulated processor cycle finishes.
6623 @end deftypefn
6624
6625 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6626 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but
6627 used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6628 @end deftypefn
6629
6630 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_ADVANCE_CYCLE (void)
6631 The hook to notify target that the current simulated cycle is about to finish.
6632 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6633 to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6634 state on a single insn is not enough.
6635 @end deftypefn
6636
6637 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_ADVANCE_CYCLE (void)
6638 The hook to notify target that new simulated cycle has just started.
6639 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6640 to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6641 state on a single insn is not enough.
6642 @end deftypefn
6643
6644 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD (void)
6645 This hook controls better choosing an insn from the ready insn queue
6646 for the @acronym{DFA}-based insn scheduler. Usually the scheduler
6647 chooses the first insn from the queue. If the hook returns a positive
6648 value, an additional scheduler code tries all permutations of
6649 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD ()}
6650 subsequent ready insns to choose an insn whose issue will result in
6651 maximal number of issued insns on the same cycle. For the
6652 @acronym{VLIW} processor, the code could actually solve the problem of
6653 packing simple insns into the @acronym{VLIW} insn. Of course, if the
6654 rules of @acronym{VLIW} packing are described in the automaton.
6655
6656 This code also could be used for superscalar @acronym{RISC}
6657 processors. Let us consider a superscalar @acronym{RISC} processor
6658 with 3 pipelines. Some insns can be executed in pipelines @var{A} or
6659 @var{B}, some insns can be executed only in pipelines @var{B} or
6660 @var{C}, and one insn can be executed in pipeline @var{B}. The
6661 processor may issue the 1st insn into @var{A} and the 2nd one into
6662 @var{B}. In this case, the 3rd insn will wait for freeing @var{B}
6663 until the next cycle. If the scheduler issues the 3rd insn the first,
6664 the processor could issue all 3 insns per cycle.
6665
6666 Actually this code demonstrates advantages of the automaton based
6667 pipeline hazard recognizer. We try quickly and easy many insn
6668 schedules to choose the best one.
6669
6670 The default is no multipass scheduling.
6671 @end deftypefn
6672
6673 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD (rtx @var{insn})
6674
6675 This hook controls what insns from the ready insn queue will be
6676 considered for the multipass insn scheduling. If the hook returns
6677 zero for @var{insn}, the insn will be not chosen to
6678 be issued.
6679
6680 The default is that any ready insns can be chosen to be issued.
6681 @end deftypefn
6682
6683 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BEGIN (void *@var{data}, char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready}, bool @var{first_cycle_insn_p})
6684 This hook prepares the target backend for a new round of multipass
6685 scheduling.
6686 @end deftypefn
6687
6688 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_ISSUE (void *@var{data}, char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready}, rtx @var{insn}, const void *@var{prev_data})
6689 This hook is called when multipass scheduling evaluates instruction INSN.
6690 @end deftypefn
6691
6692 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BACKTRACK (const void *@var{data}, char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready})
6693 This is called when multipass scheduling backtracks from evaluation of
6694 an instruction.
6695 @end deftypefn
6696
6697 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_END (const void *@var{data})
6698 This hook notifies the target about the result of the concluded current
6699 round of multipass scheduling.
6700 @end deftypefn
6701
6702 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_INIT (void *@var{data})
6703 This hook initializes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
6704 @end deftypefn
6705
6706 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_FINI (void *@var{data})
6707 This hook finalizes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
6708 @end deftypefn
6709
6710 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_DFA_NEW_CYCLE (FILE *@var{dump}, int @var{verbose}, rtx @var{insn}, int @var{last_clock}, int @var{clock}, int *@var{sort_p})
6711 This hook is called by the insn scheduler before issuing @var{insn}
6712 on cycle @var{clock}. If the hook returns nonzero,
6713 @var{insn} is not issued on this processor cycle. Instead,
6714 the processor cycle is advanced. If *@var{sort_p}
6715 is zero, the insn ready queue is not sorted on the new cycle
6716 start as usually. @var{dump} and @var{verbose} specify the file and
6717 verbosity level to use for debugging output.
6718 @var{last_clock} and @var{clock} are, respectively, the
6719 processor cycle on which the previous insn has been issued,
6720 and the current processor cycle.
6721 @end deftypefn
6722
6723 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_IS_COSTLY_DEPENDENCE (struct _dep *@var{_dep}, int @var{cost}, int @var{distance})
6724 This hook is used to define which dependences are considered costly by
6725 the target, so costly that it is not advisable to schedule the insns that
6726 are involved in the dependence too close to one another. The parameters
6727 to this hook are as follows: The first parameter @var{_dep} is the dependence
6728 being evaluated. The second parameter @var{cost} is the cost of the
6729 dependence as estimated by the scheduler, and the third
6730 parameter @var{distance} is the distance in cycles between the two insns.
6731 The hook returns @code{true} if considering the distance between the two
6732 insns the dependence between them is considered costly by the target,
6733 and @code{false} otherwise.
6734
6735 Defining this hook can be useful in multiple-issue out-of-order machines,
6736 where (a) it's practically hopeless to predict the actual data/resource
6737 delays, however: (b) there's a better chance to predict the actual grouping
6738 that will be formed, and (c) correctly emulating the grouping can be very
6739 important. In such targets one may want to allow issuing dependent insns
6740 closer to one another---i.e., closer than the dependence distance; however,
6741 not in cases of ``costly dependences'', which this hooks allows to define.
6742 @end deftypefn
6743
6744 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_H_I_D_EXTENDED (void)
6745 This hook is called by the insn scheduler after emitting a new instruction to
6746 the instruction stream. The hook notifies a target backend to extend its
6747 per instruction data structures.
6748 @end deftypefn
6749
6750 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_SCHED_ALLOC_SCHED_CONTEXT (void)
6751 Return a pointer to a store large enough to hold target scheduling context.
6752 @end deftypefn
6753
6754 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc}, bool @var{clean_p})
6755 Initialize store pointed to by @var{tc} to hold target scheduling context.
6756 It @var{clean_p} is true then initialize @var{tc} as if scheduler is at the
6757 beginning of the block. Otherwise, copy the current context into @var{tc}.
6758 @end deftypefn
6759
6760 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6761 Copy target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc} to the current context.
6762 @end deftypefn
6763
6764 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_CLEAR_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6765 Deallocate internal data in target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6766 @end deftypefn
6767
6768 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FREE_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6769 Deallocate a store for target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6770 @end deftypefn
6771
6772 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_SPECULATE_INSN (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{request}, rtx *@var{new_pat})
6773 This hook is called by the insn scheduler when @var{insn} has only
6774 speculative dependencies and therefore can be scheduled speculatively.
6775 The hook is used to check if the pattern of @var{insn} has a speculative
6776 version and, in case of successful check, to generate that speculative
6777 pattern. The hook should return 1, if the instruction has a speculative form,
6778 or @minus{}1, if it doesn't. @var{request} describes the type of requested
6779 speculation. If the return value equals 1 then @var{new_pat} is assigned
6780 the generated speculative pattern.
6781 @end deftypefn
6782
6783 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_NEEDS_BLOCK_P (int @var{dep_status})
6784 This hook is called by the insn scheduler during generation of recovery code
6785 for @var{insn}. It should return @code{true}, if the corresponding check
6786 instruction should branch to recovery code, or @code{false} otherwise.
6787 @end deftypefn
6788
6789 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_GEN_SPEC_CHECK (rtx @var{insn}, rtx @var{label}, int @var{mutate_p})
6790 This hook is called by the insn scheduler to generate a pattern for recovery
6791 check instruction. If @var{mutate_p} is zero, then @var{insn} is a
6792 speculative instruction for which the check should be generated.
6793 @var{label} is either a label of a basic block, where recovery code should
6794 be emitted, or a null pointer, when requested check doesn't branch to
6795 recovery code (a simple check). If @var{mutate_p} is nonzero, then
6796 a pattern for a branchy check corresponding to a simple check denoted by
6797 @var{insn} should be generated. In this case @var{label} can't be null.
6798 @end deftypefn
6799
6800 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD_SPEC (const_rtx @var{insn})
6801 This hook is used as a workaround for
6802 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD} not being
6803 called on the first instruction of the ready list. The hook is used to
6804 discard speculative instructions that stand first in the ready list from
6805 being scheduled on the current cycle. If the hook returns @code{false},
6806 @var{insn} will not be chosen to be issued.
6807 For non-speculative instructions,
6808 the hook should always return @code{true}. For example, in the ia64 backend
6809 the hook is used to cancel data speculative insns when the ALAT table
6810 is nearly full.
6811 @end deftypefn
6812
6813 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_FLAGS (struct spec_info_def *@var{spec_info})
6814 This hook is used by the insn scheduler to find out what features should be
6815 enabled/used.
6816 The structure *@var{spec_info} should be filled in by the target.
6817 The structure describes speculation types that can be used in the scheduler.
6818 @end deftypefn
6819
6820 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_SMS_RES_MII (struct ddg *@var{g})
6821 This hook is called by the swing modulo scheduler to calculate a
6822 resource-based lower bound which is based on the resources available in
6823 the machine and the resources required by each instruction. The target
6824 backend can use @var{g} to calculate such bound. A very simple lower
6825 bound will be used in case this hook is not implemented: the total number
6826 of instructions divided by the issue rate.
6827 @end deftypefn
6828
6829 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{x})
6830 This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It returns true if dispatch scheduling
6831 is supported in hardware and the condition specified in the parameter is true.
6832 @end deftypefn
6833
6834 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH_DO (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{x})
6835 This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It performs the operation specified
6836 in its second parameter.
6837 @end deftypefn
6838
6839 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_EXPOSED_PIPELINE
6840 True if the processor has an exposed pipeline, which means that not just
6841 the order of instructions is important for correctness when scheduling, but
6842 also the latencies of operations.
6843 @end deftypevr
6844
6845 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REASSOCIATION_WIDTH (unsigned int @var{opc}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
6846 This hook is called by tree reassociator to determine a level of
6847 parallelism required in output calculations chain.
6848 @end deftypefn
6849
6850 @node Sections
6851 @section Dividing the Output into Sections (Texts, Data, @dots{})
6852 @c the above section title is WAY too long. maybe cut the part between
6853 @c the (...)? --mew 10feb93
6854
6855 An object file is divided into sections containing different types of
6856 data. In the most common case, there are three sections: the @dfn{text
6857 section}, which holds instructions and read-only data; the @dfn{data
6858 section}, which holds initialized writable data; and the @dfn{bss
6859 section}, which holds uninitialized data. Some systems have other kinds
6860 of sections.
6861
6862 @file{varasm.c} provides several well-known sections, such as
6863 @code{text_section}, @code{data_section} and @code{bss_section}.
6864 The normal way of controlling a @code{@var{foo}_section} variable
6865 is to define the associated @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macro,
6866 as described below. The macros are only read once, when @file{varasm.c}
6867 initializes itself, so their values must be run-time constants.
6868 They may however depend on command-line flags.
6869
6870 @emph{Note:} Some run-time files, such @file{crtstuff.c}, also make
6871 use of the @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macros, and expect them
6872 to be string literals.
6873
6874 Some assemblers require a different string to be written every time a
6875 section is selected. If your assembler falls into this category, you
6876 should define the @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS} hook and use
6877 @code{get_unnamed_section} to set up the sections.
6878
6879 You must always create a @code{text_section}, either by defining
6880 @code{TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or by initializing @code{text_section}
6881 in @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS}. The same is true of
6882 @code{data_section} and @code{DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP}. If you do not
6883 create a distinct @code{readonly_data_section}, the default is to
6884 reuse @code{text_section}.
6885
6886 All the other @file{varasm.c} sections are optional, and are null
6887 if the target does not provide them.
6888
6889 @defmac TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6890 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6891 assembler operation that should precede instructions and read-only data.
6892 Normally @code{"\t.text"} is right.
6893 @end defmac
6894
6895 @defmac HOT_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6896 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing most
6897 frequently executed functions of the program. If not defined, GCC will provide
6898 a default definition if the target supports named sections.
6899 @end defmac
6900
6901 @defmac UNLIKELY_EXECUTED_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6902 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing unlikely
6903 executed functions in the program.
6904 @end defmac
6905
6906 @defmac DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6907 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6908 assembler operation to identify the following data as writable initialized
6909 data. Normally @code{"\t.data"} is right.
6910 @end defmac
6911
6912 @defmac SDATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6913 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6914 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6915 initialized, writable small data.
6916 @end defmac
6917
6918 @defmac READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6919 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6920 assembler operation to identify the following data as read-only initialized
6921 data.
6922 @end defmac
6923
6924 @defmac BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6925 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6926 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6927 uninitialized global data. If not defined, and
6928 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} not defined,
6929 uninitialized global data will be output in the data section if
6930 @option{-fno-common} is passed, otherwise @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} will be
6931 used.
6932 @end defmac
6933
6934 @defmac SBSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6935 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6936 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6937 uninitialized, writable small data.
6938 @end defmac
6939
6940 @defmac TLS_COMMON_ASM_OP
6941 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string containing the
6942 assembler operation to identify the following data as thread-local
6943 common data. The default is @code{".tls_common"}.
6944 @end defmac
6945
6946 @defmac TLS_SECTION_ASM_FLAG
6947 If defined, a C expression whose value is a character constant
6948 containing the flag used to mark a section as a TLS section. The
6949 default is @code{'T'}.
6950 @end defmac
6951
6952 @defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6953 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6954 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6955 initialization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6956 not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{init_section}
6957 variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6958 @end defmac
6959
6960 @defmac FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
6961 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6962 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6963 finalization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6964 not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{fini_section}
6965 variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6966 @end defmac
6967
6968 @defmac INIT_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6969 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6970 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6971 part of the @code{.init_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
6972 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
6973 both this macro and @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6974 @end defmac
6975
6976 @defmac FINI_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6977 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6978 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6979 part of the @code{.fini_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
6980 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
6981 both this macro and @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6982 @end defmac
6983
6984 @defmac CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION (@var{section_op}, @var{function})
6985 If defined, an ASM statement that switches to a different section
6986 via @var{section_op}, calls @var{function}, and switches back to
6987 the text section. This is used in @file{crtstuff.c} if
6988 @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP} to calls
6989 to initialization and finalization functions from the init and fini
6990 sections. By default, this macro uses a simple function call. Some
6991 ports need hand-crafted assembly code to avoid dependencies on
6992 registers initialized in the function prologue or to ensure that
6993 constant pools don't end up too far way in the text section.
6994 @end defmac
6995
6996 @defmac TARGET_LIBGCC_SDATA_SECTION
6997 If defined, a string which names the section into which small
6998 variables defined in crtstuff and libgcc should go. This is useful
6999 when the target has options for optimizing access to small data, and
7000 you want the crtstuff and libgcc routines to be conservative in what
7001 they expect of your application yet liberal in what your application
7002 expects. For example, for targets with a @code{.sdata} section (like
7003 MIPS), you could compile crtstuff with @code{-G 0} so that it doesn't
7004 require small data support from your application, but use this macro
7005 to put small data into @code{.sdata} so that your application can
7006 access these variables whether it uses small data or not.
7007 @end defmac
7008
7009 @defmac FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
7010 If defined, an ASM statement that aligns a code section to some
7011 arbitrary boundary. This is used to force all fragments of the
7012 @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections to have to same alignment
7013 and thus prevent the linker from having to add any padding.
7014 @end defmac
7015
7016 @defmac JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
7017 Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if jump
7018 tables (for @code{tablejump} insns) should be output in the text
7019 section, along with the assembler instructions. Otherwise, the
7020 readonly data section is used.
7021
7022 This macro is irrelevant if there is no separate readonly data section.
7023 @end defmac
7024
7025 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS (void)
7026 Define this hook if you need to do something special to set up the
7027 @file{varasm.c} sections, or if your target has some special sections
7028 of its own that you need to create.
7029
7030 GCC calls this hook after processing the command line, but before writing
7031 any assembly code, and before calling any of the section-returning hooks
7032 described below.
7033 @end deftypefn
7034
7035 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_RELOC_RW_MASK (void)
7036 Return a mask describing how relocations should be treated when
7037 selecting sections. Bit 1 should be set if global relocations
7038 should be placed in a read-write section; bit 0 should be set if
7039 local relocations should be placed in a read-write section.
7040
7041 The default version of this function returns 3 when @option{-fpic}
7042 is in effect, and 0 otherwise. The hook is typically redefined
7043 when the target cannot support (some kinds of) dynamic relocations
7044 in read-only sections even in executables.
7045 @end deftypefn
7046
7047 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION (tree @var{exp}, int @var{reloc}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
7048 Return the section into which @var{exp} should be placed. You can
7049 assume that @var{exp} is either a @code{VAR_DECL} node or a constant of
7050 some sort. @var{reloc} indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp}
7051 requires link-time relocations. Bit 0 is set when variable contains
7052 local relocations only, while bit 1 is set for global relocations.
7053 @var{align} is the constant alignment in bits.
7054
7055 The default version of this function takes care of putting read-only
7056 variables in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7057
7058 See also @var{USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS}.
7059 @end deftypefn
7060
7061 @defmac USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS
7062 Define this macro if you wish TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION to be called
7063 for @code{FUNCTION_DECL}s as well as for variables and constants.
7064
7065 In the case of a @code{FUNCTION_DECL}, @var{reloc} will be zero if the
7066 function has been determined to be likely to be called, and nonzero if
7067 it is unlikely to be called.
7068 @end defmac
7069
7070 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNIQUE_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, int @var{reloc})
7071 Build up a unique section name, expressed as a @code{STRING_CST} node,
7072 and assign it to @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7073 As with @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION}, @var{reloc} indicates whether
7074 the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time relocations.
7075
7076 The default version of this function appends the symbol name to the
7077 ELF section name that would normally be used for the symbol. For
7078 example, the function @code{foo} would be placed in @code{.text.foo}.
7079 Whatever the actual target object format, this is often good enough.
7080 @end deftypefn
7081
7082 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_RODATA_SECTION (tree @var{decl})
7083 Return the readonly data section associated with
7084 @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7085 The default version of this function selects @code{.gnu.linkonce.r.name} if
7086 the function's section is @code{.gnu.linkonce.t.name}, @code{.rodata.name}
7087 if function is in @code{.text.name}, and the normal readonly-data section
7088 otherwise.
7089 @end deftypefn
7090
7091 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_MERGEABLE_RODATA_PREFIX
7092 Usually, the compiler uses the prefix @code{".rodata"} to construct
7093 section names for mergeable constant data. Define this macro to override
7094 the string if a different section name should be used.
7095 @end deftypevr
7096
7097 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_TM_CLONE_TABLE_SECTION (void)
7098 Return the section that should be used for transactional memory clone tables.
7099 @end deftypefn
7100
7101 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
7102 Return the section into which a constant @var{x}, of mode @var{mode},
7103 should be placed. You can assume that @var{x} is some kind of
7104 constant in RTL@. The argument @var{mode} is redundant except in the
7105 case of a @code{const_int} rtx. @var{align} is the constant alignment
7106 in bits.
7107
7108 The default version of this function takes care of putting symbolic
7109 constants in @code{flag_pic} mode in @code{data_section} and everything
7110 else in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7111 @end deftypefn
7112
7113 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MANGLE_DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{id})
7114 Define this hook if you need to postprocess the assembler name generated
7115 by target-independent code. The @var{id} provided to this hook will be
7116 the computed name (e.g., the macro @code{DECL_NAME} of the @var{decl} in C,
7117 or the mangled name of the @var{decl} in C++). The return value of the
7118 hook is an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE} for the appropriate mangled name on
7119 your target system. The default implementation of this hook just
7120 returns the @var{id} provided.
7121 @end deftypefn
7122
7123 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO (tree @var{decl}, rtx @var{rtl}, int @var{new_decl_p})
7124 Define this hook if references to a symbol or a constant must be
7125 treated differently depending on something about the variable or
7126 function named by the symbol (such as what section it is in).
7127
7128 The hook is executed immediately after rtl has been created for
7129 @var{decl}, which may be a variable or function declaration or
7130 an entry in the constant pool. In either case, @var{rtl} is the
7131 rtl in question. Do @emph{not} use @code{DECL_RTL (@var{decl})}
7132 in this hook; that field may not have been initialized yet.
7133
7134 In the case of a constant, it is safe to assume that the rtl is
7135 a @code{mem} whose address is a @code{symbol_ref}. Most decls
7136 will also have this form, but that is not guaranteed. Global
7137 register variables, for instance, will have a @code{reg} for their
7138 rtl. (Normally the right thing to do with such unusual rtl is
7139 leave it alone.)
7140
7141 The @var{new_decl_p} argument will be true if this is the first time
7142 that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} has been invoked on this decl. It will
7143 be false for subsequent invocations, which will happen for duplicate
7144 declarations. Whether or not anything must be done for the duplicate
7145 declaration depends on whether the hook examines @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.
7146 @var{new_decl_p} is always true when the hook is called for a constant.
7147
7148 @cindex @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}, in @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7149 The usual thing for this hook to do is to record flags in the
7150 @code{symbol_ref}, using @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG} or @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7151 Historically, the name string was modified if it was necessary to
7152 encode more than one bit of information, but this practice is now
7153 discouraged; use @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7154
7155 The default definition of this hook, @code{default_encode_section_info}
7156 in @file{varasm.c}, sets a number of commonly-useful bits in
7157 @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}. Check whether the default does what you need
7158 before overriding it.
7159 @end deftypefn
7160
7161 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING (const char *@var{name})
7162 Decode @var{name} and return the real name part, sans
7163 the characters that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7164 may have added.
7165 @end deftypefn
7166
7167 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P (const_tree @var{exp})
7168 Returns true if @var{exp} should be placed into a ``small data'' section.
7169 The default version of this hook always returns false.
7170 @end deftypefn
7171
7172 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SRODATA_SECTION
7173 Contains the value true if the target places read-only
7174 ``small data'' into a separate section. The default value is false.
7175 @end deftypevr
7176
7177 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE (void)
7178 It returns true if target wants profile code emitted before prologue.
7179
7180 The default version of this hook use the target macro
7181 @code{PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE}.
7182 @end deftypefn
7183
7184 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BINDS_LOCAL_P (const_tree @var{exp})
7185 Returns true if @var{exp} names an object for which name resolution
7186 rules must resolve to the current ``module'' (dynamic shared library
7187 or executable image).
7188
7189 The default version of this hook implements the name resolution rules
7190 for ELF, which has a looser model of global name binding than other
7191 currently supported object file formats.
7192 @end deftypefn
7193
7194 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_TLS
7195 Contains the value true if the target supports thread-local storage.
7196 The default value is false.
7197 @end deftypevr
7198
7199
7200 @node PIC
7201 @section Position Independent Code
7202 @cindex position independent code
7203 @cindex PIC
7204
7205 This section describes macros that help implement generation of position
7206 independent code. Simply defining these macros is not enough to
7207 generate valid PIC; you must also add support to the hook
7208 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} and to the macro
7209 @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}, as well as @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS}. You
7210 must modify the definition of @samp{movsi} to do something appropriate
7211 when the source operand contains a symbolic address. You may also
7212 need to alter the handling of switch statements so that they use
7213 relative addresses.
7214 @c i rearranged the order of the macros above to try to force one of
7215 @c them to the next line, to eliminate an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
7216
7217 @defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
7218 The register number of the register used to address a table of static
7219 data addresses in memory. In some cases this register is defined by a
7220 processor's ``application binary interface'' (ABI)@. When this macro
7221 is defined, RTL is generated for this register once, as with the stack
7222 pointer and frame pointer registers. If this macro is not defined, it
7223 is up to the machine-dependent files to allocate such a register (if
7224 necessary). Note that this register must be fixed when in use (e.g.@:
7225 when @code{flag_pic} is true).
7226 @end defmac
7227
7228 @defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
7229 A C expression that is nonzero if the register defined by
7230 @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is clobbered by calls. If not defined,
7231 the default is zero. Do not define
7232 this macro if @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is not defined.
7233 @end defmac
7234
7235 @defmac LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (@var{x})
7236 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate immediate
7237 operand on the target machine when generating position independent code.
7238 You can assume that @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not
7239 check this. You can also assume @var{flag_pic} is true, so you need not
7240 check it either. You need not define this macro if all constants
7241 (including @code{SYMBOL_REF}) can be immediate operands when generating
7242 position independent code.
7243 @end defmac
7244
7245 @node Assembler Format
7246 @section Defining the Output Assembler Language
7247
7248 This section describes macros whose principal purpose is to describe how
7249 to write instructions in assembler language---rather than what the
7250 instructions do.
7251
7252 @menu
7253 * File Framework:: Structural information for the assembler file.
7254 * Data Output:: Output of constants (numbers, strings, addresses).
7255 * Uninitialized Data:: Output of uninitialized variables.
7256 * Label Output:: Output and generation of labels.
7257 * Initialization:: General principles of initialization
7258 and termination routines.
7259 * Macros for Initialization::
7260 Specific macros that control the handling of
7261 initialization and termination routines.
7262 * Instruction Output:: Output of actual instructions.
7263 * Dispatch Tables:: Output of jump tables.
7264 * Exception Region Output:: Output of exception region code.
7265 * Alignment Output:: Pseudo ops for alignment and skipping data.
7266 @end menu
7267
7268 @node File Framework
7269 @subsection The Overall Framework of an Assembler File
7270 @cindex assembler format
7271 @cindex output of assembler code
7272
7273 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7274 This describes the overall framework of an assembly file.
7275
7276 @findex default_file_start
7277 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_START (void)
7278 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects to
7279 find at the beginning of a file. The default behavior is controlled
7280 by two flags, documented below. Unless your target's assembler is
7281 quite unusual, if you override the default, you should call
7282 @code{default_file_start} at some point in your target hook. This
7283 lets other target files rely on these variables.
7284 @end deftypefn
7285
7286 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_APP_OFF
7287 If this flag is true, the text of the macro @code{ASM_APP_OFF} will be
7288 printed as the very first line in the assembly file, unless
7289 @option{-fverbose-asm} is in effect. (If that macro has been defined
7290 to the empty string, this variable has no effect.) With the normal
7291 definition of @code{ASM_APP_OFF}, the effect is to notify the GNU
7292 assembler that it need not bother stripping comments or extra
7293 whitespace from its input. This allows it to work a bit faster.
7294
7295 The default is false. You should not set it to true unless you have
7296 verified that your port does not generate any extra whitespace or
7297 comments that will cause GAS to issue errors in NO_APP mode.
7298 @end deftypevr
7299
7300 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE
7301 If this flag is true, @code{output_file_directive} will be called
7302 for the primary source file, immediately after printing
7303 @code{ASM_APP_OFF} (if that is enabled). Most ELF assemblers expect
7304 this to be done. The default is false.
7305 @end deftypevr
7306
7307 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_END (void)
7308 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7309 to find at the end of a file. The default is to output nothing.
7310 @end deftypefn
7311
7312 @deftypefun void file_end_indicate_exec_stack ()
7313 Some systems use a common convention, the @samp{.note.GNU-stack}
7314 special section, to indicate whether or not an object file relies on
7315 the stack being executable. If your system uses this convention, you
7316 should define @code{TARGET_ASM_FILE_END} to this function. If you
7317 need to do other things in that hook, have your hook function call
7318 this function.
7319 @end deftypefun
7320
7321 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_LTO_START (void)
7322 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7323 to find at the start of an LTO section. The default is to output
7324 nothing.
7325 @end deftypefn
7326
7327 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_LTO_END (void)
7328 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7329 to find at the end of an LTO section. The default is to output
7330 nothing.
7331 @end deftypefn
7332
7333 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CODE_END (void)
7334 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which is needed before emitting
7335 unwind info and debug info at the end of a file. Some targets emit
7336 here PIC setup thunks that cannot be emitted at the end of file,
7337 because they couldn't have unwind info then. The default is to output
7338 nothing.
7339 @end deftypefn
7340
7341 @defmac ASM_COMMENT_START
7342 A C string constant describing how to begin a comment in the target
7343 assembler language. The compiler assumes that the comment will end at
7344 the end of the line.
7345 @end defmac
7346
7347 @defmac ASM_APP_ON
7348 A C string constant for text to be output before each @code{asm}
7349 statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7350 @code{"#APP"}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
7351 assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it must check the lines
7352 that follow for all valid assembler constructs.
7353 @end defmac
7354
7355 @defmac ASM_APP_OFF
7356 A C string constant for text to be output after each @code{asm}
7357 statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7358 @code{"#NO_APP"}, which tells the GNU assembler to resume making the
7359 time-saving assumptions that are valid for ordinary compiler output.
7360 @end defmac
7361
7362 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7363 A C statement to output COFF information or DWARF debugging information
7364 which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to
7365 the stdio stream @var{stream}.
7366
7367 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
7368 for the file format in use is appropriate.
7369 @end defmac
7370
7371 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (FILE *@var{file}, const char *@var{name})
7372 Output COFF information or DWARF debugging information which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to the stdio stream @var{file}.
7373
7374 This target hook need not be defined if the standard form of output for the file format in use is appropriate.
7375 @end deftypefn
7376
7377 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT (const char *@var{name})
7378 Output a string based on @var{name}, suitable for the @samp{#ident} directive, or the equivalent directive or pragma in non-C-family languages. If this hook is not defined, nothing is output for the @samp{#ident} directive.
7379 @end deftypefn
7380
7381 @defmac OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING (@var{stream}, @var{string})
7382 A C statement to output the string @var{string} to the stdio stream
7383 @var{stream}. If you do not call the function @code{output_quoted_string}
7384 in your config files, GCC will only call it to output filenames to
7385 the assembler source. So you can use it to canonicalize the format
7386 of the filename using this macro.
7387 @end defmac
7388
7389 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION (const char *@var{name}, unsigned int @var{flags}, tree @var{decl})
7390 Output assembly directives to switch to section @var{name}. The section
7391 should have attributes as specified by @var{flags}, which is a bit mask
7392 of the @code{SECTION_*} flags defined in @file{output.h}. If @var{decl}
7393 is non-NULL, it is the @code{VAR_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_DECL} with which
7394 this section is associated.
7395 @end deftypefn
7396
7397 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, enum node_frequency @var{freq}, bool @var{startup}, bool @var{exit})
7398 Return preferred text (sub)section for function @var{decl}.
7399 Main purpose of this function is to separate cold, normal and hot
7400 functions. @var{startup} is true when function is known to be used only
7401 at startup (from static constructors or it is @code{main()}).
7402 @var{exit} is true when function is known to be used only at exit
7403 (from static destructors).
7404 Return NULL if function should go to default text section.
7405 @end deftypefn
7406
7407 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SWITCHED_TEXT_SECTIONS (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{decl}, bool @var{new_is_cold})
7408 Used by the target to emit any assembler directives or additional labels needed when a function is partitioned between different sections. Output should be written to @var{file}. The function decl is available as @var{decl} and the new section is `cold' if @var{new_is_cold} is @code{true}.
7409 @end deftypefn
7410
7411 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS
7412 This flag is true if the target supports @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}.
7413 It must not be modified by command-line option processing.
7414 @end deftypevr
7415
7416 @anchor{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}
7417 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS
7418 This flag is true if we can create zeroed data by switching to a BSS
7419 section and then using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} to allocate the space.
7420 This is true on most ELF targets.
7421 @end deftypevr
7422
7423 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS (tree @var{decl}, const char *@var{name}, int @var{reloc})
7424 Choose a set of section attributes for use by @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}
7425 based on a variable or function decl, a section name, and whether or not the
7426 declaration's initializer may contain runtime relocations. @var{decl} may be
7427 null, in which case read-write data should be assumed.
7428
7429 The default version of this function handles choosing code vs data,
7430 read-only vs read-write data, and @code{flag_pic}. You should only
7431 need to override this if your target has special flags that might be
7432 set via @code{__attribute__}.
7433 @end deftypefn
7434
7435 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES (print_switch_type @var{type}, const char *@var{text})
7436 Provides the target with the ability to record the gcc command line
7437 switches that have been passed to the compiler, and options that are
7438 enabled. The @var{type} argument specifies what is being recorded.
7439 It can take the following values:
7440
7441 @table @gcctabopt
7442 @item SWITCH_TYPE_PASSED
7443 @var{text} is a command line switch that has been set by the user.
7444
7445 @item SWITCH_TYPE_ENABLED
7446 @var{text} is an option which has been enabled. This might be as a
7447 direct result of a command line switch, or because it is enabled by
7448 default or because it has been enabled as a side effect of a different
7449 command line switch. For example, the @option{-O2} switch enables
7450 various different individual optimization passes.
7451
7452 @item SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE
7453 @var{text} is either NULL or some descriptive text which should be
7454 ignored. If @var{text} is NULL then it is being used to warn the
7455 target hook that either recording is starting or ending. The first
7456 time @var{type} is SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE and @var{text} is NULL, the
7457 warning is for start up and the second time the warning is for
7458 wind down. This feature is to allow the target hook to make any
7459 necessary preparations before it starts to record switches and to
7460 perform any necessary tidying up after it has finished recording
7461 switches.
7462
7463 @item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_START
7464 This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7465
7466 @item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_END
7467 This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7468 @end table
7469
7470 The hook's return value must be zero. Other return values may be
7471 supported in the future.
7472
7473 By default this hook is set to NULL, but an example implementation is
7474 provided for ELF based targets. Called @var{elf_record_gcc_switches},
7475 it records the switches as ASCII text inside a new, string mergeable
7476 section in the assembler output file. The name of the new section is
7477 provided by the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION} target
7478 hook.
7479 @end deftypefn
7480
7481 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION
7482 This is the name of the section that will be created by the example
7483 ELF implementation of the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES} target
7484 hook.
7485 @end deftypevr
7486
7487 @need 2000
7488 @node Data Output
7489 @subsection Output of Data
7490
7491
7492 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP
7493 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
7494 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
7495 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
7496 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_TI_OP
7497 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP
7498 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP
7499 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP
7500 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_TI_OP
7501 These hooks specify assembly directives for creating certain kinds
7502 of integer object. The @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} directive creates a
7503 byte-sized object, the @code{TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP} one creates an
7504 aligned two-byte object, and so on. Any of the hooks may be
7505 @code{NULL}, indicating that no suitable directive is available.
7506
7507 The compiler will print these strings at the start of a new line,
7508 followed immediately by the object's initial value. In most cases,
7509 the string should contain a tab, a pseudo-op, and then another tab.
7510 @end deftypevr
7511
7512 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_INTEGER (rtx @var{x}, unsigned int @var{size}, int @var{aligned_p})
7513 The @code{assemble_integer} function uses this hook to output an
7514 integer object. @var{x} is the object's value, @var{size} is its size
7515 in bytes and @var{aligned_p} indicates whether it is aligned. The
7516 function should return @code{true} if it was able to output the
7517 object. If it returns false, @code{assemble_integer} will try to
7518 split the object into smaller parts.
7519
7520 The default implementation of this hook will use the
7521 @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} family of strings, returning @code{false}
7522 when the relevant string is @code{NULL}.
7523 @end deftypefn
7524
7525 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA (FILE *@var{file}, rtx @var{x})
7526 A target hook to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that @code{output_addr_const}
7527 can't deal with, and output assembly code to @var{file} corresponding to
7528 the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to allow machine-dependent
7529 @code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
7530
7531 If target hook fails to recognize a pattern, it must return @code{false},
7532 so that a standard error message is printed. If it prints an error message
7533 itself, by calling, for example, @code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just
7534 return @code{true}.
7535 @end deftypefn
7536
7537 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}, @var{len})
7538 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7539 instruction to assemble a string constant containing the @var{len}
7540 bytes at @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} will be a C expression of type
7541 @code{char *} and @var{len} a C expression of type @code{int}.
7542
7543 If the assembler has a @code{.ascii} pseudo-op as found in the
7544 Berkeley Unix assembler, do not define the macro
7545 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII}.
7546 @end defmac
7547
7548 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{n})
7549 A C statement to output word @var{n} of a function descriptor for
7550 @var{decl}. This must be defined if @code{TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS}
7551 is defined, and is otherwise unused.
7552 @end defmac
7553
7554 @defmac CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
7555 You may define this macro as a C expression. You should define the
7556 expression to have a nonzero value if GCC should output the constant
7557 pool for a function before the code for the function, or a zero value if
7558 GCC should output the constant pool after the function. If you do
7559 not define this macro, the usual case, GCC will output the constant
7560 pool before the function.
7561 @end defmac
7562
7563 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE (@var{file}, @var{funname}, @var{fundecl}, @var{size})
7564 A C statement to output assembler commands to define the start of the
7565 constant pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving
7566 the name of the function. Should the return type of the function
7567 be required, it can be obtained via @var{fundecl}. @var{size}
7568 is the size, in bytes, of the constant pool that will be written
7569 immediately after this call.
7570
7571 If no constant-pool prefix is required, the usual case, this macro need
7572 not be defined.
7573 @end defmac
7574
7575 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY (@var{file}, @var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{align}, @var{labelno}, @var{jumpto})
7576 A C statement (with or without semicolon) to output a constant in the
7577 constant pool, if it needs special treatment. (This macro need not do
7578 anything for RTL expressions that can be output normally.)
7579
7580 The argument @var{file} is the standard I/O stream to output the
7581 assembler code on. @var{x} is the RTL expression for the constant to
7582 output, and @var{mode} is the machine mode (in case @var{x} is a
7583 @samp{const_int}). @var{align} is the required alignment for the value
7584 @var{x}; you should output an assembler directive to force this much
7585 alignment.
7586
7587 The argument @var{labelno} is a number to use in an internal label for
7588 the address of this pool entry. The definition of this macro is
7589 responsible for outputting the label definition at the proper place.
7590 Here is how to do this:
7591
7592 @smallexample
7593 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} (@var{file}, "LC", @var{labelno});
7594 @end smallexample
7595
7596 When you output a pool entry specially, you should end with a
7597 @code{goto} to the label @var{jumpto}. This will prevent the same pool
7598 entry from being output a second time in the usual manner.
7599
7600 You need not define this macro if it would do nothing.
7601 @end defmac
7602
7603 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size})
7604 A C statement to output assembler commands to at the end of the constant
7605 pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving the name of the
7606 function. Should the return type of the function be required, you can
7607 obtain it via @var{fundecl}. @var{size} is the size, in bytes, of the
7608 constant pool that GCC wrote immediately before this call.
7609
7610 If no constant-pool epilogue is required, the usual case, you need not
7611 define this macro.
7612 @end defmac
7613
7614 @defmac IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (@var{C}, @var{STR})
7615 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if @var{C} is
7616 used as a logical line separator by the assembler. @var{STR} points
7617 to the position in the string where @var{C} was found; this can be used if
7618 a line separator uses multiple characters.
7619
7620 If you do not define this macro, the default is that only
7621 the character @samp{;} is treated as a logical line separator.
7622 @end defmac
7623
7624 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_OPEN_PAREN
7625 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_CLOSE_PAREN
7626 These target hooks are C string constants, describing the syntax in the
7627 assembler for grouping arithmetic expressions. If not overridden, they
7628 default to normal parentheses, which is correct for most assemblers.
7629 @end deftypevr
7630
7631 These macros are provided by @file{real.h} for writing the definitions
7632 of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE} and the like:
7633
7634 @defmac REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7635 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7636 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7637 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7638 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL64 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7639 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL128 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7640 These translate @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to the
7641 target's floating point representation, and store its bit pattern in
7642 the variable @var{l}. For @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE} and
7643 @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32}, this variable should be a
7644 simple @code{long int}. For the others, it should be an array of
7645 @code{long int}. The number of elements in this array is determined
7646 by the size of the desired target floating point data type: 32 bits of
7647 it go in each @code{long int} array element. Each array element holds
7648 32 bits of the result, even if @code{long int} is wider than 32 bits
7649 on the host machine.
7650
7651 The array element values are designed so that you can print them out
7652 using @code{fprintf} in the order they should appear in the target
7653 machine's memory.
7654 @end defmac
7655
7656 @node Uninitialized Data
7657 @subsection Output of Uninitialized Variables
7658
7659 Each of the macros in this section is used to do the whole job of
7660 outputting a single uninitialized variable.
7661
7662 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7663 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7664 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a common-label named
7665 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7666 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants. It is
7667 possible that @var{size} may be zero, for instance if a struct with no
7668 other member than a zero-length array is defined. In this case, the
7669 backend must output a symbol definition that allocates at least one
7670 byte, both so that the address of the resulting object does not compare
7671 equal to any other, and because some object formats cannot even express
7672 the concept of a zero-sized common symbol, as that is how they represent
7673 an ordinary undefined external.
7674
7675 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7676 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7677 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7678
7679 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7680 common global variables are output.
7681 @end defmac
7682
7683 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7684 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} except takes the required alignment as a
7685 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7686 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, and gives you more flexibility in
7687 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7688 as the number of bits.
7689 @end defmac
7690
7691 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7692 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} except that @var{decl} of the
7693 variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7694 is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7695 in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} and
7696 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON}. Define this macro when you need to see
7697 the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7698 @end defmac
7699
7700 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7701 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7702 @var{stream} the assembler definition of uninitialized global @var{decl} named
7703 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{alignment}
7704 is the alignment specified as the number of bits.
7705
7706 Try to use function @code{asm_output_aligned_bss} defined in file
7707 @file{varasm.c} when defining this macro. If unable, use the expression
7708 @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name itself;
7709 before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax for defining
7710 the name, and a newline.
7711
7712 There are two ways of handling global BSS@. One is to define this macro.
7713 The other is to have @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION} return a
7714 switchable BSS section (@pxref{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}).
7715 You do not need to do both.
7716
7717 Some languages do not have @code{common} data, and require a
7718 non-common form of global BSS in order to handle uninitialized globals
7719 efficiently. C++ is one example of this. However, if the target does
7720 not support global BSS, the front end may choose to make globals
7721 common in order to save space in the object file.
7722 @end defmac
7723
7724 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7725 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7726 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a local-common-label named
7727 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7728 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
7729
7730 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7731 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7732 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7733
7734 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7735 static variables are output.
7736 @end defmac
7737
7738 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7739 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} except takes the required alignment as a
7740 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7741 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, and gives you more flexibility in
7742 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7743 as the number of bits.
7744 @end defmac
7745
7746 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7747 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL} except that @var{decl} of the
7748 variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7749 is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7750 in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DECL} and
7751 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL}. Define this macro when you need to see
7752 the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7753 @end defmac
7754
7755 @node Label Output
7756 @subsection Output and Generation of Labels
7757
7758 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7759 This is about outputting labels.
7760
7761 @findex assemble_name
7762 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7763 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7764 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name}.
7765 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7766 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7767 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7768 definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7769 @end defmac
7770
7771 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7772 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7773 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name} of
7774 a function.
7775 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7776 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7777 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7778 definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7779
7780 If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
7781 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7782 @end defmac
7783
7784 @findex assemble_name_raw
7785 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7786 Identical to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}, except that @var{name} is known
7787 to refer to a compiler-generated label. The default definition uses
7788 @code{assemble_name_raw}, which is like @code{assemble_name} except
7789 that it is more efficient.
7790 @end defmac
7791
7792 @defmac SIZE_ASM_OP
7793 A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7794 size of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7795 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.size\t"}; on other
7796 systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7797
7798 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definitions
7799 of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE}
7800 for your system. If you need your own custom definitions of those
7801 macros, or if you do not need explicit symbol sizes at all, do not
7802 define this macro.
7803 @end defmac
7804
7805 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size})
7806 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7807 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the size of the
7808 symbol @var{name} is @var{size}. @var{size} is a @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}.
7809 If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7810 provided.
7811 @end defmac
7812
7813 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7814 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7815 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler to calculate the size of
7816 the symbol @var{name} by subtracting its address from the current
7817 address.
7818
7819 If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7820 provided. The default assumes that the assembler recognizes a special
7821 @samp{.} symbol as referring to the current address, and can calculate
7822 the difference between this and another symbol. If your assembler does
7823 not recognize @samp{.} or cannot do calculations with it, you will need
7824 to redefine @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} to use some other technique.
7825 @end defmac
7826
7827 @defmac NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
7828 Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
7829 @samp{$} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in
7830 G++ have @samp{$} in the identifiers. If this macro is defined,
7831 @samp{.} is used instead.
7832 @end defmac
7833
7834 @defmac NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
7835 Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
7836 @samp{.} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in G++
7837 have names that use @samp{.}. If this macro is defined, these names
7838 are rewritten to avoid @samp{.}.
7839 @end defmac
7840
7841 @defmac TYPE_ASM_OP
7842 A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7843 type of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7844 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.type\t"}; on other
7845 systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7846
7847 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7848 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7849 custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7850 types at all, do not define this macro.
7851 @end defmac
7852
7853 @defmac TYPE_OPERAND_FMT
7854 A C string which specifies (using @code{printf} syntax) the format of
7855 the second operand to @code{TYPE_ASM_OP}. On systems that use ELF, the
7856 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"@@%s"}; on other systems,
7857 the default is not to define this macro.
7858
7859 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7860 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7861 custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7862 types at all, do not define this macro.
7863 @end defmac
7864
7865 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{type})
7866 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7867 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the type of the
7868 symbol @var{name} is @var{type}. @var{type} is a C string; currently,
7869 that string is always either @samp{"function"} or @samp{"object"}, but
7870 you should not count on this.
7871
7872 If you define @code{TYPE_ASM_OP} and @code{TYPE_OPERAND_FMT}, a default
7873 definition of this macro is provided.
7874 @end defmac
7875
7876 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7877 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7878 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
7879 function which is being defined. This macro is responsible for
7880 outputting the label definition (perhaps using
7881 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
7882 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
7883
7884 If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
7885 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}).
7886
7887 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
7888 of this macro.
7889 @end defmac
7890
7891 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7892 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7893 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a function
7894 which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
7895 function. The argument @var{decl} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node
7896 representing the function.
7897
7898 If this macro is not defined, then the function size is not defined.
7899
7900 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
7901 of this macro.
7902 @end defmac
7903
7904 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7905 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7906 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of an
7907 initialized variable which is being defined. This macro must output the
7908 label definition (perhaps using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument
7909 @var{decl} is the @code{VAR_DECL} tree node representing the variable.
7910
7911 If this macro is not defined, then the variable name is defined in the
7912 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7913
7914 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7915 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition of this macro.
7916 @end defmac
7917
7918 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DECLARE_CONSTANT_NAME (FILE *@var{file}, const char *@var{name}, const_tree @var{expr}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
7919 A target hook to output to the stdio stream @var{file} any text necessary
7920 for declaring the name @var{name} of a constant which is being defined. This
7921 target hook is responsible for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
7922 @code{assemble_label}). The argument @var{exp} is the value of the constant,
7923 and @var{size} is the size of the constant in bytes. The @var{name}
7924 will be an internal label.
7925
7926 The default version of this target hook, define the @var{name} in the
7927 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{assemble_label}).
7928
7929 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in this target hook.
7930 @end deftypefn
7931
7932 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{regno}, @var{name})
7933 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7934 @var{stream} any text necessary for claiming a register @var{regno}
7935 for a global variable @var{decl} with name @var{name}.
7936
7937 If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7938 nothing.
7939 @end defmac
7940
7941 @defmac ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{toplevel}, @var{atend})
7942 A C statement (sans semicolon) to finish up declaring a variable name
7943 once the compiler has processed its initializer fully and thus has had a
7944 chance to determine the size of an array when controlled by an
7945 initializer. This is used on systems where it's necessary to declare
7946 something about the size of the object.
7947
7948 If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7949 nothing.
7950
7951 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7952 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition of this macro.
7953 @end defmac
7954
7955 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{name})
7956 This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7957 @var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} global;
7958 that is, available for reference from other files.
7959
7960 The default implementation relies on a proper definition of
7961 @code{GLOBAL_ASM_OP}.
7962 @end deftypefn
7963
7964 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_DECL_NAME (FILE *@var{stream}, tree @var{decl})
7965 This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7966 @var{stream} some commands that will make the name associated with @var{decl}
7967 global; that is, available for reference from other files.
7968
7969 The default implementation uses the TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL target hook.
7970 @end deftypefn
7971
7972 @defmac ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7973 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7974 @var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} weak;
7975 that is, available for reference from other files but only used if
7976 no other definition is available. Use the expression
7977 @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
7978 itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
7979 for making that name weak, and a newline.
7980
7981 If you don't define this macro or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}, GCC will not
7982 support weak symbols and you should not define the @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK}
7983 macro.
7984 @end defmac
7985
7986 @defmac ASM_WEAKEN_DECL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
7987 Combines (and replaces) the function of @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} and
7988 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS}, allowing access to the associated function
7989 or variable decl. If @var{value} is not @code{NULL}, this C statement
7990 should output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code which
7991 defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
7992 @var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it should output commands
7993 to make @var{name} weak.
7994 @end defmac
7995
7996 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAKREF (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
7997 Outputs a directive that enables @var{name} to be used to refer to
7998 symbol @var{value} with weak-symbol semantics. @code{decl} is the
7999 declaration of @code{name}.
8000 @end defmac
8001
8002 @defmac SUPPORTS_WEAK
8003 A preprocessor constant expression which evaluates to true if the target
8004 supports weak symbols.
8005
8006 If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
8007 definition. If either @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}
8008 is defined, the default definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}.
8009 @end defmac
8010
8011 @defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WEAK
8012 A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports weak symbols.
8013
8014 If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
8015 definition. The default definition is @samp{(SUPPORTS_WEAK)}. Define
8016 this macro if you want to control weak symbol support with a compiler
8017 flag such as @option{-melf}.
8018 @end defmac
8019
8020 @defmac MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY (@var{decl})
8021 A C statement (sans semicolon) to mark @var{decl} to be emitted as a
8022 public symbol such that extra copies in multiple translation units will
8023 be discarded by the linker. Define this macro if your object file
8024 format provides support for this concept, such as the @samp{COMDAT}
8025 section flags in the Microsoft Windows PE/COFF format, and this support
8026 requires changes to @var{decl}, such as putting it in a separate section.
8027 @end defmac
8028
8029 @defmac SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
8030 A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports one-only
8031 semantics.
8032
8033 If you don't define this macro, @file{varasm.c} provides a default
8034 definition. If @code{MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY} is defined, the default
8035 definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}. Define this macro if
8036 you want to control one-only symbol support with a compiler flag, or if
8037 setting the @code{DECL_ONE_ONLY} flag is enough to mark a declaration to
8038 be emitted as one-only.
8039 @end defmac
8040
8041 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl}, int @var{visibility})
8042 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} some
8043 commands that will make the symbol(s) associated with @var{decl} have
8044 hidden, protected or internal visibility as specified by @var{visibility}.
8045 @end deftypefn
8046
8047 @defmac TARGET_WEAK_NOT_IN_ARCHIVE_TOC
8048 A C expression that evaluates to true if the target's linker expects
8049 that weak symbols do not appear in a static archive's table of contents.
8050 The default is @code{0}.
8051
8052 Leaving weak symbols out of an archive's table of contents means that,
8053 if a symbol will only have a definition in one translation unit and
8054 will have undefined references from other translation units, that
8055 symbol should not be weak. Defining this macro to be nonzero will
8056 thus have the effect that certain symbols that would normally be weak
8057 (explicit template instantiations, and vtables for polymorphic classes
8058 with noninline key methods) will instead be nonweak.
8059
8060 The C++ ABI requires this macro to be zero. Define this macro for
8061 targets where full C++ ABI compliance is impossible and where linker
8062 restrictions require weak symbols to be left out of a static archive's
8063 table of contents.
8064 @end defmac
8065
8066 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name})
8067 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8068 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name of an external
8069 symbol named @var{name} which is referenced in this compilation but
8070 not defined. The value of @var{decl} is the tree node for the
8071 declaration.
8072
8073 This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
8074 The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
8075 @end defmac
8076
8077 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL (rtx @var{symref})
8078 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
8079 pseudo-op to declare a library function name external. The name of the
8080 library function is given by @var{symref}, which is a @code{symbol_ref}.
8081 @end deftypefn
8082
8083 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_MARK_DECL_PRESERVED (const char *@var{symbol})
8084 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
8085 directive to annotate @var{symbol} as used. The Darwin target uses the
8086 .no_dead_code_strip directive.
8087 @end deftypefn
8088
8089 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8090 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8091 @var{stream} a reference in assembler syntax to a label named
8092 @var{name}. This should add @samp{_} to the front of the name, if that
8093 is customary on your operating system, as it is in most Berkeley Unix
8094 systems. This macro is used in @code{assemble_name}.
8095 @end defmac
8096
8097 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MANGLE_ASSEMBLER_NAME (const char *@var{name})
8098 Given a symbol @var{name}, perform same mangling as @code{varasm.c}'s @code{assemble_name}, but in memory rather than to a file stream, returning result as an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE}. Required for correct LTO symtabs. The default implementation calls the @code{TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING} hook and then prepends the @code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX}, if any.
8099 @end deftypefn
8100
8101 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{sym})
8102 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to
8103 @code{SYMBOL_REF} @var{sym}. If not defined, @code{assemble_name}
8104 will be used to output the name of the symbol. This macro may be used
8105 to modify the way a symbol is referenced depending on information
8106 encoded by @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}.
8107 @end defmac
8108
8109 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{buf})
8110 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to @var{buf}, the
8111 result of @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}. If not defined,
8112 @code{assemble_name} will be used to output the name of the symbol.
8113 This macro is not used by @code{output_asm_label}, or the @code{%l}
8114 specifier that calls it; the intention is that this macro should be set
8115 when it is necessary to output a label differently when its address is
8116 being taken.
8117 @end defmac
8118
8119 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INTERNAL_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{prefix}, unsigned long @var{labelno})
8120 A function to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a label whose
8121 name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{labelno}.
8122
8123 It is absolutely essential that these labels be distinct from the labels
8124 used for user-level functions and variables. Otherwise, certain programs
8125 will have name conflicts with internal labels.
8126
8127 It is desirable to exclude internal labels from the symbol table of the
8128 object file. Most assemblers have a naming convention for labels that
8129 should be excluded; on many systems, the letter @samp{L} at the
8130 beginning of a label has this effect. You should find out what
8131 convention your system uses, and follow it.
8132
8133 The default version of this function utilizes @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}.
8134 @end deftypefn
8135
8136 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8137 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a debug info
8138 label whose name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number
8139 @var{num}. This is useful for VLIW targets, where debug info labels
8140 may need to be treated differently than branch target labels. On some
8141 systems, branch target labels must be at the beginning of instruction
8142 bundles, but debug info labels can occur in the middle of instruction
8143 bundles.
8144
8145 If this macro is not defined, then @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} will be
8146 used.
8147 @end defmac
8148
8149 @defmac ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{string}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8150 A C statement to store into the string @var{string} a label whose name
8151 is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
8152
8153 This string, when output subsequently by @code{assemble_name}, should
8154 produce the output that @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} would produce
8155 with the same @var{prefix} and @var{num}.
8156
8157 If the string begins with @samp{*}, then @code{assemble_name} will
8158 output the rest of the string unchanged. It is often convenient for
8159 @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} to use @samp{*} in this way. If the
8160 string doesn't start with @samp{*}, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} gets
8161 to output the string, and may change it. (Of course,
8162 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} is also part of your machine description, so
8163 you should know what it does on your machine.)
8164 @end defmac
8165
8166 @defmac ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME (@var{outvar}, @var{name}, @var{number})
8167 A C expression to assign to @var{outvar} (which is a variable of type
8168 @code{char *}) a newly allocated string made from the string
8169 @var{name} and the number @var{number}, with some suitable punctuation
8170 added. Use @code{alloca} to get space for the string.
8171
8172 The string will be used as an argument to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to
8173 produce an assembler label for an internal static variable whose name is
8174 @var{name}. Therefore, the string must be such as to result in valid
8175 assembler code. The argument @var{number} is different each time this
8176 macro is executed; it prevents conflicts between similarly-named
8177 internal static variables in different scopes.
8178
8179 Ideally this string should not be a valid C identifier, to prevent any
8180 conflict with the user's own symbols. Most assemblers allow periods
8181 or percent signs in assembler symbols; putting at least one of these
8182 between the name and the number will suffice.
8183
8184 If this macro is not defined, a default definition will be provided
8185 which is correct for most systems.
8186 @end defmac
8187
8188 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8189 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8190 which defines (equates) the symbol @var{name} to have the value @var{value}.
8191
8192 @findex SET_ASM_OP
8193 If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8194 correct for most systems.
8195 @end defmac
8196
8197 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS (@var{stream}, @var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8198 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8199 which defines (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name}
8200 to have the value of the tree node @var{decl_of_value}. This macro will
8201 be used in preference to @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} if it is defined and if
8202 the tree nodes are available.
8203
8204 @findex SET_ASM_OP
8205 If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8206 correct for most systems.
8207 @end defmac
8208
8209 @defmac TARGET_DEFERRED_OUTPUT_DEFS (@var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8210 A C statement that evaluates to true if the assembler code which defines
8211 (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name} to have the value
8212 of the tree node @var{decl_of_value} should be emitted near the end of the
8213 current compilation unit. The default is to not defer output of defines.
8214 This macro affects defines output by @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} and
8215 @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS}.
8216 @end defmac
8217
8218 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8219 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8220 which defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
8221 @var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it defines @var{name} as
8222 an undefined weak symbol.
8223
8224 Define this macro if the target only supports weak aliases; define
8225 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} instead if possible.
8226 @end defmac
8227
8228 @defmac OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL (@var{buf}, @var{is_inst}, @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name}, @var{sel_name})
8229 Define this macro to override the default assembler names used for
8230 Objective-C methods.
8231
8232 The default name is a unique method number followed by the name of the
8233 class (e.g.@: @samp{_1_Foo}). For methods in categories, the name of
8234 the category is also included in the assembler name (e.g.@:
8235 @samp{_1_Foo_Bar}).
8236
8237 These names are safe on most systems, but make debugging difficult since
8238 the method's selector is not present in the name. Therefore, particular
8239 systems define other ways of computing names.
8240
8241 @var{buf} is an expression of type @code{char *} which gives you a
8242 buffer in which to store the name; its length is as long as
8243 @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name} and @var{sel_name} put together, plus
8244 50 characters extra.
8245
8246 The argument @var{is_inst} specifies whether the method is an instance
8247 method or a class method; @var{class_name} is the name of the class;
8248 @var{cat_name} is the name of the category (or @code{NULL} if the method is not
8249 in a category); and @var{sel_name} is the name of the selector.
8250
8251 On systems where the assembler can handle quoted names, you can use this
8252 macro to provide more human-readable names.
8253 @end defmac
8254
8255 @node Initialization
8256 @subsection How Initialization Functions Are Handled
8257 @cindex initialization routines
8258 @cindex termination routines
8259 @cindex constructors, output of
8260 @cindex destructors, output of
8261
8262 The compiled code for certain languages includes @dfn{constructors}
8263 (also called @dfn{initialization routines})---functions to initialize
8264 data in the program when the program is started. These functions need
8265 to be called before the program is ``started''---that is to say, before
8266 @code{main} is called.
8267
8268 Compiling some languages generates @dfn{destructors} (also called
8269 @dfn{termination routines}) that should be called when the program
8270 terminates.
8271
8272 To make the initialization and termination functions work, the compiler
8273 must output something in the assembler code to cause those functions to
8274 be called at the appropriate time. When you port the compiler to a new
8275 system, you need to specify how to do this.
8276
8277 There are two major ways that GCC currently supports the execution of
8278 initialization and termination functions. Each way has two variants.
8279 Much of the structure is common to all four variations.
8280
8281 @findex __CTOR_LIST__
8282 @findex __DTOR_LIST__
8283 The linker must build two lists of these functions---a list of
8284 initialization functions, called @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, and a list of
8285 termination functions, called @code{__DTOR_LIST__}.
8286
8287 Each list always begins with an ignored function pointer (which may hold
8288 0, @minus{}1, or a count of the function pointers after it, depending on
8289 the environment). This is followed by a series of zero or more function
8290 pointers to constructors (or destructors), followed by a function
8291 pointer containing zero.
8292
8293 Depending on the operating system and its executable file format, either
8294 @file{crtstuff.c} or @file{libgcc2.c} traverses these lists at startup
8295 time and exit time. Constructors are called in reverse order of the
8296 list; destructors in forward order.
8297
8298 The best way to handle static constructors works only for object file
8299 formats which provide arbitrarily-named sections. A section is set
8300 aside for a list of constructors, and another for a list of destructors.
8301 Traditionally these are called @samp{.ctors} and @samp{.dtors}. Each
8302 object file that defines an initialization function also puts a word in
8303 the constructor section to point to that function. The linker
8304 accumulates all these words into one contiguous @samp{.ctors} section.
8305 Termination functions are handled similarly.
8306
8307 This method will be chosen as the default by @file{target-def.h} if
8308 @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is defined. A target that does not
8309 support arbitrary sections, but does support special designated
8310 constructor and destructor sections may define @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8311 and @code{DTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP} to achieve the same effect.
8312
8313 When arbitrary sections are available, there are two variants, depending
8314 upon how the code in @file{crtstuff.c} is called. On systems that
8315 support a @dfn{.init} section which is executed at program startup,
8316 parts of @file{crtstuff.c} are compiled into that section. The
8317 program is linked by the @command{gcc} driver like this:
8318
8319 @smallexample
8320 ld -o @var{output_file} crti.o crtbegin.o @dots{} -lgcc crtend.o crtn.o
8321 @end smallexample
8322
8323 The prologue of a function (@code{__init}) appears in the @code{.init}
8324 section of @file{crti.o}; the epilogue appears in @file{crtn.o}. Likewise
8325 for the function @code{__fini} in the @dfn{.fini} section. Normally these
8326 files are provided by the operating system or by the GNU C library, but
8327 are provided by GCC for a few targets.
8328
8329 The objects @file{crtbegin.o} and @file{crtend.o} are (for most targets)
8330 compiled from @file{crtstuff.c}. They contain, among other things, code
8331 fragments within the @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections that branch
8332 to routines in the @code{.text} section. The linker will pull all parts
8333 of a section together, which results in a complete @code{__init} function
8334 that invokes the routines we need at startup.
8335
8336 To use this variant, you must define the @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8337 macro properly.
8338
8339 If no init section is available, when GCC compiles any function called
8340 @code{main} (or more accurately, any function designated as a program
8341 entry point by the language front end calling @code{expand_main_function}),
8342 it inserts a procedure call to @code{__main} as the first executable code
8343 after the function prologue. The @code{__main} function is defined
8344 in @file{libgcc2.c} and runs the global constructors.
8345
8346 In file formats that don't support arbitrary sections, there are again
8347 two variants. In the simplest variant, the GNU linker (GNU @code{ld})
8348 and an `a.out' format must be used. In this case,
8349 @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} is defined to produce a @code{.stabs}
8350 entry of type @samp{N_SETT}, referencing the name @code{__CTOR_LIST__},
8351 and with the address of the void function containing the initialization
8352 code as its value. The GNU linker recognizes this as a request to add
8353 the value to a @dfn{set}; the values are accumulated, and are eventually
8354 placed in the executable as a vector in the format described above, with
8355 a leading (ignored) count and a trailing zero element.
8356 @code{TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR} is handled similarly. Since no init
8357 section is available, the absence of @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} causes
8358 the compilation of @code{main} to call @code{__main} as above, starting
8359 the initialization process.
8360
8361 The last variant uses neither arbitrary sections nor the GNU linker.
8362 This is preferable when you want to do dynamic linking and when using
8363 file formats which the GNU linker does not support, such as `ECOFF'@. In
8364 this case, @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is false, initialization and
8365 termination functions are recognized simply by their names. This requires
8366 an extra program in the linkage step, called @command{collect2}. This program
8367 pretends to be the linker, for use with GCC; it does its job by running
8368 the ordinary linker, but also arranges to include the vectors of
8369 initialization and termination functions. These functions are called
8370 via @code{__main} as described above. In order to use this method,
8371 @code{use_collect2} must be defined in the target in @file{config.gcc}.
8372
8373 @ifinfo
8374 The following section describes the specific macros that control and
8375 customize the handling of initialization and termination functions.
8376 @end ifinfo
8377
8378 @node Macros for Initialization
8379 @subsection Macros Controlling Initialization Routines
8380
8381 Here are the macros that control how the compiler handles initialization
8382 and termination functions:
8383
8384 @defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
8385 If defined, a C string constant, including spacing, for the assembler
8386 operation to identify the following data as initialization code. If not
8387 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. When you are
8388 using special sections for initialization and termination functions, this
8389 macro also controls how @file{crtstuff.c} and @file{libgcc2.c} arrange to
8390 run the initialization functions.
8391 @end defmac
8392
8393 @defmac HAS_INIT_SECTION
8394 If defined, @code{main} will not call @code{__main} as described above.
8395 This macro should be defined for systems that control start-up code
8396 on a symbol-by-symbol basis, such as OSF/1, and should not
8397 be defined explicitly for systems that support @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
8398 @end defmac
8399
8400 @defmac LD_INIT_SWITCH
8401 If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8402 the following symbol is an initialization routine.
8403 @end defmac
8404
8405 @defmac LD_FINI_SWITCH
8406 If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8407 the following symbol is a finalization routine.
8408 @end defmac
8409
8410 @defmac COLLECT_SHARED_INIT_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8411 If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8412 automatically called when a shared library is loaded. The function
8413 should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8414 the object format requires an explicit initialization function, then a
8415 function called @code{_GLOBAL__DI} will be generated.
8416
8417 This function and the following one are used by collect2 when linking a
8418 shared library that needs constructors or destructors, or has DWARF2
8419 exception tables embedded in the code.
8420 @end defmac
8421
8422 @defmac COLLECT_SHARED_FINI_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8423 If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8424 automatically called when a shared library is unloaded. The function
8425 should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8426 the object format requires an explicit finalization function, then a
8427 function called @code{_GLOBAL__DD} will be generated.
8428 @end defmac
8429
8430 @defmac INVOKE__main
8431 If defined, @code{main} will call @code{__main} despite the presence of
8432 @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}. This macro should be defined for systems
8433 where the init section is not actually run automatically, but is still
8434 useful for collecting the lists of constructors and destructors.
8435 @end defmac
8436
8437 @defmac SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
8438 If nonzero, the C++ @code{init_priority} attribute is supported and the
8439 compiler should emit instructions to control the order of initialization
8440 of objects. If zero, the compiler will issue an error message upon
8441 encountering an @code{init_priority} attribute.
8442 @end defmac
8443
8444 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS
8445 This value is true if the target supports some ``native'' method of
8446 collecting constructors and destructors to be run at startup and exit.
8447 It is false if we must use @command{collect2}.
8448 @end deftypevr
8449
8450 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
8451 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code to arrange to call
8452 the function referenced by @var{symbol} at initialization time.
8453
8454 Assume that @var{symbol} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} for a function taking
8455 no arguments and with no return value. If the target supports initialization
8456 priorities, @var{priority} is a value between 0 and @code{MAX_INIT_PRIORITY};
8457 otherwise it must be @code{DEFAULT_INIT_PRIORITY}.
8458
8459 If this macro is not defined by the target, a suitable default will
8460 be chosen if (1) the target supports arbitrary section names, (2) the
8461 target defines @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}, or (3) @code{USE_COLLECT2}
8462 is not defined.
8463 @end deftypefn
8464
8465 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
8466 This is like @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} but used for termination
8467 functions rather than initialization functions.
8468 @end deftypefn
8469
8470 If @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is true, the initialization routine
8471 generated for the generated object file will have static linkage.
8472
8473 If your system uses @command{collect2} as the means of processing
8474 constructors, then that program normally uses @command{nm} to scan
8475 an object file for constructor functions to be called.
8476
8477 On certain kinds of systems, you can define this macro to make
8478 @command{collect2} work faster (and, in some cases, make it work at all):
8479
8480 @defmac OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
8481 Define this macro if the system uses COFF (Common Object File Format)
8482 object files, so that @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan
8483 object files directly for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
8484
8485 This macro is effective only in a native compiler; @command{collect2} as
8486 part of a cross compiler always uses @command{nm} for the target machine.
8487 @end defmac
8488
8489 @defmac REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
8490 Define this macro as a C string constant containing the file name to use
8491 to execute @command{nm}. The default is to search the path normally for
8492 @command{nm}.
8493 @end defmac
8494
8495 @defmac NM_FLAGS
8496 @command{collect2} calls @command{nm} to scan object files for static
8497 constructors and destructors and LTO info. By default, @option{-n} is
8498 passed. Define @code{NM_FLAGS} to a C string constant if other options
8499 are needed to get the same output format as GNU @command{nm -n}
8500 produces.
8501 @end defmac
8502
8503 If your system supports shared libraries and has a program to list the
8504 dynamic dependencies of a given library or executable, you can define
8505 these macros to enable support for running initialization and
8506 termination functions in shared libraries:
8507
8508 @defmac LDD_SUFFIX
8509 Define this macro to a C string constant containing the name of the program
8510 which lists dynamic dependencies, like @command{ldd} under SunOS 4.
8511 @end defmac
8512
8513 @defmac PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT (@var{ptr})
8514 Define this macro to be C code that extracts filenames from the output
8515 of the program denoted by @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. @var{ptr} is a variable
8516 of type @code{char *} that points to the beginning of a line of output
8517 from @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. If the line lists a dynamic dependency, the
8518 code must advance @var{ptr} to the beginning of the filename on that
8519 line. Otherwise, it must set @var{ptr} to @code{NULL}.
8520 @end defmac
8521
8522 @defmac SHLIB_SUFFIX
8523 Define this macro to a C string constant containing the default shared
8524 library extension of the target (e.g., @samp{".so"}). @command{collect2}
8525 strips version information after this suffix when generating global
8526 constructor and destructor names. This define is only needed on targets
8527 that use @command{collect2} to process constructors and destructors.
8528 @end defmac
8529
8530 @node Instruction Output
8531 @subsection Output of Assembler Instructions
8532
8533 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8534 This describes assembler instruction output.
8535
8536 @defmac REGISTER_NAMES
8537 A C initializer containing the assembler's names for the machine
8538 registers, each one as a C string constant. This is what translates
8539 register numbers in the compiler into assembler language.
8540 @end defmac
8541
8542 @defmac ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
8543 If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a name
8544 and a register number. This macro defines additional names for hard
8545 registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in declarations to refer
8546 to registers using alternate names.
8547 @end defmac
8548
8549 @defmac OVERLAPPING_REGISTER_NAMES
8550 If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a
8551 name, a register number and a count of the number of consecutive
8552 machine registers the name overlaps. This macro defines additional
8553 names for hard registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in
8554 declarations to refer to registers using alternate names. Unlike
8555 @code{ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES}, this macro should be used when the
8556 register name implies multiple underlying registers.
8557
8558 This macro should be used when it is important that a clobber in an
8559 @code{asm} statement clobbers all the underlying values implied by the
8560 register name. For example, on ARM, clobbering the double-precision
8561 VFP register ``d0'' implies clobbering both single-precision registers
8562 ``s0'' and ``s1''.
8563 @end defmac
8564
8565 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE (@var{stream}, @var{ptr})
8566 Define this macro if you are using an unusual assembler that
8567 requires different names for the machine instructions.
8568
8569 The definition is a C statement or statements which output an
8570 assembler instruction opcode to the stdio stream @var{stream}. The
8571 macro-operand @var{ptr} is a variable of type @code{char *} which
8572 points to the opcode name in its ``internal'' form---the form that is
8573 written in the machine description. The definition should output the
8574 opcode name to @var{stream}, performing any translation you desire, and
8575 increment the variable @var{ptr} to point at the end of the opcode
8576 so that it will not be output twice.
8577
8578 In fact, your macro definition may process less than the entire opcode
8579 name, or more than the opcode name; but if you want to process text
8580 that includes @samp{%}-sequences to substitute operands, you must take
8581 care of the substitution yourself. Just be sure to increment
8582 @var{ptr} over whatever text should not be output normally.
8583
8584 @findex recog_data.operand
8585 If you need to look at the operand values, they can be found as the
8586 elements of @code{recog_data.operand}.
8587
8588 If the macro definition does nothing, the instruction is output
8589 in the usual way.
8590 @end defmac
8591
8592 @defmac FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN (@var{insn}, @var{opvec}, @var{noperands})
8593 If defined, a C statement to be executed just prior to the output of
8594 assembler code for @var{insn}, to modify the extracted operands so
8595 they will be output differently.
8596
8597 Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8598 extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8599 elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8600 The contents of this vector are what will be used to convert the insn
8601 template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler output
8602 by changing the contents of the vector.
8603
8604 This macro is useful when various assembler syntaxes share a single
8605 file of instruction patterns; by defining this macro differently, you
8606 can cause a large class of instructions to be output differently (such
8607 as with rearranged operands). Naturally, variations in assembler
8608 syntax affecting individual insn patterns ought to be handled by
8609 writing conditional output routines in those patterns.
8610
8611 If this macro is not defined, it is equivalent to a null statement.
8612 @end defmac
8613
8614 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FINAL_POSTSCAN_INSN (FILE *@var{file}, rtx @var{insn}, rtx *@var{opvec}, int @var{noperands})
8615 If defined, this target hook is a function which is executed just after the
8616 output of assembler code for @var{insn}, to change the mode of the assembler
8617 if necessary.
8618
8619 Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8620 extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8621 elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8622 The contents of this vector are what was used to convert the insn
8623 template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler mode
8624 by checking the contents of the vector.
8625 @end deftypefn
8626
8627 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{code})
8628 A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8629 assembler syntax for an instruction operand @var{x}. @var{x} is an
8630 RTL expression.
8631
8632 @var{code} is a value that can be used to specify one of several ways
8633 of printing the operand. It is used when identical operands must be
8634 printed differently depending on the context. @var{code} comes from
8635 the @samp{%} specification that was used to request printing of the
8636 operand. If the specification was just @samp{%@var{digit}} then
8637 @var{code} is 0; if the specification was @samp{%@var{ltr}
8638 @var{digit}} then @var{code} is the ASCII code for @var{ltr}.
8639
8640 @findex reg_names
8641 If @var{x} is a register, this macro should print the register's name.
8642 The names can be found in an array @code{reg_names} whose type is
8643 @code{char *[]}. @code{reg_names} is initialized from
8644 @code{REGISTER_NAMES}.
8645
8646 When the machine description has a specification @samp{%@var{punct}}
8647 (a @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character), this macro is called
8648 with a null pointer for @var{x} and the punctuation character for
8649 @var{code}.
8650 @end defmac
8651
8652 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (@var{code})
8653 A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{code} is a valid
8654 punctuation character for use in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro. If
8655 @code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} is not defined, it means that no
8656 punctuation characters (except for the standard one, @samp{%}) are used
8657 in this way.
8658 @end defmac
8659
8660 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS (@var{stream}, @var{x})
8661 A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8662 assembler syntax for an instruction operand that is a memory reference
8663 whose address is @var{x}. @var{x} is an RTL expression.
8664
8665 @cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} usage
8666 On some machines, the syntax for a symbolic address depends on the
8667 section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the hook
8668 @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
8669 @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. @xref{Assembler
8670 Format}.
8671 @end defmac
8672
8673 @findex dbr_sequence_length
8674 @defmac DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND (@var{file})
8675 A C statement, to be executed after all slot-filler instructions have
8676 been output. If necessary, call @code{dbr_sequence_length} to
8677 determine the number of slots filled in a sequence (zero if not
8678 currently outputting a sequence), to decide how many no-ops to output,
8679 or whatever.
8680
8681 Don't define this macro if it has nothing to do, but it is helpful in
8682 reading assembly output if the extent of the delay sequence is made
8683 explicit (e.g.@: with white space).
8684 @end defmac
8685
8686 @findex final_sequence
8687 Note that output routines for instructions with delay slots must be
8688 prepared to deal with not being output as part of a sequence
8689 (i.e.@: when the scheduling pass is not run, or when no slot fillers could be
8690 found.) The variable @code{final_sequence} is null when not
8691 processing a sequence, otherwise it contains the @code{sequence} rtx
8692 being output.
8693
8694 @findex asm_fprintf
8695 @defmac REGISTER_PREFIX
8696 @defmacx LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
8697 @defmacx USER_LABEL_PREFIX
8698 @defmacx IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
8699 If defined, C string expressions to be used for the @samp{%R}, @samp{%L},
8700 @samp{%U}, and @samp{%I} options of @code{asm_fprintf} (see
8701 @file{final.c}). These are useful when a single @file{md} file must
8702 support multiple assembler formats. In that case, the various @file{tm.h}
8703 files can define these macros differently.
8704 @end defmac
8705
8706 @defmac ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS (@var{file}, @var{argptr}, @var{format})
8707 If defined this macro should expand to a series of @code{case}
8708 statements which will be parsed inside the @code{switch} statement of
8709 the @code{asm_fprintf} function. This allows targets to define extra
8710 printf formats which may useful when generating their assembler
8711 statements. Note that uppercase letters are reserved for future
8712 generic extensions to asm_fprintf, and so are not available to target
8713 specific code. The output file is given by the parameter @var{file}.
8714 The varargs input pointer is @var{argptr} and the rest of the format
8715 string, starting the character after the one that is being switched
8716 upon, is pointed to by @var{format}.
8717 @end defmac
8718
8719 @defmac ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
8720 If your target supports multiple dialects of assembler language (such as
8721 different opcodes), define this macro as a C expression that gives the
8722 numeric index of the assembler language dialect to use, with zero as the
8723 first variant.
8724
8725 If this macro is defined, you may use constructs of the form
8726 @smallexample
8727 @samp{@{option0|option1|option2@dots{}@}}
8728 @end smallexample
8729 @noindent
8730 in the output templates of patterns (@pxref{Output Template}) or in the
8731 first argument of @code{asm_fprintf}. This construct outputs
8732 @samp{option0}, @samp{option1}, @samp{option2}, etc., if the value of
8733 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is zero, one, two, etc. Any special characters
8734 within these strings retain their usual meaning. If there are fewer
8735 alternatives within the braces than the value of
8736 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT}, the construct outputs nothing.
8737
8738 If you do not define this macro, the characters @samp{@{}, @samp{|} and
8739 @samp{@}} do not have any special meaning when used in templates or
8740 operands to @code{asm_fprintf}.
8741
8742 Define the macros @code{REGISTER_PREFIX}, @code{LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX},
8743 @code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX} and @code{IMMEDIATE_PREFIX} if you can express
8744 the variations in assembler language syntax with that mechanism. Define
8745 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} and use the @samp{@{option0|option1@}} syntax
8746 if the syntax variant are larger and involve such things as different
8747 opcodes or operand order.
8748 @end defmac
8749
8750 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8751 A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8752 which will push hard register number @var{regno} onto the stack.
8753 The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8754 profiling.
8755 @end defmac
8756
8757 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8758 A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8759 which will pop hard register number @var{regno} off of the stack.
8760 The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8761 profiling.
8762 @end defmac
8763
8764 @node Dispatch Tables
8765 @subsection Output of Dispatch Tables
8766
8767 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8768 This concerns dispatch tables.
8769
8770 @cindex dispatch table
8771 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{body}, @var{value}, @var{rel})
8772 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8773 pseudo-instruction to generate a difference between two labels.
8774 @var{value} and @var{rel} are the numbers of two internal labels. The
8775 definitions of these labels are output using
8776 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}, and they must be printed in the same
8777 way here. For example,
8778
8779 @smallexample
8780 fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d-L%d\n",
8781 @var{value}, @var{rel})
8782 @end smallexample
8783
8784 You must provide this macro on machines where the addresses in a
8785 dispatch table are relative to the table's own address. If defined, GCC
8786 will also use this macro on all machines when producing PIC@.
8787 @var{body} is the body of the @code{ADDR_DIFF_VEC}; it is provided so that the
8788 mode and flags can be read.
8789 @end defmac
8790
8791 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
8792 This macro should be provided on machines where the addresses
8793 in a dispatch table are absolute.
8794
8795 The definition should be a C statement to output to the stdio stream
8796 @var{stream} an assembler pseudo-instruction to generate a reference to
8797 a label. @var{value} is the number of an internal label whose
8798 definition is output using @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8799 For example,
8800
8801 @smallexample
8802 fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d\n", @var{value})
8803 @end smallexample
8804 @end defmac
8805
8806 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8807 Define this if the label before a jump-table needs to be output
8808 specially. The first three arguments are the same as for
8809 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}; the fourth argument is the
8810 jump-table which follows (a @code{jump_insn} containing an
8811 @code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec}).
8812
8813 This feature is used on system V to output a @code{swbeg} statement
8814 for the table.
8815
8816 If this macro is not defined, these labels are output with
8817 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8818 @end defmac
8819
8820 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END (@var{stream}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8821 Define this if something special must be output at the end of a
8822 jump-table. The definition should be a C statement to be executed
8823 after the assembler code for the table is written. It should write
8824 the appropriate code to stdio stream @var{stream}. The argument
8825 @var{table} is the jump-table insn, and @var{num} is the label-number
8826 of the preceding label.
8827
8828 If this macro is not defined, nothing special is output at the end of
8829 the jump-table.
8830 @end defmac
8831
8832 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_UNWIND_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, tree @var{decl}, int @var{for_eh}, int @var{empty})
8833 This target hook emits a label at the beginning of each FDE@. It
8834 should be defined on targets where FDEs need special labels, and it
8835 should write the appropriate label, for the FDE associated with the
8836 function declaration @var{decl}, to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
8837 The third argument, @var{for_eh}, is a boolean: true if this is for an
8838 exception table. The fourth argument, @var{empty}, is a boolean:
8839 true if this is a placeholder label for an omitted FDE@.
8840
8841 The default is that FDEs are not given nonlocal labels.
8842 @end deftypefn
8843
8844 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_TABLE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream})
8845 This target hook emits a label at the beginning of the exception table.
8846 It should be defined on targets where it is desirable for the table
8847 to be broken up according to function.
8848
8849 The default is that no label is emitted.
8850 @end deftypefn
8851
8852 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_PERSONALITY (rtx @var{personality})
8853 If the target implements @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT}, this hook may be used to emit a directive to install a personality hook into the unwind info. This hook should not be used if dwarf2 unwind info is used.
8854 @end deftypefn
8855
8856 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT (FILE *@var{stream}, rtx @var{insn})
8857 This target hook emits assembly directives required to unwind the
8858 given instruction. This is only used when @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
8859 returns @code{UI_TARGET}.
8860 @end deftypefn
8861
8862 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT_BEFORE_INSN
8863 True if the @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT} hook should be called before the assembly for @var{insn} has been emitted, false if the hook should be called afterward.
8864 @end deftypevr
8865
8866 @node Exception Region Output
8867 @subsection Assembler Commands for Exception Regions
8868
8869 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8870
8871 This describes commands marking the start and the end of an exception
8872 region.
8873
8874 @defmac EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
8875 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing
8876 exception handling frame unwind information. If not defined, GCC will
8877 provide a default definition if the target supports named sections.
8878 @file{crtstuff.c} uses this macro to switch to the appropriate section.
8879
8880 You should define this symbol if your target supports DWARF 2 frame
8881 unwind information and the default definition does not work.
8882 @end defmac
8883
8884 @defmac EH_FRAME_IN_DATA_SECTION
8885 If defined, DWARF 2 frame unwind information will be placed in the
8886 data section even though the target supports named sections. This
8887 might be necessary, for instance, if the system linker does garbage
8888 collection and sections cannot be marked as not to be collected.
8889
8890 Do not define this macro unless @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is
8891 also defined.
8892 @end defmac
8893
8894 @defmac EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY
8895 Define this macro to 1 if your target is such that no frame unwind
8896 information encoding used with non-PIC code will ever require a
8897 runtime relocation, but the linker may not support merging read-only
8898 and read-write sections into a single read-write section.
8899 @end defmac
8900
8901 @defmac MASK_RETURN_ADDR
8902 An rtx used to mask the return address found via @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX}, so
8903 that it does not contain any extraneous set bits in it.
8904 @end defmac
8905
8906 @defmac DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
8907 Define this macro to 0 if your target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8908 information, but it does not yet work with exception handling.
8909 Otherwise, if your target supports this information (if it defines
8910 @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and @code{OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF}),
8911 GCC will provide a default definition of 1.
8912 @end defmac
8913
8914 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} {enum unwind_info_type} TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO (struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
8915 This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for exception handling
8916 by the target. If the target has ABI specified unwind tables, the hook
8917 should return @code{UI_TARGET}. If the target is to use the
8918 @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling scheme, the hook
8919 should return @code{UI_SJLJ}. If the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8920 information, the hook should return @code{UI_DWARF2}.
8921
8922 A target may, if exceptions are disabled, choose to return @code{UI_NONE}.
8923 This may end up simplifying other parts of target-specific code. The
8924 default implementation of this hook never returns @code{UI_NONE}.
8925
8926 Note that the value returned by this hook should be constant. It should
8927 not depend on anything except the command-line switches described by
8928 @var{opts}. In particular, the
8929 setting @code{UI_SJLJ} must be fixed at compiler start-up as C pre-processor
8930 macros and builtin functions related to exception handling are set up
8931 depending on this setting.
8932
8933 The default implementation of the hook first honors the
8934 @option{--enable-sjlj-exceptions} configure option, then
8935 @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO}, and finally defaults to @code{UI_SJLJ}. If
8936 @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO} depends on command-line options, the target
8937 must define this hook so that @var{opts} is used correctly.
8938 @end deftypefn
8939
8940 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_UNWIND_TABLES_DEFAULT
8941 This variable should be set to @code{true} if the target ABI requires unwinding
8942 tables even when exceptions are not used. It must not be modified by
8943 command-line option processing.
8944 @end deftypevr
8945
8946 @defmac DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP
8947 Define this macro to 1 if the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based scheme
8948 should use the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp} functions from the C library
8949 instead of the @code{__builtin_setjmp}/@code{__builtin_longjmp} machinery.
8950 @end defmac
8951
8952 @defmac JMP_BUF_SIZE
8953 This macro has no effect unless @code{DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP} is also
8954 defined. Define this macro if the default size of @code{jmp_buf} buffer
8955 for the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism
8956 is not large enough, or if it is much too large.
8957 The default size is @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER * sizeof(void *)}.
8958 @end defmac
8959
8960 @defmac DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
8961 This macro need only be defined if the target might save registers in the
8962 function prologue at an offset to the stack pointer that is not aligned to
8963 @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. The definition should be the negative minimum
8964 alignment if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and the positive
8965 minimum alignment otherwise. @xref{SDB and DWARF}. Only applicable if
8966 the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind information.
8967 @end defmac
8968
8969 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_TERMINATE_DW2_EH_FRAME_INFO
8970 Contains the value true if the target should add a zero word onto the
8971 end of a Dwarf-2 frame info section when used for exception handling.
8972 Default value is false if @code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, and
8973 true otherwise.
8974 @end deftypevr
8975
8976 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DWARF_REGISTER_SPAN (rtx @var{reg})
8977 Given a register, this hook should return a parallel of registers to
8978 represent where to find the register pieces. Define this hook if the
8979 register and its mode are represented in Dwarf in non-contiguous
8980 locations, or if the register should be represented in more than one
8981 register in Dwarf. Otherwise, this hook should return @code{NULL_RTX}.
8982 If not defined, the default is to return @code{NULL_RTX}.
8983 @end deftypefn
8984
8985 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_DWARF_REG_SIZES_EXTRA (tree @var{address})
8986 If some registers are represented in Dwarf-2 unwind information in
8987 multiple pieces, define this hook to fill in information about the
8988 sizes of those pieces in the table used by the unwinder at runtime.
8989 It will be called by @code{expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes} after
8990 filling in a single size corresponding to each hard register;
8991 @var{address} is the address of the table.
8992 @end deftypefn
8993
8994 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_TTYPE (rtx @var{sym})
8995 This hook is used to output a reference from a frame unwinding table to
8996 the type_info object identified by @var{sym}. It should return @code{true}
8997 if the reference was output. Returning @code{false} will cause the
8998 reference to be output using the normal Dwarf2 routines.
8999 @end deftypefn
9000
9001 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ARM_EABI_UNWINDER
9002 This flag should be set to @code{true} on targets that use an ARM EABI
9003 based unwinding library, and @code{false} on other targets. This effects
9004 the format of unwinding tables, and how the unwinder in entered after
9005 running a cleanup. The default is @code{false}.
9006 @end deftypevr
9007
9008 @node Alignment Output
9009 @subsection Assembler Commands for Alignment
9010
9011 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9012 This describes commands for alignment.
9013
9014 @defmac JUMP_ALIGN (@var{label})
9015 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which is
9016 a common destination of jumps and has no fallthru incoming edge.
9017
9018 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9019 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9020 define the macro.
9021
9022 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9023 to set the variable @var{align_jumps} in the target's
9024 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
9025 selection in @var{align_jumps} in a @code{JUMP_ALIGN} implementation.
9026 @end defmac
9027
9028 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_JUMP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx @var{label})
9029 The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
9030 @code{JUMP_ALIGN}. This works only if
9031 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
9032 @end deftypefn
9033
9034 @defmac LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER (@var{label})
9035 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
9036 a @code{BARRIER}.
9037
9038 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9039 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9040 define the macro.
9041 @end defmac
9042
9043 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP (rtx @var{label})
9044 The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
9045 @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER}. This works only if
9046 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
9047 @end deftypefn
9048
9049 @defmac LOOP_ALIGN (@var{label})
9050 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
9051 a @code{NOTE_INSN_LOOP_BEG} note.
9052
9053 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9054 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9055 define the macro.
9056
9057 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9058 to set the variable @code{align_loops} in the target's
9059 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
9060 selection in @code{align_loops} in a @code{LOOP_ALIGN} implementation.
9061 @end defmac
9062
9063 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx @var{label})
9064 The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LOOP_ALIGN} to
9065 @var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is
9066 defined.
9067 @end deftypefn
9068
9069 @defmac LABEL_ALIGN (@var{label})
9070 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}.
9071 If @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER} / @code{LOOP_ALIGN} specify a different alignment,
9072 the maximum of the specified values is used.
9073
9074 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9075 to set the variable @code{align_labels} in the target's
9076 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
9077 selection in @code{align_labels} in a @code{LABEL_ALIGN} implementation.
9078 @end defmac
9079
9080 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx @var{label})
9081 The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LABEL_ALIGN}
9082 to @var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN}
9083 is defined.
9084 @end deftypefn
9085
9086 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (@var{stream}, @var{nbytes})
9087 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9088 instruction to advance the location counter by @var{nbytes} bytes.
9089 Those bytes should be zero when loaded. @var{nbytes} will be a C
9090 expression of type @code{unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT}.
9091 @end defmac
9092
9093 @defmac ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
9094 Define this macro if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} should not be used in the
9095 text section because it fails to put zeros in the bytes that are skipped.
9096 This is true on many Unix systems, where the pseudo--op to skip bytes
9097 produces no-op instructions rather than zeros when used in the text
9098 section.
9099 @end defmac
9100
9101 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power})
9102 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9103 command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9104 @var{power} bytes. @var{power} will be a C expression of type @code{int}.
9105 @end defmac
9106
9107 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN_WITH_NOP (@var{stream}, @var{power})
9108 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}, except that the ``nop'' instruction is used
9109 for padding, if necessary.
9110 @end defmac
9111
9112 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power}, @var{max_skip})
9113 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9114 command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9115 @var{power} bytes, but only if @var{max_skip} or fewer bytes are needed to
9116 satisfy the alignment request. @var{power} and @var{max_skip} will be
9117 a C expression of type @code{int}.
9118 @end defmac
9119
9120 @need 3000
9121 @node Debugging Info
9122 @section Controlling Debugging Information Format
9123
9124 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9125 This describes how to specify debugging information.
9126
9127 @menu
9128 * All Debuggers:: Macros that affect all debugging formats uniformly.
9129 * DBX Options:: Macros enabling specific options in DBX format.
9130 * DBX Hooks:: Hook macros for varying DBX format.
9131 * File Names and DBX:: Macros controlling output of file names in DBX format.
9132 * SDB and DWARF:: Macros for SDB (COFF) and DWARF formats.
9133 * VMS Debug:: Macros for VMS debug format.
9134 @end menu
9135
9136 @node All Debuggers
9137 @subsection Macros Affecting All Debugging Formats
9138
9139 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9140 These macros affect all debugging formats.
9141
9142 @defmac DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})
9143 A C expression that returns the DBX register number for the compiler
9144 register number @var{regno}. In the default macro provided, the value
9145 of this expression will be @var{regno} itself. But sometimes there are
9146 some registers that the compiler knows about and DBX does not, or vice
9147 versa. In such cases, some register may need to have one number in the
9148 compiler and another for DBX@.
9149
9150 If two registers have consecutive numbers inside GCC, and they can be
9151 used as a pair to hold a multiword value, then they @emph{must} have
9152 consecutive numbers after renumbering with @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER}.
9153 Otherwise, debuggers will be unable to access such a pair, because they
9154 expect register pairs to be consecutive in their own numbering scheme.
9155
9156 If you find yourself defining @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER} in way that
9157 does not preserve register pairs, then what you must do instead is
9158 redefine the actual register numbering scheme.
9159 @end defmac
9160
9161 @defmac DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET (@var{x})
9162 A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an automatic
9163 variable having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The default
9164 computation assumes that @var{x} is based on the frame-pointer and
9165 gives the offset from the frame-pointer. This is required for targets
9166 that produce debugging output for DBX or COFF-style debugging output
9167 for SDB and allow the frame-pointer to be eliminated when the
9168 @option{-g} options is used.
9169 @end defmac
9170
9171 @defmac DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET (@var{offset}, @var{x})
9172 A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an argument
9173 having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The nominal offset is
9174 @var{offset}.
9175 @end defmac
9176
9177 @defmac PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
9178 A C expression that returns the type of debugging output GCC should
9179 produce when the user specifies just @option{-g}. Define
9180 this if you have arranged for GCC to support more than one format of
9181 debugging output. Currently, the allowable values are @code{DBX_DEBUG},
9182 @code{SDB_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF2_DEBUG},
9183 @code{XCOFF_DEBUG}, @code{VMS_DEBUG}, and @code{VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG}.
9184
9185 When the user specifies @option{-ggdb}, GCC normally also uses the
9186 value of this macro to select the debugging output format, but with two
9187 exceptions. If @code{DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO} is defined, GCC uses the
9188 value @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}. Otherwise, if @code{DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO} is
9189 defined, GCC uses @code{DBX_DEBUG}.
9190
9191 The value of this macro only affects the default debugging output; the
9192 user can always get a specific type of output by using @option{-gstabs},
9193 @option{-gcoff}, @option{-gdwarf-2}, @option{-gxcoff}, or @option{-gvms}.
9194 @end defmac
9195
9196 @node DBX Options
9197 @subsection Specific Options for DBX Output
9198
9199 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9200 These are specific options for DBX output.
9201
9202 @defmac DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
9203 Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for DBX
9204 in response to the @option{-g} option.
9205 @end defmac
9206
9207 @defmac XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
9208 Define this macro if GCC should produce XCOFF format debugging output
9209 in response to the @option{-g} option. This is a variant of DBX format.
9210 @end defmac
9211
9212 @defmac DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
9213 Define this macro to control whether GCC should by default generate
9214 GDB's extended version of DBX debugging information (assuming DBX-format
9215 debugging information is enabled at all). If you don't define the
9216 macro, the default is 1: always generate the extended information
9217 if there is any occasion to.
9218 @end defmac
9219
9220 @defmac DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
9221 Define this macro if all @code{.stabs} commands should be output while
9222 in the text section.
9223 @end defmac
9224
9225 @defmac ASM_STABS_OP
9226 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9227 use instead of @code{"\t.stabs\t"} to define an ordinary debugging symbol.
9228 If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabs\t"} is used. This macro
9229 applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9230 @end defmac
9231
9232 @defmac ASM_STABD_OP
9233 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9234 use instead of @code{"\t.stabd\t"} to define a debugging symbol whose
9235 value is the current location. If you don't define this macro,
9236 @code{"\t.stabd\t"} is used. This macro applies only to DBX debugging
9237 information format.
9238 @end defmac
9239
9240 @defmac ASM_STABN_OP
9241 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9242 use instead of @code{"\t.stabn\t"} to define a debugging symbol with no
9243 name. If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabn\t"} is used. This
9244 macro applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9245 @end defmac
9246
9247 @defmac DBX_NO_XREFS
9248 Define this macro if DBX on your system does not support the construct
9249 @samp{xs@var{tagname}}. On some systems, this construct is used to
9250 describe a forward reference to a structure named @var{tagname}.
9251 On other systems, this construct is not supported at all.
9252 @end defmac
9253
9254 @defmac DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
9255 A symbol name in DBX-format debugging information is normally
9256 continued (split into two separate @code{.stabs} directives) when it
9257 exceeds a certain length (by default, 80 characters). On some
9258 operating systems, DBX requires this splitting; on others, splitting
9259 must not be done. You can inhibit splitting by defining this macro
9260 with the value zero. You can override the default splitting-length by
9261 defining this macro as an expression for the length you desire.
9262 @end defmac
9263
9264 @defmac DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
9265 Normally continuation is indicated by adding a @samp{\} character to
9266 the end of a @code{.stabs} string when a continuation follows. To use
9267 a different character instead, define this macro as a character
9268 constant for the character you want to use. Do not define this macro
9269 if backslash is correct for your system.
9270 @end defmac
9271
9272 @defmac DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
9273 Define this macro if it is necessary to go to the data section before
9274 outputting the @samp{.stabs} pseudo-op for a non-global static
9275 variable.
9276 @end defmac
9277
9278 @defmac DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
9279 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9280 for a typedef. The default is @code{N_LSYM}.
9281 @end defmac
9282
9283 @defmac DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
9284 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9285 for a static variable located in the text section. DBX format does not
9286 provide any ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_FUN}.
9287 @end defmac
9288
9289 @defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
9290 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9291 for a parameter passed in registers. DBX format does not provide any
9292 ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_RSYM}.
9293 @end defmac
9294
9295 @defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
9296 The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a parameter
9297 passed in registers. DBX format does not customarily provide any way to
9298 do this. The default is @code{'P'}.
9299 @end defmac
9300
9301 @defmac DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
9302 Define this macro if the DBX information for a function and its
9303 arguments should precede the assembler code for the function. Normally,
9304 in DBX format, the debugging information entirely follows the assembler
9305 code.
9306 @end defmac
9307
9308 @defmac DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9309 Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol describing
9310 the scope of a block (@code{N_LBRAC} or @code{N_RBRAC}) should be
9311 relative to the start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses
9312 an absolute address.
9313 @end defmac
9314
9315 @defmac DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9316 Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol indicating
9317 the current line number (@code{N_SLINE}) should be relative to the
9318 start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses an absolute address.
9319 @end defmac
9320
9321 @defmac DBX_USE_BINCL
9322 Define this macro if GCC should generate @code{N_BINCL} and
9323 @code{N_EINCL} stabs for included header files, as on Sun systems. This
9324 macro also directs GCC to output a type number as a pair of a file
9325 number and a type number within the file. Normally, GCC does not
9326 generate @code{N_BINCL} or @code{N_EINCL} stabs, and it outputs a single
9327 number for a type number.
9328 @end defmac
9329
9330 @node DBX Hooks
9331 @subsection Open-Ended Hooks for DBX Format
9332
9333 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9334 These are hooks for DBX format.
9335
9336 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line}, @var{counter})
9337 A C statement to output DBX debugging information before code for line
9338 number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9339 @var{stream}. @var{counter} is the number of time the macro was
9340 invoked, including the current invocation; it is intended to generate
9341 unique labels in the assembly output.
9342
9343 This macro should not be defined if the default output is correct, or
9344 if it can be made correct by defining @code{DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE}.
9345 @end defmac
9346
9347 @defmac NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
9348 Some stabs encapsulation formats (in particular ECOFF), cannot handle the
9349 @code{.stabs "",N_FUN,,0,0,Lscope-function-1} gdb dbx extension construct.
9350 On those machines, define this macro to turn this feature off without
9351 disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9352 @end defmac
9353
9354 @defmac NO_DBX_BNSYM_ENSYM
9355 Some assemblers cannot handle the @code{.stabd BNSYM/ENSYM,0,0} gdb dbx
9356 extension construct. On those machines, define this macro to turn this
9357 feature off without disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9358 @end defmac
9359
9360 @node File Names and DBX
9361 @subsection File Names in DBX Format
9362
9363 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9364 This describes file names in DBX format.
9365
9366 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9367 A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
9368 @var{stream}, which indicates that file @var{name} is the main source
9369 file---the file specified as the input file for compilation.
9370 This macro is called only once, at the beginning of compilation.
9371
9372 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
9373 for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
9374
9375 It may be necessary to refer to a label equal to the beginning of the
9376 text section. You can use @samp{assemble_name (stream, ltext_label_name)}
9377 to do so. If you do this, you must also set the variable
9378 @var{used_ltext_label_name} to @code{true}.
9379 @end defmac
9380
9381 @defmac NO_DBX_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY
9382 Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9383 of the current directory for compilation and current source language at
9384 the beginning of the file.
9385 @end defmac
9386
9387 @defmac NO_DBX_GCC_MARKER
9388 Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9389 that this object file was compiled by GCC@. The default is to emit
9390 an @code{N_OPT} stab at the beginning of every source file, with
9391 @samp{gcc2_compiled.} for the string and value 0.
9392 @end defmac
9393
9394 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9395 A C statement to output DBX debugging information at the end of
9396 compilation of the main source file @var{name}. Output should be
9397 written to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
9398
9399 If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output at the end
9400 of compilation, which is correct for most machines.
9401 @end defmac
9402
9403 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NULL_N_SO_AT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END
9404 Define this macro @emph{instead of} defining
9405 @code{DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END}, if what needs to be output at
9406 the end of compilation is an @code{N_SO} stab with an empty string,
9407 whose value is the highest absolute text address in the file.
9408 @end defmac
9409
9410 @need 2000
9411 @node SDB and DWARF
9412 @subsection Macros for SDB and DWARF Output
9413
9414 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9415 Here are macros for SDB and DWARF output.
9416
9417 @defmac SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
9418 Define this macro if GCC should produce COFF-style debugging output
9419 for SDB in response to the @option{-g} option.
9420 @end defmac
9421
9422 @defmac DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
9423 Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf version 2 format
9424 debugging output in response to the @option{-g} option.
9425
9426 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_DWARF_CALLING_CONVENTION (const_tree @var{function})
9427 Define this to enable the dwarf attribute @code{DW_AT_calling_convention} to
9428 be emitted for each function. Instead of an integer return the enum
9429 value for the @code{DW_CC_} tag.
9430 @end deftypefn
9431
9432 To support optional call frame debugging information, you must also
9433 define @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either set
9434 @code{RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P} on the prologue insns if you use RTL for the
9435 prologue, or call @code{dwarf2out_def_cfa} and @code{dwarf2out_reg_save}
9436 as appropriate from @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} if you don't.
9437 @end defmac
9438
9439 @defmac DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
9440 Define this macro to a nonzero value if GCC should always output
9441 Dwarf 2 frame information. If @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
9442 (@pxref{Exception Region Output}) returns @code{UI_DWARF2}, and
9443 exceptions are enabled, GCC will output this information not matter
9444 how you define @code{DWARF2_FRAME_INFO}.
9445 @end defmac
9446
9447 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum unwind_info_type} TARGET_DEBUG_UNWIND_INFO (void)
9448 This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for describing frame
9449 unwind information to the debugger. Normally the hook will return
9450 @code{UI_DWARF2} if DWARF 2 debug information is enabled, and
9451 return @code{UI_NONE} otherwise.
9452
9453 A target may return @code{UI_DWARF2} even when DWARF 2 debug information
9454 is disabled in order to always output DWARF 2 frame information.
9455
9456 A target may return @code{UI_TARGET} if it has ABI specified unwind tables.
9457 This will suppress generation of the normal debug frame unwind information.
9458 @end deftypefn
9459
9460 @defmac DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
9461 Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler can generate Dwarf 2
9462 line debug info sections. This will result in much more compact line number
9463 tables, and hence is desirable if it works.
9464 @end defmac
9465
9466 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_WANT_DEBUG_PUB_SECTIONS
9467 True if the @code{.debug_pubtypes} and @code{.debug_pubnames} sections should be emitted. These sections are not used on most platforms, and in particular GDB does not use them.
9468 @end deftypevr
9469
9470 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FORCE_AT_COMP_DIR
9471 True if the @code{DW_AT_comp_dir} attribute should be emitted for each compilation unit. This attribute is required for the darwin linker to emit debug information.
9472 @end deftypevr
9473
9474 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DELAY_SCHED2
9475 True if sched2 is not to be run at its normal place. This usually means it will be run as part of machine-specific reorg.
9476 @end deftypevr
9477
9478 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DELAY_VARTRACK
9479 True if vartrack is not to be run at its normal place. This usually means it will be run as part of machine-specific reorg.
9480 @end deftypevr
9481
9482 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9483 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9484 @var{lab1} minus @var{lab2}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9485 @end defmac
9486
9487 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_VMS_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9488 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9489 between the two given labels in system defined units, e.g. instruction
9490 slots on IA64 VMS, using an integer of the given size.
9491 @end defmac
9492
9493 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_OFFSET (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label}, @var{section})
9494 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a
9495 section-relative reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the
9496 given @var{size}. The label is known to be defined in the given @var{section}.
9497 @end defmac
9498
9499 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_PCREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
9500 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a self-relative
9501 reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9502 @end defmac
9503
9504 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (@var{label})
9505 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to
9506 the DWARF table identifier @var{label} from the current section. This
9507 is used on some systems to avoid garbage collecting a DWARF table which
9508 is referenced by a function.
9509 @end defmac
9510
9511 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{size}, rtx @var{x})
9512 If defined, this target hook is a function which outputs a DTP-relative
9513 reference to the given TLS symbol of the specified size.
9514 @end deftypefn
9515
9516 @defmac PUT_SDB_@dots{}
9517 Define these macros to override the assembler syntax for the special
9518 SDB assembler directives. See @file{sdbout.c} for a list of these
9519 macros and their arguments. If the standard syntax is used, you need
9520 not define them yourself.
9521 @end defmac
9522
9523 @defmac SDB_DELIM
9524 Some assemblers do not support a semicolon as a delimiter, even between
9525 SDB assembler directives. In that case, define this macro to be the
9526 delimiter to use (usually @samp{\n}). It is not necessary to define
9527 a new set of @code{PUT_SDB_@var{op}} macros if this is the only change
9528 required.
9529 @end defmac
9530
9531 @defmac SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
9532 Define this macro to allow references to unknown structure,
9533 union, or enumeration tags to be emitted. Standard COFF does not
9534 allow handling of unknown references, MIPS ECOFF has support for
9535 it.
9536 @end defmac
9537
9538 @defmac SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
9539 Define this macro to allow references to structure, union, or
9540 enumeration tags that have not yet been seen to be handled. Some
9541 assemblers choke if forward tags are used, while some require it.
9542 @end defmac
9543
9544 @defmac SDB_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line})
9545 A C statement to output SDB debugging information before code for line
9546 number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9547 @var{stream}. The default is to emit an @code{.ln} directive.
9548 @end defmac
9549
9550 @need 2000
9551 @node VMS Debug
9552 @subsection Macros for VMS Debug Format
9553
9554 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9555 Here are macros for VMS debug format.
9556
9557 @defmac VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9558 Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for VMS
9559 in response to the @option{-g} option. The default behavior for VMS
9560 is to generate minimal debug info for a traceback in the absence of
9561 @option{-g} unless explicitly overridden with @option{-g0}. This
9562 behavior is controlled by @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} and
9563 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}.
9564 @end defmac
9565
9566 @node Floating Point
9567 @section Cross Compilation and Floating Point
9568 @cindex cross compilation and floating point
9569 @cindex floating point and cross compilation
9570
9571 While all modern machines use twos-complement representation for integers,
9572 there are a variety of representations for floating point numbers. This
9573 means that in a cross-compiler the representation of floating point numbers
9574 in the compiled program may be different from that used in the machine
9575 doing the compilation.
9576
9577 Because different representation systems may offer different amounts of
9578 range and precision, all floating point constants must be represented in
9579 the target machine's format. Therefore, the cross compiler cannot
9580 safely use the host machine's floating point arithmetic; it must emulate
9581 the target's arithmetic. To ensure consistency, GCC always uses
9582 emulation to work with floating point values, even when the host and
9583 target floating point formats are identical.
9584
9585 The following macros are provided by @file{real.h} for the compiler to
9586 use. All parts of the compiler which generate or optimize
9587 floating-point calculations must use these macros. They may evaluate
9588 their operands more than once, so operands must not have side effects.
9589
9590 @defmac REAL_VALUE_TYPE
9591 The C data type to be used to hold a floating point value in the target
9592 machine's format. Typically this is a @code{struct} containing an
9593 array of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, but all code should treat it as an opaque
9594 quantity.
9595 @end defmac
9596
9597 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9598 Compares for equality the two values, @var{x} and @var{y}. If the target
9599 floating point format supports negative zeroes and/or NaNs,
9600 @samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (-0.0, 0.0)} is true, and
9601 @samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (NaN, NaN)} is false.
9602 @end deftypefn
9603
9604 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_LESS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9605 Tests whether @var{x} is less than @var{y}.
9606 @end deftypefn
9607
9608 @deftypefn Macro HOST_WIDE_INT REAL_VALUE_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9609 Truncates @var{x} to a signed integer, rounding toward zero.
9610 @end deftypefn
9611
9612 @deftypefn Macro {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9613 Truncates @var{x} to an unsigned integer, rounding toward zero. If
9614 @var{x} is negative, returns zero.
9615 @end deftypefn
9616
9617 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ATOF (const char *@var{string}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9618 Converts @var{string} into a floating point number in the target machine's
9619 representation for mode @var{mode}. This routine can handle both
9620 decimal and hexadecimal floating point constants, using the syntax
9621 defined by the C language for both.
9622 @end deftypefn
9623
9624 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_NEGATIVE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9625 Returns 1 if @var{x} is negative (including negative zero), 0 otherwise.
9626 @end deftypefn
9627
9628 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISINF (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9629 Determines whether @var{x} represents infinity (positive or negative).
9630 @end deftypefn
9631
9632 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISNAN (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9633 Determines whether @var{x} represents a ``NaN'' (not-a-number).
9634 @end deftypefn
9635
9636 @deftypefn Macro void REAL_ARITHMETIC (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{output}, enum tree_code @var{code}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9637 Calculates an arithmetic operation on the two floating point values
9638 @var{x} and @var{y}, storing the result in @var{output} (which must be a
9639 variable).
9640
9641 The operation to be performed is specified by @var{code}. Only the
9642 following codes are supported: @code{PLUS_EXPR}, @code{MINUS_EXPR},
9643 @code{MULT_EXPR}, @code{RDIV_EXPR}, @code{MAX_EXPR}, @code{MIN_EXPR}.
9644
9645 If @code{REAL_ARITHMETIC} is asked to evaluate division by zero and the
9646 target's floating point format cannot represent infinity, it will call
9647 @code{abort}. Callers should check for this situation first, using
9648 @code{MODE_HAS_INFINITIES}. @xref{Storage Layout}.
9649 @end deftypefn
9650
9651 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9652 Returns the negative of the floating point value @var{x}.
9653 @end deftypefn
9654
9655 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ABS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9656 Returns the absolute value of @var{x}.
9657 @end deftypefn
9658
9659 @deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_TO_INT (HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9660 Converts a floating point value @var{x} into a double-precision integer
9661 which is then stored into @var{low} and @var{high}. If the value is not
9662 integral, it is truncated.
9663 @end deftypefn
9664
9665 @deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_FROM_INT (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9666 Converts a double-precision integer found in @var{low} and @var{high},
9667 into a floating point value which is then stored into @var{x}. The
9668 value is truncated to fit in mode @var{mode}.
9669 @end deftypefn
9670
9671 @node Mode Switching
9672 @section Mode Switching Instructions
9673 @cindex mode switching
9674 The following macros control mode switching optimizations:
9675
9676 @defmac OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING (@var{entity})
9677 Define this macro if the port needs extra instructions inserted for mode
9678 switching in an optimizing compilation.
9679
9680 For an example, the SH4 can perform both single and double precision
9681 floating point operations, but to perform a single precision operation,
9682 the FPSCR PR bit has to be cleared, while for a double precision
9683 operation, this bit has to be set. Changing the PR bit requires a general
9684 purpose register as a scratch register, hence these FPSCR sets have to
9685 be inserted before reload, i.e.@: you can't put this into instruction emitting
9686 or @code{TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG}.
9687
9688 You can have multiple entities that are mode-switched, and select at run time
9689 which entities actually need it. @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} should
9690 return nonzero for any @var{entity} that needs mode-switching.
9691 If you define this macro, you also have to define
9692 @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, @code{MODE_NEEDED},
9693 @code{MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE} and @code{EMIT_MODE_SET}.
9694 @code{MODE_AFTER}, @code{MODE_ENTRY}, and @code{MODE_EXIT}
9695 are optional.
9696 @end defmac
9697
9698 @defmac NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
9699 If you define @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING}, you have to define this as
9700 initializer for an array of integers. Each initializer element
9701 N refers to an entity that needs mode switching, and specifies the number
9702 of different modes that might need to be set for this entity.
9703 The position of the initializer in the initializer---starting counting at
9704 zero---determines the integer that is used to refer to the mode-switched
9705 entity in question.
9706 In macros that take mode arguments / yield a mode result, modes are
9707 represented as numbers 0 @dots{} N @minus{} 1. N is used to specify that no mode
9708 switch is needed / supplied.
9709 @end defmac
9710
9711 @defmac MODE_NEEDED (@var{entity}, @var{insn})
9712 @var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If
9713 @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} is defined, you must define this macro to
9714 return an integer value not larger than the corresponding element in
9715 @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, to denote the mode that @var{entity} must
9716 be switched into prior to the execution of @var{insn}.
9717 @end defmac
9718
9719 @defmac MODE_AFTER (@var{entity}, @var{mode}, @var{insn})
9720 @var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If
9721 this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{insn} during
9722 mode switching. It determines the mode that an insn results in (if
9723 different from the incoming mode).
9724 @end defmac
9725
9726 @defmac MODE_ENTRY (@var{entity})
9727 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
9728 mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9729 @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function entry. If @code{MODE_ENTRY}
9730 is defined then @code{MODE_EXIT} must be defined.
9731 @end defmac
9732
9733 @defmac MODE_EXIT (@var{entity})
9734 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
9735 mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9736 @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function exit. If @code{MODE_EXIT}
9737 is defined then @code{MODE_ENTRY} must be defined.
9738 @end defmac
9739
9740 @defmac MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE (@var{entity}, @var{n})
9741 This macro specifies the order in which modes for @var{entity} are processed.
9742 0 is the highest priority, @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING[@var{entity}] - 1} the
9743 lowest. The value of the macro should be an integer designating a mode
9744 for @var{entity}. For any fixed @var{entity}, @code{mode_priority_to_mode}
9745 (@var{entity}, @var{n}) shall be a bijection in 0 @dots{}
9746 @code{num_modes_for_mode_switching[@var{entity}] - 1}.
9747 @end defmac
9748
9749 @defmac EMIT_MODE_SET (@var{entity}, @var{mode}, @var{hard_regs_live})
9750 Generate one or more insns to set @var{entity} to @var{mode}.
9751 @var{hard_reg_live} is the set of hard registers live at the point where
9752 the insn(s) are to be inserted.
9753 @end defmac
9754
9755 @node Target Attributes
9756 @section Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}
9757 @cindex target attributes
9758 @cindex machine attributes
9759 @cindex attributes, target-specific
9760
9761 Target-specific attributes may be defined for functions, data and types.
9762 These are described using the following target hooks; they also need to
9763 be documented in @file{extend.texi}.
9764
9765 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const struct attribute_spec *} TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE
9766 If defined, this target hook points to an array of @samp{struct
9767 attribute_spec} (defined in @file{tree.h}) specifying the machine
9768 specific attributes for this target and some of the restrictions on the
9769 entities to which these attributes are applied and the arguments they
9770 take.
9771 @end deftypevr
9772
9773 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TAKES_IDENTIFIER_P (const_tree @var{name})
9774 If defined, this target hook is a function which returns true if the
9775 machine-specific attribute named @var{name} expects an identifier
9776 given as its first argument to be passed on as a plain identifier, not
9777 subjected to name lookup. If this is not defined, the default is
9778 false for all machine-specific attributes.
9779 @end deftypefn
9780
9781 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (const_tree @var{type1}, const_tree @var{type2})
9782 If defined, this target hook is a function which returns zero if the attributes on
9783 @var{type1} and @var{type2} are incompatible, one if they are compatible,
9784 and two if they are nearly compatible (which causes a warning to be
9785 generated). If this is not defined, machine-specific attributes are
9786 supposed always to be compatible.
9787 @end deftypefn
9788
9789 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type})
9790 If defined, this target hook is a function which assigns default attributes to
9791 the newly defined @var{type}.
9792 @end deftypefn
9793
9794 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type1}, tree @var{type2})
9795 Define this target hook if the merging of type attributes needs special
9796 handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9797 @code{TYPE_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{type1} and @var{type2}. It is assumed
9798 that @code{comptypes} has already been called and returned 1. This
9799 function may call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent
9800 merging.
9801 @end deftypefn
9802
9803 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{olddecl}, tree @var{newdecl})
9804 Define this target hook if the merging of decl attributes needs special
9805 handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9806 @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{olddecl} and @var{newdecl}.
9807 @var{newdecl} is a duplicate declaration of @var{olddecl}. Examples of
9808 when this is needed are when one attribute overrides another, or when an
9809 attribute is nullified by a subsequent definition. This function may
9810 call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent merging.
9811
9812 @findex TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
9813 If the only target-specific handling you require is @samp{dllimport}
9814 for Microsoft Windows targets, you should define the macro
9815 @code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES} to @code{1}. The compiler
9816 will then define a function called
9817 @code{merge_dllimport_decl_attributes} which can then be defined as
9818 the expansion of @code{TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. You can also
9819 add @code{handle_dll_attribute} in the attribute table for your port
9820 to perform initial processing of the @samp{dllimport} and
9821 @samp{dllexport} attributes. This is done in @file{i386/cygwin.h} and
9822 @file{i386/i386.c}, for example.
9823 @end deftypefn
9824
9825 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_DLLIMPORT_ATTRIBUTE_P (const_tree @var{decl})
9826 @var{decl} is a variable or function with @code{__attribute__((dllimport))} specified. Use this hook if the target needs to add extra validation checks to @code{handle_dll_attribute}.
9827 @end deftypefn
9828
9829 @defmac TARGET_DECLSPEC
9830 Define this macro to a nonzero value if you want to treat
9831 @code{__declspec(X)} as equivalent to @code{__attribute((X))}. By
9832 default, this behavior is enabled only for targets that define
9833 @code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. The current implementation
9834 of @code{__declspec} is via a built-in macro, but you should not rely
9835 on this implementation detail.
9836 @end defmac
9837
9838 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{node}, tree *@var{attr_ptr})
9839 Define this target hook if you want to be able to add attributes to a decl
9840 when it is being created. This is normally useful for back ends which
9841 wish to implement a pragma by using the attributes which correspond to
9842 the pragma's effect. The @var{node} argument is the decl which is being
9843 created. The @var{attr_ptr} argument is a pointer to the attribute list
9844 for this decl. The list itself should not be modified, since it may be
9845 shared with other decls, but attributes may be chained on the head of
9846 the list and @code{*@var{attr_ptr}} modified to point to the new
9847 attributes, or a copy of the list may be made if further changes are
9848 needed.
9849 @end deftypefn
9850
9851 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_ATTRIBUTE_INLINABLE_P (const_tree @var{fndecl})
9852 @cindex inlining
9853 This target hook returns @code{true} if it is ok to inline @var{fndecl}
9854 into the current function, despite its having target-specific
9855 attributes, @code{false} otherwise. By default, if a function has a
9856 target specific attribute attached to it, it will not be inlined.
9857 @end deftypefn
9858
9859 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{name}, tree @var{args}, int @var{flags})
9860 This hook is called to parse the @code{attribute(option("..."))}, and
9861 it allows the function to set different target machine compile time
9862 options for the current function that might be different than the
9863 options specified on the command line. The hook should return
9864 @code{true} if the options are valid.
9865
9866 The hook should set the @var{DECL_FUNCTION_SPECIFIC_TARGET} field in
9867 the function declaration to hold a pointer to a target specific
9868 @var{struct cl_target_option} structure.
9869 @end deftypefn
9870
9871 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_SAVE (struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
9872 This hook is called to save any additional target specific information
9873 in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for function specific
9874 options.
9875 @xref{Option file format}.
9876 @end deftypefn
9877
9878 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_RESTORE (struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
9879 This hook is called to restore any additional target specific
9880 information in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9881 function specific options.
9882 @end deftypefn
9883
9884 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_PRINT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{indent}, struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
9885 This hook is called to print any additional target specific
9886 information in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9887 function specific options.
9888 @end deftypefn
9889
9890 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_PRAGMA_PARSE (tree @var{args}, tree @var{pop_target})
9891 This target hook parses the options for @code{#pragma GCC option} to
9892 set the machine specific options for functions that occur later in the
9893 input stream. The options should be the same as handled by the
9894 @code{TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P} hook.
9895 @end deftypefn
9896
9897 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE (void)
9898 Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on
9899 a particular target machine. You can override the hook
9900 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} to take account of this. This hooks is called
9901 once just after all the command options have been parsed.
9902
9903 Don't use this hook to turn on various extra optimizations for
9904 @option{-O}. That is what @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} is for.
9905
9906 If you need to do something whenever the optimization level is
9907 changed via the optimize attribute or pragma, see
9908 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}
9909 @end deftypefn
9910
9911 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_INLINE_P (tree @var{caller}, tree @var{callee})
9912 This target hook returns @code{false} if the @var{caller} function
9913 cannot inline @var{callee}, based on target specific information. By
9914 default, inlining is not allowed if the callee function has function
9915 specific target options and the caller does not use the same options.
9916 @end deftypefn
9917
9918 @node Emulated TLS
9919 @section Emulating TLS
9920 @cindex Emulated TLS
9921
9922 For targets whose psABI does not provide Thread Local Storage via
9923 specific relocations and instruction sequences, an emulation layer is
9924 used. A set of target hooks allows this emulation layer to be
9925 configured for the requirements of a particular target. For instance
9926 the psABI may in fact specify TLS support in terms of an emulation
9927 layer.
9928
9929 The emulation layer works by creating a control object for every TLS
9930 object. To access the TLS object, a lookup function is provided
9931 which, when given the address of the control object, will return the
9932 address of the current thread's instance of the TLS object.
9933
9934 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_GET_ADDRESS
9935 Contains the name of the helper function that uses a TLS control
9936 object to locate a TLS instance. The default causes libgcc's
9937 emulated TLS helper function to be used.
9938 @end deftypevr
9939
9940 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_REGISTER_COMMON
9941 Contains the name of the helper function that should be used at
9942 program startup to register TLS objects that are implicitly
9943 initialized to zero. If this is @code{NULL}, all TLS objects will
9944 have explicit initializers. The default causes libgcc's emulated TLS
9945 registration function to be used.
9946 @end deftypevr
9947
9948 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_SECTION
9949 Contains the name of the section in which TLS control variables should
9950 be placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in
9951 any section.
9952 @end deftypevr
9953
9954 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_SECTION
9955 Contains the name of the section in which TLS initializers should be
9956 placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in any
9957 section.
9958 @end deftypevr
9959
9960 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_PREFIX
9961 Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS control variable names.
9962 The default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9963 @end deftypevr
9964
9965 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_PREFIX
9966 Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS initializer objects. The
9967 default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9968 @end deftypevr
9969
9970 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_FIELDS (tree @var{type}, tree *@var{name})
9971 Specifies a function that generates the FIELD_DECLs for a TLS control
9972 object type. @var{type} is the RECORD_TYPE the fields are for and
9973 @var{name} should be filled with the structure tag, if the default of
9974 @code{__emutls_object} is unsuitable. The default creates a type suitable
9975 for libgcc's emulated TLS function.
9976 @end deftypefn
9977
9978 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_INIT (tree @var{var}, tree @var{decl}, tree @var{tmpl_addr})
9979 Specifies a function that generates the CONSTRUCTOR to initialize a
9980 TLS control object. @var{var} is the TLS control object, @var{decl}
9981 is the TLS object and @var{tmpl_addr} is the address of the
9982 initializer. The default initializes libgcc's emulated TLS control object.
9983 @end deftypefn
9984
9985 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_ALIGN_FIXED
9986 Specifies whether the alignment of TLS control variable objects is
9987 fixed and should not be increased as some backends may do to optimize
9988 single objects. The default is false.
9989 @end deftypevr
9990
9991 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMUTLS_DEBUG_FORM_TLS_ADDRESS
9992 Specifies whether a DWARF @code{DW_OP_form_tls_address} location descriptor
9993 may be used to describe emulated TLS control objects.
9994 @end deftypevr
9995
9996 @node MIPS Coprocessors
9997 @section Defining coprocessor specifics for MIPS targets.
9998 @cindex MIPS coprocessor-definition macros
9999
10000 The MIPS specification allows MIPS implementations to have as many as 4
10001 coprocessors, each with as many as 32 private registers. GCC supports
10002 accessing these registers and transferring values between the registers
10003 and memory using asm-ized variables. For example:
10004
10005 @smallexample
10006 register unsigned int cp0count asm ("c0r1");
10007 unsigned int d;
10008
10009 d = cp0count + 3;
10010 @end smallexample
10011
10012 (``c0r1'' is the default name of register 1 in coprocessor 0; alternate
10013 names may be added as described below, or the default names may be
10014 overridden entirely in @code{SUBTARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}.)
10015
10016 Coprocessor registers are assumed to be epilogue-used; sets to them will
10017 be preserved even if it does not appear that the register is used again
10018 later in the function.
10019
10020 Another note: according to the MIPS spec, coprocessor 1 (if present) is
10021 the FPU@. One accesses COP1 registers through standard mips
10022 floating-point support; they are not included in this mechanism.
10023
10024 There is one macro used in defining the MIPS coprocessor interface which
10025 you may want to override in subtargets; it is described below.
10026
10027 @node PCH Target
10028 @section Parameters for Precompiled Header Validity Checking
10029 @cindex parameters, precompiled headers
10030
10031 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY (size_t *@var{sz})
10032 This hook returns a pointer to the data needed by
10033 @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} and sets
10034 @samp{*@var{sz}} to the size of the data in bytes.
10035 @end deftypefn
10036
10037 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_PCH_VALID_P (const void *@var{data}, size_t @var{sz})
10038 This hook checks whether the options used to create a PCH file are
10039 compatible with the current settings. It returns @code{NULL}
10040 if so and a suitable error message if not. Error messages will
10041 be presented to the user and must be localized using @samp{_(@var{msg})}.
10042
10043 @var{data} is the data that was returned by @code{TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY}
10044 when the PCH file was created and @var{sz} is the size of that data in bytes.
10045 It's safe to assume that the data was created by the same version of the
10046 compiler, so no format checking is needed.
10047
10048 The default definition of @code{default_pch_valid_p} should be
10049 suitable for most targets.
10050 @end deftypefn
10051
10052 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_CHECK_PCH_TARGET_FLAGS (int @var{pch_flags})
10053 If this hook is nonnull, the default implementation of
10054 @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} will use it to check for compatible values
10055 of @code{target_flags}. @var{pch_flags} specifies the value that
10056 @code{target_flags} had when the PCH file was created. The return
10057 value is the same as for @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P}.
10058 @end deftypefn
10059
10060 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_PREPARE_PCH_SAVE (void)
10061 Called before writing out a PCH file. If the target has some
10062 garbage-collected data that needs to be in a particular state on PCH loads,
10063 it can use this hook to enforce that state. Very few targets need
10064 to do anything here.
10065 @end deftypefn
10066
10067 @node C++ ABI
10068 @section C++ ABI parameters
10069 @cindex parameters, c++ abi
10070
10071 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GUARD_TYPE (void)
10072 Define this hook to override the integer type used for guard variables.
10073 These are used to implement one-time construction of static objects. The
10074 default is long_long_integer_type_node.
10075 @end deftypefn
10076
10077 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_GUARD_MASK_BIT (void)
10078 This hook determines how guard variables are used. It should return
10079 @code{false} (the default) if the first byte should be used. A return value of
10080 @code{true} indicates that only the least significant bit should be used.
10081 @end deftypefn
10082
10083 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GET_COOKIE_SIZE (tree @var{type})
10084 This hook returns the size of the cookie to use when allocating an array
10085 whose elements have the indicated @var{type}. Assumes that it is already
10086 known that a cookie is needed. The default is
10087 @code{max(sizeof (size_t), alignof(type))}, as defined in section 2.7 of the
10088 IA64/Generic C++ ABI@.
10089 @end deftypefn
10090
10091 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_COOKIE_HAS_SIZE (void)
10092 This hook should return @code{true} if the element size should be stored in
10093 array cookies. The default is to return @code{false}.
10094 @end deftypefn
10095
10096 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_CXX_IMPORT_EXPORT_CLASS (tree @var{type}, int @var{import_export})
10097 If defined by a backend this hook allows the decision made to export
10098 class @var{type} to be overruled. Upon entry @var{import_export}
10099 will contain 1 if the class is going to be exported, @minus{}1 if it is going
10100 to be imported and 0 otherwise. This function should return the
10101 modified value and perform any other actions necessary to support the
10102 backend's targeted operating system.
10103 @end deftypefn
10104
10105 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CDTOR_RETURNS_THIS (void)
10106 This hook should return @code{true} if constructors and destructors return
10107 the address of the object created/destroyed. The default is to return
10108 @code{false}.
10109 @end deftypefn
10110
10111 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_KEY_METHOD_MAY_BE_INLINE (void)
10112 This hook returns true if the key method for a class (i.e., the method
10113 which, if defined in the current translation unit, causes the virtual
10114 table to be emitted) may be an inline function. Under the standard
10115 Itanium C++ ABI the key method may be an inline function so long as
10116 the function is not declared inline in the class definition. Under
10117 some variants of the ABI, an inline function can never be the key
10118 method. The default is to return @code{true}.
10119 @end deftypefn
10120
10121 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_DETERMINE_CLASS_DATA_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl})
10122 @var{decl} is a virtual table, virtual table table, typeinfo object, or other similar implicit class data object that will be emitted with external linkage in this translation unit. No ELF visibility has been explicitly specified. If the target needs to specify a visibility other than that of the containing class, use this hook to set @code{DECL_VISIBILITY} and @code{DECL_VISIBILITY_SPECIFIED}.
10123 @end deftypefn
10124
10125 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CLASS_DATA_ALWAYS_COMDAT (void)
10126 This hook returns true (the default) if virtual tables and other
10127 similar implicit class data objects are always COMDAT if they have
10128 external linkage. If this hook returns false, then class data for
10129 classes whose virtual table will be emitted in only one translation
10130 unit will not be COMDAT.
10131 @end deftypefn
10132
10133 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_LIBRARY_RTTI_COMDAT (void)
10134 This hook returns true (the default) if the RTTI information for
10135 the basic types which is defined in the C++ runtime should always
10136 be COMDAT, false if it should not be COMDAT.
10137 @end deftypefn
10138
10139 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_USE_AEABI_ATEXIT (void)
10140 This hook returns true if @code{__aeabi_atexit} (as defined by the ARM EABI)
10141 should be used to register static destructors when @option{-fuse-cxa-atexit}
10142 is in effect. The default is to return false to use @code{__cxa_atexit}.
10143 @end deftypefn
10144
10145 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_USE_ATEXIT_FOR_CXA_ATEXIT (void)
10146 This hook returns true if the target @code{atexit} function can be used
10147 in the same manner as @code{__cxa_atexit} to register C++ static
10148 destructors. This requires that @code{atexit}-registered functions in
10149 shared libraries are run in the correct order when the libraries are
10150 unloaded. The default is to return false.
10151 @end deftypefn
10152
10153 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_ADJUST_CLASS_AT_DEFINITION (tree @var{type})
10154 @var{type} is a C++ class (i.e., RECORD_TYPE or UNION_TYPE) that has just been defined. Use this hook to make adjustments to the class (eg, tweak visibility or perform any other required target modifications).
10155 @end deftypefn
10156
10157 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_DECL_MANGLING_CONTEXT (const_tree @var{decl})
10158 Return target-specific mangling context of @var{decl} or @code{NULL_TREE}.
10159 @end deftypefn
10160
10161 @node Named Address Spaces
10162 @section Adding support for named address spaces
10163 @cindex named address spaces
10164
10165 The draft technical report of the ISO/IEC JTC1 S22 WG14 N1275
10166 standards committee, @cite{Programming Languages - C - Extensions to
10167 support embedded processors}, specifies a syntax for embedded
10168 processors to specify alternate address spaces. You can configure a
10169 GCC port to support section 5.1 of the draft report to add support for
10170 address spaces other than the default address space. These address
10171 spaces are new keywords that are similar to the @code{volatile} and
10172 @code{const} type attributes.
10173
10174 Pointers to named address spaces can have a different size than
10175 pointers to the generic address space.
10176
10177 For example, the SPU port uses the @code{__ea} address space to refer
10178 to memory in the host processor, rather than memory local to the SPU
10179 processor. Access to memory in the @code{__ea} address space involves
10180 issuing DMA operations to move data between the host processor and the
10181 local processor memory address space. Pointers in the @code{__ea}
10182 address space are either 32 bits or 64 bits based on the
10183 @option{-mea32} or @option{-mea64} switches (native SPU pointers are
10184 always 32 bits).
10185
10186 Internally, address spaces are represented as a small integer in the
10187 range 0 to 15 with address space 0 being reserved for the generic
10188 address space.
10189
10190 To register a named address space qualifier keyword with the C front end,
10191 the target may call the @code{c_register_addr_space} routine. For example,
10192 the SPU port uses the following to declare @code{__ea} as the keyword for
10193 named address space #1:
10194 @smallexample
10195 #define ADDR_SPACE_EA 1
10196 c_register_addr_space ("__ea", ADDR_SPACE_EA);
10197 @end smallexample
10198
10199 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE (addr_space_t @var{address_space})
10200 Define this to return the machine mode to use for pointers to
10201 @var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10202 The default version of this hook returns @code{ptr_mode} for the
10203 generic address space only.
10204 @end deftypefn
10205
10206 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE (addr_space_t @var{address_space})
10207 Define this to return the machine mode to use for addresses in
10208 @var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10209 The default version of this hook returns @code{Pmode} for the
10210 generic address space only.
10211 @end deftypefn
10212
10213 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_VALID_POINTER_MODE (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10214 Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
10215 with machine mode @var{mode} to address space @var{as}. This target
10216 hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE} target hook,
10217 except that it includes explicit named address space support. The default
10218 version of this hook returns true for the modes returned by either the
10219 @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE} or @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE}
10220 target hooks for the given address space.
10221 @end deftypefn
10222
10223 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{exp}, bool @var{strict}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10224 Define this to return true if @var{exp} is a valid address for mode
10225 @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. The @var{strict}
10226 parameter says whether strict addressing is in effect after reload has
10227 finished. This target hook is the same as the
10228 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} target hook, except that it includes
10229 explicit named address space support.
10230 @end deftypefn
10231
10232 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x}, rtx @var{oldx}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10233 Define this to modify an invalid address @var{x} to be a valid address
10234 with mode @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. This target
10235 hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} target hook,
10236 except that it includes explicit named address space support.
10237 @end deftypefn
10238
10239 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P (addr_space_t @var{subset}, addr_space_t @var{superset})
10240 Define this to return whether the @var{subset} named address space is
10241 contained within the @var{superset} named address space. Pointers to
10242 a named address space that is a subset of another named address space
10243 will be converted automatically without a cast if used together in
10244 arithmetic operations. Pointers to a superset address space can be
10245 converted to pointers to a subset address space via explicit casts.
10246 @end deftypefn
10247
10248 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_CONVERT (rtx @var{op}, tree @var{from_type}, tree @var{to_type})
10249 Define this to convert the pointer expression represented by the RTL
10250 @var{op} with type @var{from_type} that points to a named address
10251 space to a new pointer expression with type @var{to_type} that points
10252 to a different named address space. When this hook it called, it is
10253 guaranteed that one of the two address spaces is a subset of the other,
10254 as determined by the @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P} target hook.
10255 @end deftypefn
10256
10257 @node Misc
10258 @section Miscellaneous Parameters
10259 @cindex parameters, miscellaneous
10260
10261 @c prevent bad page break with this line
10262 Here are several miscellaneous parameters.
10263
10264 @defmac HAS_LONG_COND_BRANCH
10265 Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10266 has conditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10267 conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10268 blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10269 set to false, gcc will convert any conditional branches that attempt
10270 to cross between sections into unconditional branches or indirect jumps.
10271 @end defmac
10272
10273 @defmac HAS_LONG_UNCOND_BRANCH
10274 Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10275 has unconditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10276 conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10277 blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10278 set to false, gcc will convert any unconditional branches that attempt
10279 to cross between sections into indirect jumps.
10280 @end defmac
10281
10282 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_MODE
10283 An alias for a machine mode name. This is the machine mode that
10284 elements of a jump-table should have.
10285 @end defmac
10286
10287 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE (@var{min_offset}, @var{max_offset}, @var{body})
10288 Optional: return the preferred mode for an @code{addr_diff_vec}
10289 when the minimum and maximum offset are known. If you define this,
10290 it enables extra code in branch shortening to deal with @code{addr_diff_vec}.
10291 To make this work, you also have to define @code{INSN_ALIGN} and
10292 make the alignment for @code{addr_diff_vec} explicit.
10293 The @var{body} argument is provided so that the offset_unsigned and scale
10294 flags can be updated.
10295 @end defmac
10296
10297 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
10298 Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate when jump-tables
10299 should contain relative addresses. You need not define this macro if
10300 jump-tables never contain relative addresses, or jump-tables should
10301 contain relative addresses only when @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIC}
10302 is in effect.
10303 @end defmac
10304
10305 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD (void)
10306 This function return the smallest number of different values for which it
10307 is best to use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.
10308 The default is four for machines with a @code{casesi} instruction and
10309 five otherwise. This is best for most machines.
10310 @end deftypefn
10311
10312 @defmac WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
10313 Define this macro if operations between registers with integral mode
10314 smaller than a word are always performed on the entire register.
10315 Most RISC machines have this property and most CISC machines do not.
10316 @end defmac
10317
10318 @defmac LOAD_EXTEND_OP (@var{mem_mode})
10319 Define this macro to be a C expression indicating when insns that read
10320 memory in @var{mem_mode}, an integral mode narrower than a word, set the
10321 bits outside of @var{mem_mode} to be either the sign-extension or the
10322 zero-extension of the data read. Return @code{SIGN_EXTEND} for values
10323 of @var{mem_mode} for which the
10324 insn sign-extends, @code{ZERO_EXTEND} for which it zero-extends, and
10325 @code{UNKNOWN} for other modes.
10326
10327 This macro is not called with @var{mem_mode} non-integral or with a width
10328 greater than or equal to @code{BITS_PER_WORD}, so you may return any
10329 value in this case. Do not define this macro if it would always return
10330 @code{UNKNOWN}. On machines where this macro is defined, you will normally
10331 define it as the constant @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{ZERO_EXTEND}.
10332
10333 You may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN} value even if for some hard registers
10334 the sign extension is not performed, if for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS}
10335 of these hard registers @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero
10336 when the @var{from} mode is @var{mem_mode} and the @var{to} mode is any
10337 integral mode larger than this but not larger than @code{word_mode}.
10338
10339 You must return @code{UNKNOWN} if for some hard registers that allow this
10340 mode, @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} says that they cannot change to
10341 @code{word_mode}, but that they can change to another integral mode that
10342 is larger then @var{mem_mode} but still smaller than @code{word_mode}.
10343 @end defmac
10344
10345 @defmac SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
10346 Define this macro if loading short immediate values into registers sign
10347 extends.
10348 @end defmac
10349
10350 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_MIN_DIVISIONS_FOR_RECIP_MUL (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
10351 When @option{-ffast-math} is in effect, GCC tries to optimize
10352 divisions by the same divisor, by turning them into multiplications by
10353 the reciprocal. This target hook specifies the minimum number of divisions
10354 that should be there for GCC to perform the optimization for a variable
10355 of mode @var{mode}. The default implementation returns 3 if the machine
10356 has an instruction for the division, and 2 if it does not.
10357 @end deftypefn
10358
10359 @defmac MOVE_MAX
10360 The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10361 between memory and registers or between two memory locations.
10362 @end defmac
10363
10364 @defmac MAX_MOVE_MAX
10365 The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10366 between memory and registers or between two memory locations. If this
10367 is undefined, the default is @code{MOVE_MAX}. Otherwise, it is the
10368 constant value that is the largest value that @code{MOVE_MAX} can have
10369 at run-time.
10370 @end defmac
10371
10372 @defmac SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
10373 A C expression that is nonzero if on this machine the number of bits
10374 actually used for the count of a shift operation is equal to the number
10375 of bits needed to represent the size of the object being shifted. When
10376 this macro is nonzero, the compiler will assume that it is safe to omit
10377 a sign-extend, zero-extend, and certain bitwise `and' instructions that
10378 truncates the count of a shift operation. On machines that have
10379 instructions that act on bit-fields at variable positions, which may
10380 include `bit test' instructions, a nonzero @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10381 also enables deletion of truncations of the values that serve as
10382 arguments to bit-field instructions.
10383
10384 If both types of instructions truncate the count (for shifts) and
10385 position (for bit-field operations), or if no variable-position bit-field
10386 instructions exist, you should define this macro.
10387
10388 However, on some machines, such as the 80386 and the 680x0, truncation
10389 only applies to shift operations and not the (real or pretended)
10390 bit-field operations. Define @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} to be zero on
10391 such machines. Instead, add patterns to the @file{md} file that include
10392 the implied truncation of the shift instructions.
10393
10394 You need not define this macro if it would always have the value of zero.
10395 @end defmac
10396
10397 @anchor{TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK}
10398 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
10399 This function describes how the standard shift patterns for @var{mode}
10400 deal with shifts by negative amounts or by more than the width of the mode.
10401 @xref{shift patterns}.
10402
10403 On many machines, the shift patterns will apply a mask @var{m} to the
10404 shift count, meaning that a fixed-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y} is
10405 equivalent to an arbitrary-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y & m}. If
10406 this is true for mode @var{mode}, the function should return @var{m},
10407 otherwise it should return 0. A return value of 0 indicates that no
10408 particular behavior is guaranteed.
10409
10410 Note that, unlike @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}, this function does
10411 @emph{not} apply to general shift rtxes; it applies only to instructions
10412 that are generated by the named shift patterns.
10413
10414 The default implementation of this function returns
10415 @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE (@var{mode}) - 1} if @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10416 and 0 otherwise. This definition is always safe, but if
10417 @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} is false, and some shift patterns
10418 nevertheless truncate the shift count, you may get better code
10419 by overriding it.
10420 @end deftypefn
10421
10422 @defmac TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (@var{outprec}, @var{inprec})
10423 A C expression which is nonzero if on this machine it is safe to
10424 ``convert'' an integer of @var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec}
10425 bits (where @var{outprec} is smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely
10426 operating on it as if it had only @var{outprec} bits.
10427
10428 On many machines, this expression can be 1.
10429
10430 @c rearranged this, removed the phrase "it is reported that". this was
10431 @c to fix an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
10432 When @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} returns 1 for a pair of sizes for
10433 modes for which @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P} is 0, suboptimal code can result.
10434 If this is the case, making @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} return 0 in
10435 such cases may improve things.
10436 @end defmac
10437
10438 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, enum machine_mode @var{rep_mode})
10439 The representation of an integral mode can be such that the values
10440 are always extended to a wider integral mode. Return
10441 @code{SIGN_EXTEND} if values of @var{mode} are represented in
10442 sign-extended form to @var{rep_mode}. Return @code{UNKNOWN}
10443 otherwise. (Currently, none of the targets use zero-extended
10444 representation this way so unlike @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP},
10445 @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} is expected to return either
10446 @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{UNKNOWN}. Also no target extends
10447 @var{mode} to @var{rep_mode} so that @var{rep_mode} is not the next
10448 widest integral mode and currently we take advantage of this fact.)
10449
10450 Similarly to @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP} you may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN}
10451 value even if the extension is not performed on certain hard registers
10452 as long as for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS} of these hard registers
10453 @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero.
10454
10455 Note that @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} and @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP}
10456 describe two related properties. If you define
10457 @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (mode, word_mode)} you probably also want
10458 to define @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP (mode)} to return the same type of
10459 extension.
10460
10461 In order to enforce the representation of @code{mode},
10462 @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} should return false when truncating to
10463 @code{mode}.
10464 @end deftypefn
10465
10466 @defmac STORE_FLAG_VALUE
10467 A C expression describing the value returned by a comparison operator
10468 with an integral mode and stored by a store-flag instruction
10469 (@samp{cstore@var{mode}4}) when the condition is true. This description must
10470 apply to @emph{all} the @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} patterns and all the
10471 comparison operators whose results have a @code{MODE_INT} mode.
10472
10473 A value of 1 or @minus{}1 means that the instruction implementing the
10474 comparison operator returns exactly 1 or @minus{}1 when the comparison is true
10475 and 0 when the comparison is false. Otherwise, the value indicates
10476 which bits of the result are guaranteed to be 1 when the comparison is
10477 true. This value is interpreted in the mode of the comparison
10478 operation, which is given by the mode of the first operand in the
10479 @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} pattern. Either the low bit or the sign bit of
10480 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} be on. Presently, only those bits are used by
10481 the compiler.
10482
10483 If @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is neither 1 or @minus{}1, the compiler will
10484 generate code that depends only on the specified bits. It can also
10485 replace comparison operators with equivalent operations if they cause
10486 the required bits to be set, even if the remaining bits are undefined.
10487 For example, on a machine whose comparison operators return an
10488 @code{SImode} value and where @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is defined as
10489 @samp{0x80000000}, saying that just the sign bit is relevant, the
10490 expression
10491
10492 @smallexample
10493 (ne:SI (and:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{power-of-2})) (const_int 0))
10494 @end smallexample
10495
10496 @noindent
10497 can be converted to
10498
10499 @smallexample
10500 (ashift:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))
10501 @end smallexample
10502
10503 @noindent
10504 where @var{n} is the appropriate shift count to move the bit being
10505 tested into the sign bit.
10506
10507 There is no way to describe a machine that always sets the low-order bit
10508 for a true value, but does not guarantee the value of any other bits,
10509 but we do not know of any machine that has such an instruction. If you
10510 are trying to port GCC to such a machine, include an instruction to
10511 perform a logical-and of the result with 1 in the pattern for the
10512 comparison operators and let us know at @email{gcc@@gcc.gnu.org}.
10513
10514 Often, a machine will have multiple instructions that obtain a value
10515 from a comparison (or the condition codes). Here are rules to guide the
10516 choice of value for @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}, and hence the instructions
10517 to be used:
10518
10519 @itemize @bullet
10520 @item
10521 Use the shortest sequence that yields a valid definition for
10522 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}. It is more efficient for the compiler to
10523 ``normalize'' the value (convert it to, e.g., 1 or 0) than for the
10524 comparison operators to do so because there may be opportunities to
10525 combine the normalization with other operations.
10526
10527 @item
10528 For equal-length sequences, use a value of 1 or @minus{}1, with @minus{}1 being
10529 slightly preferred on machines with expensive jumps and 1 preferred on
10530 other machines.
10531
10532 @item
10533 As a second choice, choose a value of @samp{0x80000001} if instructions
10534 exist that set both the sign and low-order bits but do not define the
10535 others.
10536
10537 @item
10538 Otherwise, use a value of @samp{0x80000000}.
10539 @end itemize
10540
10541 Many machines can produce both the value chosen for
10542 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} and its negation in the same number of
10543 instructions. On those machines, you should also define a pattern for
10544 those cases, e.g., one matching
10545
10546 @smallexample
10547 (set @var{A} (neg:@var{m} (ne:@var{m} @var{B} @var{C})))
10548 @end smallexample
10549
10550 Some machines can also perform @code{and} or @code{plus} operations on
10551 condition code values with less instructions than the corresponding
10552 @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} insn followed by @code{and} or @code{plus}. On those
10553 machines, define the appropriate patterns. Use the names @code{incscc}
10554 and @code{decscc}, respectively, for the patterns which perform
10555 @code{plus} or @code{minus} operations on condition code values. See
10556 @file{rs6000.md} for some examples. The GNU Superoptimizer can be used to
10557 find such instruction sequences on other machines.
10558
10559 If this macro is not defined, the default value, 1, is used. You need
10560 not define @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} if the machine has no store-flag
10561 instructions, or if the value generated by these instructions is 1.
10562 @end defmac
10563
10564 @defmac FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10565 A C expression that gives a nonzero @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} value that is
10566 returned when comparison operators with floating-point results are true.
10567 Define this macro on machines that have comparison operations that return
10568 floating-point values. If there are no such operations, do not define
10569 this macro.
10570 @end defmac
10571
10572 @defmac VECTOR_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10573 A C expression that gives a rtx representing the nonzero true element
10574 for vector comparisons. The returned rtx should be valid for the inner
10575 mode of @var{mode} which is guaranteed to be a vector mode. Define
10576 this macro on machines that have vector comparison operations that
10577 return a vector result. If there are no such operations, do not define
10578 this macro. Typically, this macro is defined as @code{const1_rtx} or
10579 @code{constm1_rtx}. This macro may return @code{NULL_RTX} to prevent
10580 the compiler optimizing such vector comparison operations for the
10581 given mode.
10582 @end defmac
10583
10584 @defmac CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10585 @defmacx CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10586 A C expression that indicates whether the architecture defines a value
10587 for @code{clz} or @code{ctz} with a zero operand.
10588 A result of @code{0} indicates the value is undefined.
10589 If the value is defined for only the RTL expression, the macro should
10590 evaluate to @code{1}; if the value applies also to the corresponding optab
10591 entry (which is normally the case if it expands directly into
10592 the corresponding RTL), then the macro should evaluate to @code{2}.
10593 In the cases where the value is defined, @var{value} should be set to
10594 this value.
10595
10596 If this macro is not defined, the value of @code{clz} or
10597 @code{ctz} at zero is assumed to be undefined.
10598
10599 This macro must be defined if the target's expansion for @code{ffs}
10600 relies on a particular value to get correct results. Otherwise it
10601 is not necessary, though it may be used to optimize some corner cases, and
10602 to provide a default expansion for the @code{ffs} optab.
10603
10604 Note that regardless of this macro the ``definedness'' of @code{clz}
10605 and @code{ctz} at zero do @emph{not} extend to the builtin functions
10606 visible to the user. Thus one may be free to adjust the value at will
10607 to match the target expansion of these operations without fear of
10608 breaking the API@.
10609 @end defmac
10610
10611 @defmac Pmode
10612 An alias for the machine mode for pointers. On most machines, define
10613 this to be the integer mode corresponding to the width of a hardware
10614 pointer; @code{SImode} on 32-bit machine or @code{DImode} on 64-bit machines.
10615 On some machines you must define this to be one of the partial integer
10616 modes, such as @code{PSImode}.
10617
10618 The width of @code{Pmode} must be at least as large as the value of
10619 @code{POINTER_SIZE}. If it is not equal, you must define the macro
10620 @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED} to specify how pointers are extended
10621 to @code{Pmode}.
10622 @end defmac
10623
10624 @defmac FUNCTION_MODE
10625 An alias for the machine mode used for memory references to functions
10626 being called, in @code{call} RTL expressions. On most CISC machines,
10627 where an instruction can begin at any byte address, this should be
10628 @code{QImode}. On most RISC machines, where all instructions have fixed
10629 size and alignment, this should be a mode with the same size and alignment
10630 as the machine instruction words - typically @code{SImode} or @code{HImode}.
10631 @end defmac
10632
10633 @defmac STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
10634 In normal operation, the preprocessor expands @code{__STDC__} to the
10635 constant 1, to signify that GCC conforms to ISO Standard C@. On some
10636 hosts, like Solaris, the system compiler uses a different convention,
10637 where @code{__STDC__} is normally 0, but is 1 if the user specifies
10638 strict conformance to the C Standard.
10639
10640 Defining @code{STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS} makes GNU CPP follows the host
10641 convention when processing system header files, but when processing user
10642 files @code{__STDC__} will always expand to 1.
10643 @end defmac
10644
10645 @defmac NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
10646 Define this macro if the system header files support C++ as well as C@.
10647 This macro inhibits the usual method of using system header files in
10648 C++, which is to pretend that the file's contents are enclosed in
10649 @samp{extern "C" @{@dots{}@}}.
10650 @end defmac
10651
10652 @findex #pragma
10653 @findex pragma
10654 @defmac REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS ()
10655 Define this macro if you want to implement any target-specific pragmas.
10656 If defined, it is a C expression which makes a series of calls to
10657 @code{c_register_pragma} or @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion}
10658 for each pragma. The macro may also do any
10659 setup required for the pragmas.
10660
10661 The primary reason to define this macro is to provide compatibility with
10662 other compilers for the same target. In general, we discourage
10663 definition of target-specific pragmas for GCC@.
10664
10665 If the pragma can be implemented by attributes then you should consider
10666 defining the target hook @samp{TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES} as well.
10667
10668 Preprocessor macros that appear on pragma lines are not expanded. All
10669 @samp{#pragma} directives that do not match any registered pragma are
10670 silently ignored, unless the user specifies @option{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
10671 @end defmac
10672
10673 @deftypefun void c_register_pragma (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10674 @deftypefunx void c_register_pragma_with_expansion (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10675
10676 Each call to @code{c_register_pragma} or
10677 @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} establishes one pragma. The
10678 @var{callback} routine will be called when the preprocessor encounters a
10679 pragma of the form
10680
10681 @smallexample
10682 #pragma [@var{space}] @var{name} @dots{}
10683 @end smallexample
10684
10685 @var{space} is the case-sensitive namespace of the pragma, or
10686 @code{NULL} to put the pragma in the global namespace. The callback
10687 routine receives @var{pfile} as its first argument, which can be passed
10688 on to cpplib's functions if necessary. You can lex tokens after the
10689 @var{name} by calling @code{pragma_lex}. Tokens that are not read by the
10690 callback will be silently ignored. The end of the line is indicated by
10691 a token of type @code{CPP_EOF}. Macro expansion occurs on the
10692 arguments of pragmas registered with
10693 @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} but not on the arguments of
10694 pragmas registered with @code{c_register_pragma}.
10695
10696 Note that the use of @code{pragma_lex} is specific to the C and C++
10697 compilers. It will not work in the Java or Fortran compilers, or any
10698 other language compilers for that matter. Thus if @code{pragma_lex} is going
10699 to be called from target-specific code, it must only be done so when
10700 building the C and C++ compilers. This can be done by defining the
10701 variables @code{c_target_objs} and @code{cxx_target_objs} in the
10702 target entry in the @file{config.gcc} file. These variables should name
10703 the target-specific, language-specific object file which contains the
10704 code that uses @code{pragma_lex}. Note it will also be necessary to add a
10705 rule to the makefile fragment pointed to by @code{tmake_file} that shows
10706 how to build this object file.
10707 @end deftypefun
10708
10709 @defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_WITH_EXPANSION
10710 Define this macro if macros should be expanded in the
10711 arguments of @samp{#pragma pack}.
10712 @end defmac
10713
10714 @defmac TARGET_DEFAULT_PACK_STRUCT
10715 If your target requires a structure packing default other than 0 (meaning
10716 the machine default), define this macro to the necessary value (in bytes).
10717 This must be a value that would also be valid to use with
10718 @samp{#pragma pack()} (that is, a small power of two).
10719 @end defmac
10720
10721 @defmac DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
10722 Define this macro to control use of the character @samp{$} in
10723 identifier names for the C family of languages. 0 means @samp{$} is
10724 not allowed by default; 1 means it is allowed. 1 is the default;
10725 there is no need to define this macro in that case.
10726 @end defmac
10727
10728 @defmac INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10729 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10730 delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10731 even if they appear to use a resource set or clobbered in @var{insn}.
10732 @var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}; GCC knows that
10733 every @code{call_insn} has this behavior. On machines where some @code{insn}
10734 or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and hence has this behavior,
10735 you should define this macro.
10736
10737 You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10738 @end defmac
10739
10740 @defmac INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10741 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10742 delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10743 even if they appear to set or clobber a resource referenced in @var{insn}.
10744 @var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}. On machines where
10745 some @code{insn} or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and its operands
10746 are registers whose use is actually in the subroutine it calls, you should
10747 define this macro. Doing so allows the delay slot scheduler to move
10748 instructions which copy arguments into the argument registers into the delay
10749 slot of @var{insn}.
10750
10751 You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10752 @end defmac
10753
10754 @defmac MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
10755 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if, in some cases,
10756 global symbols from one translation unit may not be bound to undefined
10757 symbols in another translation unit without user intervention. For
10758 instance, under Microsoft Windows symbols must be explicitly imported
10759 from shared libraries (DLLs).
10760
10761 You need not define this macro if it would always evaluate to zero.
10762 @end defmac
10763
10764 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MD_ASM_CLOBBERS (tree @var{outputs}, tree @var{inputs}, tree @var{clobbers})
10765 This target hook should add to @var{clobbers} @code{STRING_CST} trees for
10766 any hard regs the port wishes to automatically clobber for an asm.
10767 It should return the result of the last @code{tree_cons} used to add a
10768 clobber. The @var{outputs}, @var{inputs} and @var{clobber} lists are the
10769 corresponding parameters to the asm and may be inspected to avoid
10770 clobbering a register that is an input or output of the asm. You can use
10771 @code{tree_overlaps_hard_reg_set}, declared in @file{tree.h}, to test
10772 for overlap with regards to asm-declared registers.
10773 @end deftypefn
10774
10775 @defmac MATH_LIBRARY
10776 Define this macro as a C string constant for the linker argument to link
10777 in the system math library, minus the initial @samp{"-l"}, or
10778 @samp{""} if the target does not have a
10779 separate math library.
10780
10781 You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"m"} is wrong.
10782 @end defmac
10783
10784 @defmac LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
10785 Define this macro as a C string constant for the environment variable that
10786 specifies where the linker should look for libraries.
10787
10788 You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"LIBRARY_PATH"}
10789 is wrong.
10790 @end defmac
10791
10792 @defmac TARGET_POSIX_IO
10793 Define this macro if the target supports the following POSIX@ file
10794 functions, access, mkdir and file locking with fcntl / F_SETLKW@.
10795 Defining @code{TARGET_POSIX_IO} will enable the test coverage code
10796 to use file locking when exiting a program, which avoids race conditions
10797 if the program has forked. It will also create directories at run-time
10798 for cross-profiling.
10799 @end defmac
10800
10801 @defmac MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
10802
10803 A C expression for the maximum number of instructions to execute via
10804 conditional execution instructions instead of a branch. A value of
10805 @code{BRANCH_COST}+1 is the default if the machine does not use cc0, and
10806 1 if it does use cc0.
10807 @end defmac
10808
10809 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10810 Used if the target needs to perform machine-dependent modifications on the
10811 conditionals used for turning basic blocks into conditionally executed code.
10812 @var{ce_info} points to a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which
10813 contains information about the currently processed blocks. @var{true_expr}
10814 and @var{false_expr} are the tests that are used for converting the
10815 then-block and the else-block, respectively. Set either @var{true_expr} or
10816 @var{false_expr} to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted.
10817 @end defmac
10818
10819 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_MULTIPLE_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{bb}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10820 Like @code{IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS}, but used when converting more complicated
10821 if-statements into conditions combined by @code{and} and @code{or} operations.
10822 @var{bb} contains the basic block that contains the test that is currently
10823 being processed and about to be turned into a condition.
10824 @end defmac
10825
10826 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN (@var{ce_info}, @var{pattern}, @var{insn})
10827 A C expression to modify the @var{PATTERN} of an @var{INSN} that is to
10828 be converted to conditional execution format. @var{ce_info} points to
10829 a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which contains information
10830 about the currently processed blocks.
10831 @end defmac
10832
10833 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL (@var{ce_info})
10834 A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
10835 converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10836 can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10837 to by @var{ce_info}.
10838 @end defmac
10839
10840 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL (@var{ce_info})
10841 A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in
10842 converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10843 can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10844 to by @var{ce_info}.
10845 @end defmac
10846
10847 @defmac IFCVT_MACHDEP_INIT (@var{ce_info})
10848 A C expression to initialize any machine specific data for if-conversion
10849 of the if-block in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10850 to by @var{ce_info}.
10851 @end defmac
10852
10853 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG (void)
10854 If non-null, this hook performs a target-specific pass over the
10855 instruction stream. The compiler will run it at all optimization levels,
10856 just before the point at which it normally does delayed-branch scheduling.
10857
10858 The exact purpose of the hook varies from target to target. Some use
10859 it to do transformations that are necessary for correctness, such as
10860 laying out in-function constant pools or avoiding hardware hazards.
10861 Others use it as an opportunity to do some machine-dependent optimizations.
10862
10863 You need not implement the hook if it has nothing to do. The default
10864 definition is null.
10865 @end deftypefn
10866
10867 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS (void)
10868 Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10869 that need to be defined. It should be a function that performs the
10870 necessary setup.
10871
10872 Machine specific built-in functions can be useful to expand special machine
10873 instructions that would otherwise not normally be generated because
10874 they have no equivalent in the source language (for example, SIMD vector
10875 instructions or prefetch instructions).
10876
10877 To create a built-in function, call the function
10878 @code{lang_hooks.builtin_function}
10879 which is defined by the language front end. You can use any type nodes set
10880 up by @code{build_common_tree_nodes};
10881 only language front ends that use those two functions will call
10882 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.
10883 @end deftypefn
10884
10885 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_DECL (unsigned @var{code}, bool @var{initialize_p})
10886 Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10887 that need to be defined. It should be a function that returns the
10888 builtin function declaration for the builtin function code @var{code}.
10889 If there is no such builtin and it cannot be initialized at this time
10890 if @var{initialize_p} is true the function should return @code{NULL_TREE}.
10891 If @var{code} is out of range the function should return
10892 @code{error_mark_node}.
10893 @end deftypefn
10894
10895 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN (tree @var{exp}, rtx @var{target}, rtx @var{subtarget}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, int @var{ignore})
10896
10897 Expand a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10898 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{exp} is the expression for the
10899 function call; the result should go to @var{target} if that is
10900 convenient, and have mode @var{mode} if that is convenient.
10901 @var{subtarget} may be used as the target for computing one of
10902 @var{exp}'s operands. @var{ignore} is nonzero if the value is to be
10903 ignored. This function should return the result of the call to the
10904 built-in function.
10905 @end deftypefn
10906
10907 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_RESOLVE_OVERLOADED_BUILTIN (unsigned int @var{loc}, tree @var{fndecl}, void *@var{arglist})
10908 Select a replacement for a machine specific built-in function that
10909 was set up by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. This is done
10910 @emph{before} regular type checking, and so allows the target to
10911 implement a crude form of function overloading. @var{fndecl} is the
10912 declaration of the built-in function. @var{arglist} is the list of
10913 arguments passed to the built-in function. The result is a
10914 complete expression that implements the operation, usually
10915 another @code{CALL_EXPR}.
10916 @var{arglist} really has type @samp{VEC(tree,gc)*}
10917 @end deftypefn
10918
10919 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FOLD_BUILTIN (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{n_args}, tree *@var{argp}, bool @var{ignore})
10920 Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10921 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{fndecl} is the declaration of the
10922 built-in function. @var{n_args} is the number of arguments passed to
10923 the function; the arguments themselves are pointed to by @var{argp}.
10924 The result is another tree containing a simplified expression for the
10925 call's result. If @var{ignore} is true the value will be ignored.
10926 @end deftypefn
10927
10928 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_WITHIN_DOLOOP (const_rtx @var{insn})
10929
10930 Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return NULL if it is valid within a
10931 low-overhead loop, otherwise return a string explaining why doloop
10932 could not be applied.
10933
10934 Many targets use special registers for low-overhead looping. For any
10935 instruction that clobbers these this function should return a string indicating
10936 the reason why the doloop could not be applied.
10937 By default, the RTL loop optimizer does not use a present doloop pattern for
10938 loops containing function calls or branch on table instructions.
10939 @end deftypefn
10940
10941 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_COMBINED_INSN (rtx @var{insn})
10942 Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return @code{false} if the instruction is not appropriate as a combination of two or more instructions. The default is to accept all instructions.
10943 @end deftypefn
10944
10945 @defmac MD_CAN_REDIRECT_BRANCH (@var{branch1}, @var{branch2})
10946
10947 Take a branch insn in @var{branch1} and another in @var{branch2}.
10948 Return true if redirecting @var{branch1} to the destination of
10949 @var{branch2} is possible.
10950
10951 On some targets, branches may have a limited range. Optimizing the
10952 filling of delay slots can result in branches being redirected, and this
10953 may in turn cause a branch offset to overflow.
10954 @end defmac
10955
10956 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_COMMUTATIVE_P (const_rtx @var{x}, int @var{outer_code})
10957 This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{x} is considered to be commutative.
10958 Usually, this is just COMMUTATIVE_P (@var{x}), but the HP PA doesn't consider
10959 PLUS to be commutative inside a MEM@. @var{outer_code} is the rtx code
10960 of the enclosing rtl, if known, otherwise it is UNKNOWN.
10961 @end deftypefn
10962
10963 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE (rtx @var{hard_reg})
10964
10965 When the initial value of a hard register has been copied in a pseudo
10966 register, it is often not necessary to actually allocate another register
10967 to this pseudo register, because the original hard register or a stack slot
10968 it has been saved into can be used. @code{TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE}
10969 is called at the start of register allocation once for each hard register
10970 that had its initial value copied by using
10971 @code{get_func_hard_reg_initial_val} or @code{get_hard_reg_initial_val}.
10972 Possible values are @code{NULL_RTX}, if you don't want
10973 to do any special allocation, a @code{REG} rtx---that would typically be
10974 the hard register itself, if it is known not to be clobbered---or a
10975 @code{MEM}.
10976 If you are returning a @code{MEM}, this is only a hint for the allocator;
10977 it might decide to use another register anyways.
10978 You may use @code{current_function_leaf_function} in the hook, functions
10979 that use @code{REG_N_SETS}, to determine if the hard
10980 register in question will not be clobbered.
10981 The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which disables any special
10982 allocation.
10983 @end deftypefn
10984
10985 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_UNSPEC_MAY_TRAP_P (const_rtx @var{x}, unsigned @var{flags})
10986 This target hook returns nonzero if @var{x}, an @code{unspec} or
10987 @code{unspec_volatile} operation, might cause a trap. Targets can use
10988 this hook to enhance precision of analysis for @code{unspec} and
10989 @code{unspec_volatile} operations. You may call @code{may_trap_p_1}
10990 to analyze inner elements of @var{x} in which case @var{flags} should be
10991 passed along.
10992 @end deftypefn
10993
10994 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_CURRENT_FUNCTION (tree @var{decl})
10995 The compiler invokes this hook whenever it changes its current function
10996 context (@code{cfun}). You can define this function if
10997 the back end needs to perform any initialization or reset actions on a
10998 per-function basis. For example, it may be used to implement function
10999 attributes that affect register usage or code generation patterns.
11000 The argument @var{decl} is the declaration for the new function context,
11001 and may be null to indicate that the compiler has left a function context
11002 and is returning to processing at the top level.
11003 The default hook function does nothing.
11004
11005 GCC sets @code{cfun} to a dummy function context during initialization of
11006 some parts of the back end. The hook function is not invoked in this
11007 situation; you need not worry about the hook being invoked recursively,
11008 or when the back end is in a partially-initialized state.
11009 @code{cfun} might be @code{NULL} to indicate processing at top level,
11010 outside of any function scope.
11011 @end deftypefn
11012
11013 @defmac TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
11014 Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix for object
11015 files on your target machine. If you do not define this macro, GCC will
11016 use @samp{.o} as the suffix for object files.
11017 @end defmac
11018
11019 @defmac TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
11020 Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix to be
11021 automatically added to executable files on your target machine. If you
11022 do not define this macro, GCC will use the null string as the suffix for
11023 executable files.
11024 @end defmac
11025
11026 @defmac COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
11027 If defined, @code{collect2} will scan the individual object files
11028 specified on its command line and create an export list for the linker.
11029 Define this macro for systems like AIX, where the linker discards
11030 object files that are not referenced from @code{main} and uses export
11031 lists.
11032 @end defmac
11033
11034 @defmac MODIFY_JNI_METHOD_CALL (@var{mdecl})
11035 Define this macro to a C expression representing a variant of the
11036 method call @var{mdecl}, if Java Native Interface (JNI) methods
11037 must be invoked differently from other methods on your target.
11038 For example, on 32-bit Microsoft Windows, JNI methods must be invoked using
11039 the @code{stdcall} calling convention and this macro is then
11040 defined as this expression:
11041
11042 @smallexample
11043 build_type_attribute_variant (@var{mdecl},
11044 build_tree_list
11045 (get_identifier ("stdcall"),
11046 NULL))
11047 @end smallexample
11048 @end defmac
11049
11050 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_MODIFY_JUMPS_P (void)
11051 This target hook returns @code{true} past the point in which new jump
11052 instructions could be created. On machines that require a register for
11053 every jump such as the SHmedia ISA of SH5, this point would typically be
11054 reload, so this target hook should be defined to a function such as:
11055
11056 @smallexample
11057 static bool
11058 cannot_modify_jumps_past_reload_p ()
11059 @{
11060 return (reload_completed || reload_in_progress);
11061 @}
11062 @end smallexample
11063 @end deftypefn
11064
11065 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS (void)
11066 This target hook returns a register class for which branch target register
11067 optimizations should be applied. All registers in this class should be
11068 usable interchangeably. After reload, registers in this class will be
11069 re-allocated and loads will be hoisted out of loops and be subjected
11070 to inter-block scheduling.
11071 @end deftypefn
11072
11073 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CALLEE_SAVED (bool @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen})
11074 Branch target register optimization will by default exclude callee-saved
11075 registers
11076 that are not already live during the current function; if this target hook
11077 returns true, they will be included. The target code must than make sure
11078 that all target registers in the class returned by
11079 @samp{TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS} that might need saving are
11080 saved. @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} indicates if prologues and
11081 epilogues have already been generated. Note, even if you only return
11082 true when @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} is false, you still are likely
11083 to have to make special provisions in @code{INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET}
11084 to reserve space for caller-saved target registers.
11085 @end deftypefn
11086
11087 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTION (void)
11088 This target hook returns true if the target supports conditional execution.
11089 This target hook is required only when the target has several different
11090 modes and they have different conditional execution capability, such as ARM.
11091 @end deftypefn
11092
11093 @deftypefn {Target Hook} unsigned TARGET_LOOP_UNROLL_ADJUST (unsigned @var{nunroll}, struct loop *@var{loop})
11094 This target hook returns a new value for the number of times @var{loop}
11095 should be unrolled. The parameter @var{nunroll} is the number of times
11096 the loop is to be unrolled. The parameter @var{loop} is a pointer to
11097 the loop, which is going to be checked for unrolling. This target hook
11098 is required only when the target has special constraints like maximum
11099 number of memory accesses.
11100 @end deftypefn
11101
11102 @defmac POWI_MAX_MULTS
11103 If defined, this macro is interpreted as a signed integer C expression
11104 that specifies the maximum number of floating point multiplications
11105 that should be emitted when expanding exponentiation by an integer
11106 constant inline. When this value is defined, exponentiation requiring
11107 more than this number of multiplications is implemented by calling the
11108 system library's @code{pow}, @code{powf} or @code{powl} routines.
11109 The default value places no upper bound on the multiplication count.
11110 @end defmac
11111
11112 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11113 This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11114 target. The parameter @var{stdinc} indicates if normal include files
11115 are present. The parameter @var{sysroot} is the system root directory.
11116 The parameter @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11117 @end deftypefn
11118
11119 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_PRE_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11120 This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11121 target before any standard headers. The parameter @var{stdinc}
11122 indicates if normal include files are present. The parameter
11123 @var{sysroot} is the system root directory. The parameter
11124 @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11125 @end deftypefn
11126
11127 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_OPTF (char *@var{path})
11128 This target hook should register special include paths for the target.
11129 The parameter @var{path} is the include to register. On Darwin
11130 systems, this is used for Framework includes, which have semantics
11131 that are different from @option{-I}.
11132 @end deftypefn
11133
11134 @defmac bool TARGET_USE_LOCAL_THUNK_ALIAS_P (tree @var{fndecl})
11135 This target macro returns @code{true} if it is safe to use a local alias
11136 for a virtual function @var{fndecl} when constructing thunks,
11137 @code{false} otherwise. By default, the macro returns @code{true} for all
11138 functions, if a target supports aliases (i.e.@: defines
11139 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF}), @code{false} otherwise,
11140 @end defmac
11141
11142 @defmac TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES
11143 If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11144 target-specific format checking information for the @option{-Wformat}
11145 option. The default is to have no target-specific format checks.
11146 @end defmac
11147
11148 @defmac TARGET_N_FORMAT_TYPES
11149 If defined, this macro is the number of entries in
11150 @code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES}.
11151 @end defmac
11152
11153 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES
11154 If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11155 target-specific format overrides for the @option{-Wformat} option. The
11156 default is to have no target-specific format overrides. If defined,
11157 @code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES} must be defined, too.
11158 @end defmac
11159
11160 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES_COUNT
11161 If defined, this macro specifies the number of entries in
11162 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES}.
11163 @end defmac
11164
11165 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_INIT
11166 If defined, this macro specifies the optional initialization
11167 routine for target specific customizations of the system printf
11168 and scanf formatter settings.
11169 @end defmac
11170
11171 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RELAXED_ORDERING
11172 If set to @code{true}, means that the target's memory model does not
11173 guarantee that loads which do not depend on one another will access
11174 main memory in the order of the instruction stream; if ordering is
11175 important, an explicit memory barrier must be used. This is true of
11176 many recent processors which implement a policy of ``relaxed,''
11177 ``weak,'' or ``release'' memory consistency, such as Alpha, PowerPC,
11178 and ia64. The default is @code{false}.
11179 @end deftypevr
11180
11181 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_ARG_FOR_UNPROTOTYPED_FN (const_tree @var{typelist}, const_tree @var{funcdecl}, const_tree @var{val})
11182 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11183 illegal to pass argument @var{val} to function @var{funcdecl}
11184 with prototype @var{typelist}.
11185 @end deftypefn
11186
11187 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_CONVERSION (const_tree @var{fromtype}, const_tree @var{totype})
11188 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11189 invalid to convert from @var{fromtype} to @var{totype}, or @code{NULL}
11190 if validity should be determined by the front end.
11191 @end deftypefn
11192
11193 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_UNARY_OP (int @var{op}, const_tree @var{type})
11194 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11195 invalid to apply operation @var{op} (where unary plus is denoted by
11196 @code{CONVERT_EXPR}) to an operand of type @var{type}, or @code{NULL}
11197 if validity should be determined by the front end.
11198 @end deftypefn
11199
11200 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_BINARY_OP (int @var{op}, const_tree @var{type1}, const_tree @var{type2})
11201 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11202 invalid to apply operation @var{op} to operands of types @var{type1}
11203 and @var{type2}, or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11204 the front end.
11205 @end deftypefn
11206
11207 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_PARAMETER_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
11208 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11209 invalid for functions to include parameters of type @var{type},
11210 or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11211 the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11212 @end deftypefn
11213
11214 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_RETURN_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
11215 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11216 invalid for functions to have return type @var{type},
11217 or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11218 the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11219 @end deftypefn
11220
11221 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_PROMOTED_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
11222 If defined, this target hook returns the type to which values of
11223 @var{type} should be promoted when they appear in expressions,
11224 analogous to the integer promotions, or @code{NULL_TREE} to use the
11225 front end's normal promotion rules. This hook is useful when there are
11226 target-specific types with special promotion rules.
11227 This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11228 @end deftypefn
11229
11230 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CONVERT_TO_TYPE (tree @var{type}, tree @var{expr})
11231 If defined, this hook returns the result of converting @var{expr} to
11232 @var{type}. It should return the converted expression,
11233 or @code{NULL_TREE} to apply the front end's normal conversion rules.
11234 This hook is useful when there are target-specific types with special
11235 conversion rules.
11236 This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11237 @end deftypefn
11238
11239 @defmac TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION
11240 This macro determines whether to use the JCR section to register Java
11241 classes. By default, TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION is defined to 1 if both
11242 SUPPORTS_WEAK and TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS are true, else 0.
11243 @end defmac
11244
11245 @defmac OBJC_JBLEN
11246 This macro determines the size of the objective C jump buffer for the
11247 NeXT runtime. By default, OBJC_JBLEN is defined to an innocuous value.
11248 @end defmac
11249
11250 @defmac LIBGCC2_UNWIND_ATTRIBUTE
11251 Define this macro if any target-specific attributes need to be attached
11252 to the functions in @file{libgcc} that provide low-level support for
11253 call stack unwinding. It is used in declarations in @file{unwind-generic.h}
11254 and the associated definitions of those functions.
11255 @end defmac
11256
11257 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_UPDATE_STACK_BOUNDARY (void)
11258 Define this macro to update the current function stack boundary if
11259 necessary.
11260 @end deftypefn
11261
11262 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_GET_DRAP_RTX (void)
11263 This hook should return an rtx for Dynamic Realign Argument Pointer (DRAP) if a
11264 different argument pointer register is needed to access the function's
11265 argument list due to stack realignment. Return @code{NULL} if no DRAP
11266 is needed.
11267 @end deftypefn
11268
11269 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALLOCATE_STACK_SLOTS_FOR_ARGS (void)
11270 When optimization is disabled, this hook indicates whether or not
11271 arguments should be allocated to stack slots. Normally, GCC allocates
11272 stacks slots for arguments when not optimizing in order to make
11273 debugging easier. However, when a function is declared with
11274 @code{__attribute__((naked))}, there is no stack frame, and the compiler
11275 cannot safely move arguments from the registers in which they are passed
11276 to the stack. Therefore, this hook should return true in general, but
11277 false for naked functions. The default implementation always returns true.
11278 @end deftypefn
11279
11280 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR
11281 On some architectures it can take multiple instructions to synthesize
11282 a constant. If there is another constant already in a register that
11283 is close enough in value then it is preferable that the new constant
11284 is computed from this register using immediate addition or
11285 subtraction. We accomplish this through CSE. Besides the value of
11286 the constant we also add a lower and an upper constant anchor to the
11287 available expressions. These are then queried when encountering new
11288 constants. The anchors are computed by rounding the constant up and
11289 down to a multiple of the value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR}.
11290 @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} should be the maximum positive value
11291 accepted by immediate-add plus one. We currently assume that the
11292 value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is a power of 2. For example, on
11293 MIPS, where add-immediate takes a 16-bit signed value,
11294 @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is set to @samp{0x8000}. The default value
11295 is zero, which disables this optimization. @end deftypevr
11296
11297 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_MEMMODEL_CHECK (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{val})
11298 Validate target specific memory model mask bits. When NULL no target specific
11299 memory model bits are allowed.
11300 @end deftypefn
11301
11302 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned char} TARGET_ATOMIC_TEST_AND_SET_TRUEVAL
11303 This value should be set if the result written by @code{atomic_test_and_set} is not exactly 1, i.e. the @code{bool} @code{true}.
11304 @end deftypevr